[ Undergraduate] Bulletin, LaGrange College, LaGrange, Georgia, Catalogue Issue, 2005-2006, September 2005

Skip viewer

Digitized by the Internet Archive
in 2013

http://archive.org/details/undergraduatebul2005lagr

VOLUME CLXIV SEPTEMBER 2005 NUMBER 1

BULLETIN
LAGRANGE COLLEGE

LAGRANGE, GEORGIA

CATALOGUE ISSUE 2005-2006

l

Communications Directory

LaGrange College

601 Broad Street

LaGrange, Georgia 30240-2999

(706) 880-8000 Fax: (706) 880-8358 www.lagrange.edu

For prompt attention, please address inquiries as indicated below.

Prefix is 706.

LaGrange College (general information) 880-8000

Office of the President 880-8230

Executive Director of Instructional & Information Tech 880-8304

Vice President for Academic Affairs and Dean 880-8236

Registrar 880-8237

Vice President & Dean for Student Life and Retention 880-8004

Director of Career Planning and Placement 880-8286

Vice President for Enrollment Management 880-8736

Director of Admission 880-8253

Director Student Financial Planning 880-8229

Executive Vice President for Administration 880-8267

Controller 880-8232

Vice President for Advancement 880-8257

Director of Communications and Marketing 880-8246

Visitors are welcome at LaGrange College throughout the year.

The administrative offices in the Quillian Building are open Monday through
Friday from 8:00 a.m. to 5:00 p.m. Saturday visits may be arranged by appointment.
Visitors desiring interviews with members of the staff are urged to make
appointments in advance.

LaGrange College admits qualified students of any race, color, national and ethnic
origin to all rights, privileges, programs and activities generally accorded or made
available to students at the school. It does not discriminate on the basis of sex, race,
color, national or ethnic origin in administration of its educational policies,
admissions policies, scholarship and loan programs, and athletic and other school-
administered programs.

LaGrange College Bulletin, Volume CLXIV, Number i

President: Dr. F. Stuart Gulley Editor: Dr. Jay Simmons

LaGrange College Bulletin, the official publication of LaGrange College for current
and future students, is published monthly except February, August and November.
Correspondence should be directed to the Office of Academic Dean, LaGrange
College, 601 Broad Street, LaGrange, GA 30240-2999. E-mail correspondence to
jsimmons@lagrange.edu or fax to (706) 880-8358.

Challenging the mind.

Inspiring the soul.

Contents

Communications Directory 3

Calendar 5

About LaGrange College, Purpose and History 10

LaGrange College at Albany 13

The LaGrange College Campus 14

Admission and Enrollment 20

Financial Information 27

Financial Aid 33

Student Life 45

Academic Advising 58

Academic Support and Information Technology 73

Academic Programs 81

Departments and Courses 98

Academic Divisions, Departments and Courses 99

Faculty 262

Trustees 272

Administration 275

Index 279

Change of Regulations

The College reserves the right to make modifications in the degree re-
quirements, courses, schedules, calendar, regulations, fees and other
changes deemed necessary or conducive to the efficient operation of the
College. Such changes become effective as announced by the proper
college authorities.

Note: For information, regulations and procedures for graduate study,
please see the Graduate Bulletin. For information, regulations and pro-
cedures for evening courses, please see the Evening College Bulletin.
For information, regulations and procedures of the Albany campus,
please see the Albany Bulletin.

2005-2006
Academic Calendar

Day Program

Fall Semester (63 Class Days)

23

AUGUST

August
August 24

August

New faculty assemble

Opening Session

30-Sept 2 New student orientation

SEPTEMBER

September 6

September 7

7:00 PM
September

Registration for new and returning Day
students not prepaid. Advisors for freshman,
transfer and readmitted students are
available.

All Classes Begin

Opening Convocation

13

End drop/add period and late
registration. No refunds for individual
courses dropped after 5:00 p.m. "I"
grades must be changed to permanent
grades. Syllabi and office hours due in
Dean's office. If possible, please submit
by email

September

16

Day of Record

September

29-30

Interim Term Pre-Registration

OCTOBER

October

4

Last day to drop a class with an automatic "W"

October

13-14

Fall Break No Classes
Midterm

October

21

Board of Trustees Meeting

October

21-23

Homecoming

October

3 1-Nov 4 Advising period and pre-registration for Day
program students. Students completing
degree requirements by end of fall term
should file petitions for graduation.
Students may declare majors.
Advisors available.

NOVEMBER

November

10

22

Last day to drop a class

November

Last Day of Classes before
Thanksgiving Break

November

28

Classes resume after Thanksgiving Break

DECEMBER

December

5-11

Celebrate the Servant Week

December

9

Last Day of Fall Semester Classes for
Day College

December

10

Reading Day

December

12-16

Final Exams

December

16

Begin term break

December
December

5:00 pm Grades due. Last day to pre-pay or confirm
pre-registration for Interim and Spring
Terms 2006; otherwise, pre-registered
students must go through registration,
January 2, 2006

23-27 Holidays for administration and staff.

28-30 Administrative offices open

Interim Term (20 Class Days)

January
January

New Year's Holiday
Residence halls open

Registration for new and returning Day
students. Advisors for freshman, transfer
and readmitted students are available.
Evening College, joint enrollment and
graduate registration. Night and graduate
advisors are available. Mandatory First
Meeting for all Interim Classes.

January

January
January

January

5 End Drop/Add. No refund for individual

classes dropped after this date. Last day for
late registration. Syllabi and office hours due
in Dean's office. If possible, please submit
by e-mail.

1 1 Last day to drop a class with an automatic "W"

16 Martin Luther King, Jr., Day - College

closed. No Classes.

31 Last day of class

FEBRUARY

February

Interim Term Grades due

Spring Semester (63 Class Days)

3

February

February
February

February

Day program registration for new and
returning students not prepaid. Advisors for
freshman, transfer and readmitted students
are available.

Classes begin

End drop/add at 5:00 p.m. No refund for
individual classes dropped after this date. "I"
grades must be changed to permanent grades.
Last day for late registration. Fall Class
Schedules due in the Registrar's Office.
Syllabi and office hours due in Dean's office.
If possible, please submit by e-mail.

17 Day Of Record.

MARCH

March
March

20

Midterm

27-31 Advising period and pre-registration for

upper class Day program students. Students
completing degree requirements in summer
or fall should file petitions for graduation.
Students may declare majors.
Advisors available

APRIL

April 3-7 Spring Break

April 14 Last Day to Drop a Class

April 21 Board of Trustees Meeting

April 28 Honors Day

April 28-30 Family Weekend

April 29 May Day

MAY

May 10 Last Day of Classes for Day Program

May 1 1 Reading Day

May 12-17 Final Exams

GRADES DUE FOR GRADUATES BY 12:00 P.M.
ON THURSDAY , MAY 18

May 19 9:30 AM Graduation rehearsal, faculty marshals and

student marshals attend

Senior brunch, faculty invited.

5:00 PM Baccalaureate at First United Methodist Church

All faculty should plan to attend

Grades due at 5:00 p.m.

May 20

8:30 AM Graduation on Quadrangle. All faculty
should plan to attend.

May 29

Memorial Day - College closed.

Summer I Term 2006

May 30

Residence halls open

Registration

May 31

All classes meet

JUNE

June 1

End drop/add at 5:00 p.m. No refund for individual
classes dropped after this date. Syllabi and office
hours due in Dean's office

June 7 Last day to drop a class with an automatic "W

June

21

June

29

June

30

Summer II

JULY

July

3-4

July

5

Last day to drop a course

July 6

July 13
July 27

12:00 and 2:00 classes have exams during class times
7:30 and 9:30 classes have exams during class times
Departmental Annual Reports due in Dean's Office
Term 2006

July 4 th College Holiday-no classes

Grade Reports due at noon

Residence halls open

Registration, Registrar's Office, Smith Hall

All classes meet

End drop/add, 5:00 p.m. No refund for individual
classes dropped after this date. Syllabi and office
hours due in Dean's office

Last day to drop a class with an automatic "W"

Last day to drop a class

AUGUST

August 4
August 7
August 9

12:00 and 2:00 classes have exams during class times
7:30 and 9:30 classes have exams during class times

Grade reports due by noon

About LaGrange College

LaGrange College is called through the United Methodist Church to
challenge the minds and inspire the souls of students by improving
their creative, critical and communicative abilities in a caring and
ethical community.

Mission

LaGrange College, established in 1831, is owned by the North Georgia
Conference of the United Methodist Church. LaGrange College is proud
of this relationship and believes that its mission is an extension of the
work of The United Methodist Church. LaGrange College is committed
to the free, uninhibited pursuit of truth. Academic freedom and free
expression of faculty and students are integral to the LaGrange College
ethos. LaGrange College is committed to challenging the minds and
inspiring the souls of students by improving their creative, critical and
communicative abilities. Faculty recognize the part they play in a
student's development by serving as mentors and role models. The total
LaGrange College program - curricular and co-curricular - is designed to
challenge and support students as they deal with fundamental issues of
self, world, and God.

The principal curricular methods by which the College assists students
in the improving of their creative, critical, and communicative abilities
are an interdisciplinary, technologically sophisticated liberal arts
program (A. A., B.A., B.S., B.M.), and professional programs in
business, nursing (B.S.N.) and education (B.A., M.Ed., M.A.T.) The
principal co-curricular means is through a comprehensive program of
student life and athletics.

LaGrange College strives to be a caring and ethical community. The
hallmark of the LaGrange College community is the quest for civility,
diversity, service, and excellence.

Adopted by Faculty, Administration, and Board of Trustees, 1997;
reaffirmed by Board of Trustees on October 20, 2000.

History and Description

The history of LaGrange College is closely associated with the history of
the City of LaGrange and Troup County. When the vast tract of land
lying between the Flint and Chattahoochee Rivers was secured by the
Indian Springs Treaty of 1825 and was opened for settlement in 1827,
one of the five counties formed on the western border of the state was
named Troup in honor of Governor George Michael Troup.

10

An act was passed by the Georgia Legislature on December 24, 1827,
providing for the selection of a county seat. It was named LaGrange
after the country estate of the Marquis de Lafayette, American
Revolutionary War hero who had visited the region in 1825 as the guest
of Governor Troup. The site for the town of LaGrange was purchased in
1828 and the town was incorporated on December 18, 1828. On
December 26, 1831, the charter for the LaGrange Female Academy was
granted at the state capitol, then in Milledgeville.

In 1831 Andrew Jackson was president of the United States. Abraham
Lincoln was 22 years old. The Creek Indians had been moved out of
this area of the state only six years earlier. The only other college in the
state was Franklin College, now The University of Georgia.

In 1847 the charter for the school was amended and the school became
the LaGrange Female Institute with power to confer degrees. The name
was changed to LaGrange Female College in 1851 and in 1934 it was
changed to LaGrange College. The College became officially
coeducational in 1953.

The first location of the school was in a large white building at what is
now 406 Broad Street. The school moved to its present location "On the
Hill," the highest geographical point in LaGrange, after the construction
of the building now known as Smith Hall in 1842.

The College was sold to the Georgia Conference of the Methodist
Episcopal Church South in 1856. Today it is an institution of the North
Georgia Conference of the United Methodist Church.

Strong in the liberal arts, LaGrange College has an outstanding
reputation in pre-professional programs, including pre-medical and
allied fields, pre-law, pre-theology, and pre-engineering.

LaGrange College offers the Bachelor of Arts degree with sixteen
majors, the Bachelor of Science degree in five areas, the Bachelor of
Music and the Bachelor of Science in Nursing degree. The Master of
Arts in Teaching, and the Master of Education degree in Early
Curriculum and Instruction are offered. The Associate of Arts degree is
offered in one area.

LaGrange College operates on the modified (4-1-4) semester system for
day classes. In addition there is an evening session during the regular
year and in the summer. During the regular school year, the night
classes follow a modified quarter system. The summer is divided into
two sessions of day classes and one seven-week session in the evening.
For all day classes, credits earned are semester hour credits.

11

The College draws more than half of its student body from Georgia.
However, students from at least one-third of the other states in the U.S.
and from abroad nourish a rich cosmopolitan and international
community which includes various religious and ethnic backgrounds.

Georgia's leader in granting academic credit through the College Level
Examination Program, the College also offers travel seminars, field
study programs and internships. Students in the college's nursing
division receive supervised learning experiences in many area medical
facilities. Campus art exhibitions, lectures, concerts, and varsity and
intramural sports add to the cultural enrichment and recreational
opportunities offered by the College. The College has a service learning
program unlike any in the state.

The College is located in the town of LaGrange, Georgia, which has
a population of 28,000. Nearby are Callaway Gardens, the Warm
Springs Foundation and Franklin D. Roosevelt's Little White House.
The West Point Dam on the Chattahoochee River provides one of the
largest lakes in the region, with waterfronts and a marina within the city
limits of LaGrange.

Accreditation

LaGrange College is accredited by the Commission on Colleges of the
Southern Association of Colleges and Schools (1866 Southern Lane,
Decatur, Georgia 30033-4097: Telephone number 404-679-4501) to
award the degrees of Associate of Arts, Bachelor of Arts, Bachelor of
Music, Bachelor of Science, Bachelor of Business Administration,
Bachelor of Science in Nursing, Master of Education, and Master of
Arts in Teaching.

LaGrange College is also approved by the United Methodist
University Senate. It has membership in the National Association of
Independent Colleges and Universities and the Georgia Foundation for
Independent Colleges.

The Georgia Professional Standards Commission, which confers
professional certificates upon college graduates meeting requirements in
early childhood, middle grades, or secondary education, has awarded
highest approval to LaGrange College's program of teacher education.

The Bachelor of Science in Nursing program is accredited by the
National League for Nursing.

The undergraduate and graduate programs in business administration
are accredited by the Association of Collegiate Business Schools
and Programs.

12

Other Sessions
Evening College

Recognizing the unique needs of the nontraditional learner who may be
managing personal, professional, and collegiate careers, the Evening
College structure supports full-time or part-time evening study for
qualified adult students. Classes are scheduled Monday-Thursday
evenings during four academic quarters; students may enroll in
September, January, March, or June. Degrees offered include the
Bachelor of Arts degree in Business Administration, the Bachelor of
Arts degree in Human Development, and the Associate of Arts degree in
Liberal Studies. Students may also earn a minor in Sociology.

View the Evening College Bulletin online at www.lagrange.edu or call
(706) 880-8298 for additional information.

LaGrange College at Albany

The academic program at LaGrange College at Albany has been created
in direct response to community and area needs. An extensive needs
assessment in southwest Georgia was initiated prior to the planning and
development of the program for LaGrange College at Albany. The
research results stressed the need for a program for non-traditional
students that would enable them to complete a baccalaureate degree.
The program offers a modular course schedule with a predictable
structure of course offerings, costs, and outcomes. The program
emphasizes leadership knowledge and skills in the workplace and in
the community.

Additional information is contained in the Albany Bulletin or by calling
229-420-8000

13

The Lagrange College Campus

William and Evelyn Banks Library

The librarians and staff take great pride in the high level of service that
is offered at the Banks Library. Each year the library staff receives high
marks from faculty and students on the annual library survey. Library
instruction is highly emphasized with both individual and group
instruction offered.

The Banks Library provides up-to-date resources that support the
curriculum and general information needs of students and faculty. The
Online Catalog can be accessed from anywhere in the world on the
WEB. Additionally, the library makes available to students and faculty
full-text databases on GALILEO plus other databases to which it
subscribes including JSTOR, GALES Business and Company Resource
Center, ATLAS Religion Database, CINAHL, ProjectMuse, Wilson
Omnifile and more.

Separate Education and Music & Art areas in the library provide easy
access to library materials for those disciplines in a comfortable, user-
friendly environment. A Multi-Media Center provides access to the
Internet, word processing, presentation software, E-MAIL, and the
library's electronic resources. The library provides a scanner, computer
projector, multi-media and Finale music workstations for student use.
Group study rooms, study carrels, video viewing-rooms, and a
conference room are also available.

The Banks Library seeks to fulfill the mission of the college through the
provision of information resources and services supporting the
curriculum, co-curricular, and research needs of students and faculty.

Lee Edwards Candler and Vernon Street Residence Halls were
completed in 2002. Each apartment-style hall houses 124 students.
Arranged in either two or four bedroom floor plans with one bathroom
per two students, the apartments are fully furnished and also have a
full kitchen. A community room is also located at the end of one wing
in each building. Candler Hall is named in memory of Mrs. Lee
Edwards Candler.

Cason J. Callaway Science Building

Built in 1972, this three-story brick building is supplied with the latest
equipment for instruction in general science, biology, chemistry, math,

14

and physics. The building is named in memory of a former member of
the College's Board of Trustees.

Fuller E. Callaway Academic Building

Completed in 1981 and renovated in 2000, the Fuller E. Callaway
Academic Building houses the Departments of Nursing, Psychology,
History, Political Science, and Human Services.

Warren A. Candler Cottage

Completed in 1929 as a home for the college president. The Candler
Cottage now houses the Vice President for Advancement, Donor
Relations, and Advancement Services.

Lamar Dodd Art Center

Completed in 1982, this building provides a physical environment and
the equipment needed for art instruction as well as gallery space for the
College's outstanding art collection. The building is named in honor of
the late Lamar Dodd, a Georgia artist who was reared in LaGrange and
whose paintings won international recognition.

Louise Anderson Manget Building

Built in 1959 and renovated in 2001, the Louise Anderson Manget
Building houses the Division of Humanities, including the Departments
of English, Latin American Studies and Modern Languages, and
Religion and Philosophy.

Pitts Hall

Completed in 1941, this two-story brick women's dormitory was
renovated in 1990. Pitts Hall was rededicated in memory of Mr. and
Mrs. W. I. H. Pitts and in honor of their daughter, the late Miss Margaret
Adger Pitts, a former college trustee. The Pitts were long-time
supporters of the College.

Price Theatre

Completed in 1975, this dramatic arts building seats 280 and houses
classrooms for the Department of Theatre Arts, faculty offices, scenery
workshop, dressing rooms, costume room, actors' lounge, and a black
box theatre.

15

Quillian Building

Built in 1949 and named in memory of a former president, Hubert T.
Quillian, who served from 1938-1948, this building provides offices for
the President, the Vice President for Academic Affairs and Dean, the
Executive Vice President for Administration, the Business Office, and
Institutional Research and Planning.

Smith Hall

The oldest building on the campus, the main portion of the building was
constructed in 1842 of handmade brick formed from native clay. An
addition was built in 1887 and a major renovation was completed in
1989 at a cost of over $2.5 million. Ready for the 21 st century, the
building now houses offices, classrooms and seminar rooms. Smith Hall
was named in memory of Mrs. Oreon Smith, wife of a former president
of the College, Rufus W. Smith, who served from 1885 until his death
in 1915. The building is on the National Register of Historic Places.

Sunny Gables Alumni House

Built by Mary and Julia Nix in 1924, Sunny Gables Alumni House is an
outstanding example of early twentieth century Tudor Revival
architecture designed by P. Thornton Marye and is now part of the
National Register of Historic Places' Vernon Road Historic District. The
Sunny Gables Alumni House seeks to provide a real and symbolic home
for LaGrange College alumni for generations to come, capturing a part
of LaGrange College's historic past and stretching forward into the
College's future. This multipurpose facility serves as the permanent
home for alumni, as well as the Office of Alumni and Parent Relations and
the Office of Development. The facility extends entertainment space to the
College's constituents for College programming purposes consistent with
Gateway to Excellence, our strategic plan.

The Mitchell Building is located on the grounds of Sunny Gables
Alumni House. It was named in memory of Evelyn Mitchell, a trustee of
The Arthur Vining Davis Foundations. The building formerly provided
classroom space for the Nursing Division and currently houses the
College's Communications and Marketing Department.

The Chapel

Built in 1965, the materials used in the construction of the Chapel link it
with Christian worship in LaGrange and other parts of the world.
Included in the structure are two stained glass windows made in

16

Belgium more than 100 years ago; a stone from the temple of Apollo at
Corinth, Greece; a stone from the Benedictine Monastery, Iona,
Scotland; and a stone from St. George's Chapel, Windsor, England.
Regular worship services are held when the College is in session.

J. K. BOATWRIGHT HALL

Completed in 1962, this three-story brick building serves as a men's
dormitory. J. K. Boatwright Hall is named in memory of a long-time
member of the College's Board of Trustees and chairman of the board's
executive committee from 1956-1962. New designs were incorporated
in the renovations to the building in 2003.

HawkesHall

Completed in 1911, this four-story brick building is named in memory
of Mrs. Harriet Hawkes, mother of College benefactor, the late A.K.
Hawkes. After a major renovation costing $1.4 million, the building
houses women students on second, third, and fourth floors. Faculty
offices and classrooms for the Education Department occupy the ground
floor. Also on the second floor is the Nixon Parlor, named in honor of
long-time supporter of the College, Winifred Adams Nixon '33.

Waights G. Henry, Jr., Residence Hall

Completed in 1970, this five-story brick building provides student
housing. The building is named in honor of the late Dr. Waights G.
Henry, Jr., who served as president of the College from 1948-1978, and
as chancellor from 1978 until his death in 1989. This building also
houses a 24-hour computer lab and tutoring center open to all students.

Student Center

Built in 1958 not long after the institution became co-educational, this
three-story brick building was first used to provide campus housing for
men, and later, women. In 2003, the structure was renovated and
enlarged to become a student center, featuring large and small meeting
rooms, a student grill and a game room on the first two floors. Student
housing remains on the third floor and is known as the William H.
Turner, Jr., Residence Hall. It is named in memory of Mr. Turner, a
textile executive of LaGrange who was a benefactor of the College, a
longtime member of the Board of Trustees and chairman of the board's
executive committee from 1929 until 1950.

17

Alfred Mariotti Gymnasium

Built in 1959, the Mariotti Gym houses physical education classrooms
and facilities for indoor athletics. The facility is named in memory of
Coach Alfred Mariotti, the College's basketball coach from 1962-1974
and member of the faculty until his retirement in 1979.

Margaret Adger Pitts Dining Hall

Completed in 1962 and renovated in 1998, this two-story brick building
houses the dining area, kitchen, and the College Bookstore. The
building is dedicated in honor of the late Margaret Adger Pitts, a former
College trustee.

Callaway Campus

Acquired by the College in 1992 as a gift from Callaway Foundation,
Inc., the campus includes three buildings of brick and concrete
construction. Callaway Foundation, Inc. donated funds to build a state-
of-the-art lighted soccer field in 1995. The Callaway Campus also
includes softball fields.

Callaway Auditorium

Built in 1941, Callaway Auditorium underwent extensive renovation in
2005. It is now the primary performance venue for the College's
Department of Music and the LaGrange Symphony Orchestra.

Charles D. Hudson Natatorium

The swimming pool was constructed in 1947 as an oversized pool with
dimensions of 80 by 150 feet. The cabana and bathhouse were built in
1956. The oversized pool has been divided into an outdoor pool and a
natatorium. The complex is now equipped for a year-round aquatics
program. The Natatorium is named in honor of Dr. Charles D. Hudson,
long-time chair of the Board of Trustees and recently retired chair of the
Board's Executive Committee.

Callaway Educational Building

Built in 1965 and renovated in 1994, the building houses the Music
Department, Offices of Intercollegiate and Intramural Athletics, and
Offices of the Department of Health and Physical Education. The
facility includes state-of-the-art electronic music equipment, a recording
studio, a fitness center, a gymnasium, and faculty offices.

18

Cleaveland Field

Cleaveland Field opened in 2000 as LaGrange College's new $2.21
million baseball facility. Callaway Foundation, Inc. gave a challenge
grant as well as the land to honor Philip Cleaveland, who served the
College as a trustee for 19 years.

Other Resources
Information Systems

In 1991, LaGrange College became committed to creating a fiber-optic
network of mini-computers that would allow students and faculty to
access the network anywhere on campus, including residence hall
rooms. Since 1994, the number of computer laboratories has grown
from seven to twelve. Students can access World Wide Web from
virtually any site on campus to find information ranging from stock
prices to Russian recipes. Specific details regarding the technological
environment at LaGrange College can be found in the Academic
Support and Information Technology section of this Bulletin. Future
technological direction on campus includes the addition of more
interactive multimedia learning environments.

Coleman Health Center

The location for Student Health Services provides a day clinic for the
LaGrange College Community. For details students should consult the
student handbook.

19

Admission And Enrollment

The application process at LaGrange College is selective and designed
to carefully consider each candidate's personal qualities and readiness
for college. We seek applicants who have the potential to be successful
academically and who will contribute to our community in meaningful
ways. We will evaluate the application, transcript(s), course selection,
SAT or ACT scores (if required), essay and recommendation when
making our decision. An admission counselor will assist each
prospective student throughout the application and enrollment process.
We encourage prospective students to visit campus for a personal
interview as part of the application process.

Students interested in attending LaGrange College must submit an
application for admission. March 1 is the deadline for best
consideration for admission, financial aid, and housing for the fall
semester. Students interested in scholarship consideration should apply
before January 1 or the published deadline for the scholarship,
whichever is earlier. Students applying for admission to the January or
Summer terms should submit the application and supporting documents
at least one month prior to the beginning of the term for which
admission is desired.

Applying for Admission

Applicants for freshman admission must submit the following items:
the application form, application fee, official high school transcripts,
official SAT or ACT scores, essay and recommendation. The office
of admission reserves the right to request or waive documentation
as appropriate.

Applicants who have attended a college or university following high
school graduation must submit the following items: application form,
fee, college or university transcripts, essay, and recommendation. If the
applicant has completed fewer than 30 semester hour or 40 quarter hours
of college level work, an ACT or SAT score and high school transcripts
will also be required.

To be considered an official document, a transcript should be submitted
directly to LaGrange College in a sealed envelope from the sending
institution. Institutional records personally delivered to LaGrange
College by a student must also be in a sealed envelope to be considered
official. Photocopies, faxes, or transcripts in unsealed envelopes are not
considered official.

20

LaGrange College prefers SAT scores but will accept ACT scores.
Beginning with new first year students entering during the Fall 2006
semester, the College will require a writing test for admission. This
requirement may be met by submitting the SAT including the essay or
an ACT writing score in addition to the regular ACT. Test results
should be sent directly to LaGrange College, preferably by March of the
student's senior year of high school.

The Admission Committee may request additional materials from an
applicant or require an interview to gain a better understanding of the
student's potential for success in a challenging academic environment.
The Office of Admission notifies applicants of their application status
shortly after review by the Admission Committee. Admission to the
College requires satisfactory completion of academic work in progress.

LaGrange College values personal integrity in our community. Our
students sign an Honor Code statement pledging not to lie, cheat, steal,
nor tolerate these unethical behaviors in others. Recognizing the
importance of adherence to the Honor Code, the Office of Admission
extends this principle to our application process. Any student who omits
or falsifies material details in the application for admission will not be
admitted or their offer of admission may be revoked.

After an offer of admission is extended, candidates wishing to accept the
offer of admission are asked to submit a tuition deposit. The tuition
deposit serves to reserve space for the student in the incoming class.
The amount of the tuition deposit is $100 for commuting students and
$200 for residential students. The $100 deposit will be placed on the
student's account for the first semester. The additional $100 for
residential students serves as a room reservation deposit and will reserve
a space in the residence halls for the student. The tuition deposit is fully
refundable provided the student submits a written request to the Office
of Admission by the following dates: May 1 for Fall Semester,
December 1 for the Interim (January) Term, and Spring Semester.

LaGrange College encourages interested students to visit the campus.
Individual appointments may be scheduled by contacting the Office of
Admission at 1-800-593-2885 or by e-mail at admission@lagrange.edu.
Please contact the Office of Admission at least one week prior to the day
you plan to visit.

Academic Requirements for Admission

Freshman Admission: Prior to enrollment, an applicant is expected to
complete graduation requirements from an approved high school.
Students graduating from Georgia high schools are normally expected to

21

complete the requirements for the College Preparatory Curriculum
(CPC) diploma.

LaGrange College students come from a variety of public and private
secondary school backgrounds. Preference is given to applicants who
have strong academic preparation in high school. To qualify for regular
admission to the college, an applicant should complete at least the
following number of units, comparable to the Georgia College
Preparatory Curriculum:

Subject Area Units

English 4

Social Studies (including American and world studies 3

College Preparatory Mathematics 4

(Algebra I, Algebra II, Geometry ,etc.)
Science (including lab courses for life and physical sciences) 3

Desirable electives include additional academic courses in languages,
mathematics, and the sciences. A basic understanding of computer
science is also encouraged.

LaGrange College invites home-educated students to apply for
admission. In addition to the items requested for freshman admission,
home-schooled students are asked to provide a bibliography of all high
school literature including instructional texts and two letters of
recommendation. Please note that at least one letter of recommendation
must not be written by a family member.

Students holding a General Education Development (GED), High
School Level may be considered for admission, although they will
generally not be accepted to the college prior to the year in which their
class would have normally been eligible for admission to the college.
Applicants must submit GED scores in addition to the certificate.
Students possessing a GED must also submit either SAT or ACT scores
as a part of the application process. The SAT or ACT requirement may
be waived for students who are at least 22 years of age.

Admission Status

A number of factors are considered in making an admission decision,
including a student's grade point average, difficulty of course work,
standardized test scores, extracurricular and co-curricular activities,
recommendations and admission essay. Students may be accepted to
LaGrange College in one of several categories.

22

Regular Admission: Most students offered admission to LaGrange
College are accepted with no stipulations, other than successful
completion of their current academic course work and proof of high
school graduation.

Conditional Admission: In some cases a candidate who appears to
meet the standard requirements for admission may experience delays in
obtaining required documents. At the discretion of the Admission
Committee, a student may be granted Conditional Admission pending
receipt of required documents. Upon submission of the documents, the
student will be granted regular status. All documents must be submitted
within 30 days of matriculation.

Probation: In some cases candidates for admission may meet most of
the criteria for admission but still not qualify for regular admission. At
the discretion of the admission committee, such students may be
admitted on probation. Students admitted on probation must meet the
minimum stated grade point average requirement based on their class
level in order to be removed from probationary status.

Early Admission: Early admission is possible for academically talented
students who have completed their junior year of high school. To
qualify for early admission, a student must meet specific academic
criteria including a B+ or better high school average in a college
preparatory program and completion of 15 of the 16 prescribed units,
with a minimum total of 16 units. Students seeking early admission
must also earn a minimum composite score of 1690 on the SAT or 25 on
the ACT. A minimum of 550 on the verbal portion of the SAT or a
minimum of 24 on the English subject area of the ACT is highly
desirable. An interview is required for all early admission candidates.

Joint Enrollment: LaGrange College encourages qualified eleventh and
twelfth grade students to consider simultaneous enrollment in LaGrange
College and their high school. Georgia high school seniors may wish to
consider participating in the Georgia Ace Program. Students wishing to
apply for the joint enrollment program or Georgia Ace Program must
submit the following materials: an application for admission, application
fee, recommendation letter from the student's principal or headmaster,
SAT or ACT scores, and a high school average that indicates that the
student has the academic ability to be successful in the program.

Students applying for the Georgia Ace Program must also submit an
official recommendation from the high school counseling office as well
as a notarized statement attesting to the fact that they live within a 25
mile radius of LaGrange College and do not live within 25 miles of a
public institution.

23

Transfer Admission: Students attending another institution may apply
for transfer to LaGrange College provided they are eligible to return to
their current institution at the time of entry to LaGrange College. A
student may be accepted on probation under the standard probation
regulations. Prior to admission to LaGrange College, the Office of
Admission must receive all necessary documents, including official
transcripts of all college course work. Applicants may enroll at the
beginning of any semester.

LaGrange College is accredited by the Commission on Colleges of the
Southern Association of Colleges and Schools (1866 Southern Lane,
Decatur, Georgia 30033-4097: Telephone number 404-679-4501) to
award degrees of Associate of Arts, Bachelor of Arts, Bachelor of
Music, Bachelor of Science, Bachelor of Business Administration,
Bachelor of Science in Nursing, Master of Education, and Master of
Arts in Teaching. Accordingly, the college accepts course work from
similarly regionally accredited colleges and universities. Academic
credit is normally given to students for grades of "C" or above.
Acceptable credit from a junior college is limited to 54 semester hours.
Students enrolling from other senior colleges may be able to receive
additional semester credit but LaGrange College residency
requirements, the core curriculum, and appropriate major course work
must be satisfied. Transfer students who have attempted any
developmental-level course work must provide evidence that they have
completed all requirements and successfully exited the program prior
to evaluation by the admission committee. Members of Phi Theta
Kappa may qualify for academic scholarships reserved for members of
this society.

Transient Admission: Students currently enrolled in good standing at
another college may enroll at LaGrange College as transient students.
Approval of course work must be authorized by the primary institution
on the Transient Application for Admission, which is available in the
Admission Office. A permission letter from the student's home
institution certifying status and granting permission for specific transient
course work may also be sent.

Non-degree Undergraduate Admission: Students not working toward
a degree may register as non-degree undergraduate students in any
course for which they have the necessary prerequisites. An application
for non-degree undergraduate student status may be obtained through
the Admission Office. Students classified as non-degree undergraduate

24

students may become regular, degree-seeking, students by meeting
requirements for regular admission. No more that 6 credit hours earned
under this classification may be applied toward a degree.

Readmission to LaGrange College: Following an absence from
LaGrange College of 3 or more semesters, or any time a student was not
in good standing during the last term of attendance at LaGrange College,
any student wishing to return to attempt additional course work must
submit an Application for Readmission. This form is available in the
Office of Admission. Students absent from LaGrange College for 2
semesters or less, and who were in good standing when he/she last
attended LaGrange College may re-activate his/her file in the Registrar's
Office. These students do not need to apply for readmission.

In the event that a student seeking readmission has attended another
institution as a transfer student (not transient) since he/she left LaGrange
College, then the student, if readmitted, is treated as a new transfer
student. Students fitting this description are subject to the Bulletin in
force at the time of transfer back to LaGrange College. Students who
have not attended another institution are generally governed by the
catalog in force at the time of their initial admission. However, students
who have been out of school for four calendar years or more re-enter
LaGrange College under the Bulletin in force at the time of readmission
and resumption of study.

International Student Admission: Admission to LaGrange College
requires submission of the international student application, application
fee, and translated and certified documents attesting to the student's
academic performance in secondary and/or university studies. Students
j seeking admission may submit one of the following to prove English
proficiency:

Minimum TOEFL score of 500 (173 computer-based);

Certificate of completion of level 1 12 from the ELS Centers, Inc.;

Grades of "C" or better on G.C.E., G.S.C.E, or C.X.C. English
! examinations or equivalent tests;

Minimum SAT verbal score of 450;

Minimum ACT English section score of 21.

! International students must submit an affidavit of support and financial
I statements demonstrating the ability to pay the cost of attendance for at
least one year of study.

If the prospective student is in the United States, an interview at the

25

college is desirable. The Director of Admission should be contacted for
an appointment as well as for the current interpretation of regulations
with regard to obtaining an F-l student visa.

26

Financial Information

expenses

Payment of Charges

All charges for the semester are due and payable at the beginning of the
term, and each student is expected to make satisfactory arrangements at
that time. Students who pre-register and pay in advance of the deadline
each semester are not required to attend final registration. Students
completing registration after the Registration Day will be assessed a
Late Registration fee as enumerated below. Realizing that some
families prefer to pay on a monthly basis, the College has arrangements
with AMS TuitionPay and FACTS to offer families this option. These
plans are an agreement between the parent and the company; there is no
involvement by LaGrange College in the agreements. For additional
information, contact the Business Office. The College also offers a
deferred payment option that allows students to make monthly payments
I to cover educational costs. Interest will be assessed to students utilizing
this option.

In addition to cash and check, the College accepts American Express,
Discover, MasterCard, and VISA as payment of charges on a
student's account. Online payments are also available through the
College's website.

Charges

1. Admission

Application for admission (non-refundable) $20.00

2. Tuition

A. Undergraduate

(1) Part-time per semester hour

(1-1 1 or greater than 15) $668.00

(2) Full-time (12-15 semester hours) $8 1 00.00

(3) Nursing (NSG) courses per semester hour $668.00

B. Summer Term charges are listed in the summer brochure.

Students may request information regarding offerings and
charges from the Registrar's Office.

C. Audit (per semester hour) $668.00

27

3. Room and Board

Boatwright, Hawkes, Henry, Pitts, and Turner

(per semester) $3,337.00

Candler and Vernon (per semester $3,450.00

(Note: All students living in dormitories are required to pay
room and board.)

4. Private Room

Private rooms are abailable at an additional charge

(per semester) $685.00

After the beginning of the semester any student occupying a double
room alone will be charged the private rate. If a student occupying a
double room alone does note wish to pay the private room rate, it is that
student's responsibility to find a suitable roommate. Willingness to
accept a roommate does not constitute grounds for waiving the single
room charge.

Fees - Miscellaneous

Late registration (after Registration Day) $50.00

Personal checks failing to clear $25.00

Student Identification Card replacement fee $15.00

Document Fee (International Students) $175.00

Parking Permit $15.00

Testing Fee (All New Students) $60.00

Room deposit (Refundable ) $ 1 00.00

Admission Deposit (New Students) $100.00

Summary of Standard Charges Per Semester Per Year

Non-Dormitory Students:

Tuition (full-time with 12-15 hours) $8,100 $16,200

Dormitory Students:

Boatwright, Hawkes, Henry, Pitts, and Turner residents

Tuition (full-time with 12-15 hours)

$8,100

$16,200

Room and Board

$3,337

$6,674

$11,437

$22,874

Dormitory Students:

Candler and Vernon Road residents

Tuition(full-time with 12-15 hours)

$8,100

$16,200

Room and Board

$3,450

$6,900

28

All undergraduate degree-seeking students taking twelve or more hours
who have been residents of the state of Georgia for twelve consecutive
months are eligible to receive a Tuition Equalization Grant (TEG)
regardless of need. The State Legislature establishes the amount of
this grant.

In addition, Georgia students who are entering freshmen as Hope
Scholars (B or better high school grade point average) will receive a
$3,000 academic scholarship per year from the Georgia Hope
Scholarship program as long as a "B or better" average is maintained.
Eligibility is determined every term by the Financial Aid Office.

Fees relating to the Evening and Graduate Programs are included in a
separate bulletin pertaining to those programs. You may contact the
College to receive a copy of those publications.

Federal Tax Credits

The Tax Reform Act of 1997 provided two tax credits for higher
education. The Hope Scholarship Credit provides up to a $1,500 tax
credit for the first two years of postsecondary education in a program
that leads to a degree, certificate, or other recognized educational
credential. The student must be enrolled at least halftime. Qualified
expenses are tuition and fees, and do not include room, board, books,
insurance, and other similar expenses.

The Lifetime Learning Credit provides up to a $2,000 per year tax credit
per family after the first two years of higher education. These tax
credits are phased out as the modified adjusted gross income exceeds

! certain limits. Please check with your tax advisor regarding these limits.

, For additional information about these credits, please consult the

| Business Office or your tax preparer.

Miscellaneous

Depending upon individual requirements, a student may expect to spend
I $750 to $1,000 per year on books and personal expenses.

The above charges are applicable to an academic year of two semesters.
; Summer term charges and Interim Term fees, and curriculum, are
available in separate bulletins.

Nursing students should consult the Nursing Division concerning
required nursing supplies and their projected costs.

All students must present the College with a proof of health insurance at
the time of registration and complete a waiver form including provider

29

name and policy number. If the student does not have insurance, the
College will assess the student for a limited coverage group sickness and
accident insurance policy.

Official transcripts and diplomas are withheld for any student who has a
financial obligation owed to the College.

Credit Balances

Students who have a credit balance on their student accounts receivable
may obtain a credit balance refund within fourteen (14) calendar days
whichever is the latest of:

the date the balance occurs,

the first day of classes of a payment period or enrollment period,
as applicable, or

the date the student rescinds authorization given the school to
hold the funds.

Refund and Repayment Policies

No refund of any nature will be made to any student who is suspended
or dismissed for disciplinary reasons.

No refund will be made for individual courses dropped after the end of
the drop/add period as established by the school calendar.

Refunds will be processed within thirty (30) days of notification of a
Complete Withdrawal. A Complete Withdrawal date is defined by:

the earlier of date student began school's withdrawal process or
date student otherwise provided "official" notice; or

if student did not notify school, the midpoint in the term; or the
date of student's last attendance at documented academically-
related activity, or

if student did not notify due to circumstances beyond student's
control, date related to that circumstance.

Refund Policies - Tuition and Fees

A student withdrawing from the College must submit a Complete
Withdrawal Form, which is available in the Registrar's Office.
The student should also consult the Financial Aid Office and the
Business Office to determine the financial consequences of a
Complete Withdrawal.

30

The Department of Education requires all unearned Title IV funds to be
returned to the program from which such aid was awarded. The College
will credit a student's account for all unearned institutional charges.
The Department of Education defines institutional charges as "all
charges for tuition, fees, and room and board, and expenses for required
course materials, if the student does not have a real and reasonable
opportunity to purchase the required course materials from any place but
the school."

In the event of a Complete Withdrawal from the College, refunds of
institutional charges will be calculated as follows: The College
calculates the amount of federal grant and loan funds the student has
earned during the term by dividing the number of days a student actually
completes by the total number of days within the term (excluding breaks
of five days or more). The resulting percentage is multiplied by the
amount of federal funds that were applied to the student's account. This
is the amount the student actually earned. The remainder is returned to
the federal program. If the resulting percentage is 60 percent or greater,
the student would be entitled to 100 percent of the federal funds.
Tuition credits will be applied to the student's account in the same
manner as the return of federal funds. After the student has completed
60 percent of the term, there will be no refund of institutional charges.

In certain cases, these refund requirements may leave an indebtedness
on the student's account. This may also require the student to reimburse
the Department of Education for some or all of the applicable Federal
Pell and SEOG funds. It is therefore imperative that the students fully
discuss the ramifications of a Complete Withdrawal with the Financial
Aid Office prior to making a final decision.

A student will not receive a refund until all financial aid programs have
been reimbursed. Refunds will be returned in the order indicated below:

Unsubsidized Federal Stafford Loan Program

Subsidized Federal Stafford Loan Program

Federal Perkins Loan Program

Federal PLUS Program

Federal Pell Grant Program

Federal SEOG Program

Other Title IV Programs

Other state, private, or institutional assistance programs

To the student

31

Refund Policies - Room and Board

If a student does not enroll, the room deposit is refundable if the student
notifies the College of his/her cancellation by May 1st. There is no
refund of room deposits after this date. No refund of room or board will
be made if a student withdraws from the dormitory after registration. In
the event of a Complete Withdrawal from the College, there is no refund
of ROOM charges. The BOARD charges will be prorated at $15 per day
from the move-in date.

Student Repayment Policy

Students who receive cash disbursements after registration for that
enrollment period will be assessed liability for repayment of the
appropriate percentage of the refund due the Title IV programs upon
withdrawal, expulsion, or suspension.

Students who receive cash disbursements that are attributable to Federal
Pell or SEOG programs may owe a repayment of these funds to the
College to prevent an overpayment. A student who owes a repayment
will be deemed ineligible for any financial assistance from any source
until the student has resolved the overpayment. Repayments will be
allocated to the student aid programs in the following order: Pell Grant,
SEOG, other Title IV programs, and then to the institution.

Students have 45 days from the date of their notification to make
arrangements for repayment of the aid received. If they fail to make
satisfactory arrangements within the 45-day time period, the account
will be submitted to the Department of Education and the student
could lose future eligibility for financial aid programs.

32

Financial Aid

Philosophy

Recognizing the significant investment students and families make when
choosing a private college, LaGrange College offers a variety of
assistance and payment options. We expect students and families to use
a combination of scholarships, grants, loans and work to meet college
costs. These resources may come from family, college, community, and
state or federal sources. Payment plans are available to distribute
required payments over the course of an academic year or for longer
terms using PLUS loans. We encourage students to apply for financial
aid and scholarships as early as possible to maximize eligibility to all
types of assistance.

Financial Aid Eligibility Requirements

In general, to be eligible for financial assistance, the applicant must:

Be a U.S. Citizen or permanent resident alien of the United States.

Be admitted or currently enrolled in an approved degree-seeking or
teacher certification program.

Have a high school diploma or a General Education Development
(GED) Certification, or pass an approved Ability-to-Benefit test.

Be making Satisfactory Academic Progress towards the completion
of their degree program.

Not be in default on any federal educational loan or have made
satisfactory arrangements to repay the loan.

Not owe a refund on a federal or state grant.

Not have borrowed in excess of federal loan limits.

Be registered with Selective Service, if required.

Financial Aid Application Procedures

applicants for financial aid must:

Apply and be admitted as a degree-seeking student in an eligible
program at LaGrange College.

Complete and submit a Free Application for Federal Student Aid
(FAFSA) or a Renewal FAFSA annually.

33

Complete a Georgia Tuition Equalization Grant Application, if
applicable.

Submit all required documents for verification, if selected.

Determining Financial Need

Students seeking financial assistance must complete the federal need
analysis form, the Free Application for Federal Student Aid (FAFSA).
The FAFSA collects parental and student income and asset information
needed to determine eligibility for financial aid. This information is
used in a federal need analysis formula to determine the Expected
Family Contribution (EFC).

The Financial Aid Office establishes a Cost of Attendance Budget each
year. The Cost of Attendance Budget includes tuition, fees, room,
board, books, supplies, and living expenses. Other components of the
Cost of Attendance, which is applied on an individual basis, are
childcare expenses, study abroad, and the purchase of a computer.
These items may require documentation from the student. Below is the
Cost of Attendance Budgets for the 2005-2006 academic year.

Dependent Undergraduate Day Program $26,150

Independent Undergraduate Day Program $26,900

Dependent Undergraduate Nursing Program $30,910

Independent Undergraduate Nursing Program $3 1 ,660

The Expected Family Contribution (EFC) is deducted from the Cost of
Attendance at LaGrange College to determine whether a need for
financial assistance exists. If the family's EFC is less than the Cost of
Attendance, a financial need is established. The Financial Aid Office
attempts to meet the demonstrated financial need of applicants with
federal, state, and institutional grants and scholarships, work programs,
and student loans.

SATISFACTORY ACADEMIC PROGRESS

The United States Department of Education requires institutions of
higher education to establish a satisfactory academic progress policy to
be applied to all recipients of federal financial aid. Satisfactory
academic progress means the student is progressing in a manner
consistent with fulfilling their degree or certification requirements.
Satisfactory academic progress is evaluated throughout the course of the
degree program. A Satisfactory Academic Progress policy must include

34

two components: qualitative and quantitative. Qualitative measures
cumulative grade point average. Quantitative measures the number or
percentage of courses completed. The quantitative component also
establishes the maximum time frame for completing a degree program.
Financial aid recipients must meet both of these standards to receive
financial aid.

The standards established in the Satisfactory Academic Progress policy
apply to the following financial aid programs: Federal Pell Grant,
Federal Supplemental Educational Opportunity Grant (FSEOG), Federal
Perkins Loan, Federal Stafford Loan (subsidized and unsubsidized),
Federal Parent Loan for Undergraduate Students (PLUS), Federal Work
Study, HOPE Scholarship, Georgia Tuition Equalization Grant (GTEG),
Georgia LEAP, State Service Cancelable Loans, LaGrange College
Grant, Lettie Pate Whitehead Grant, Clark and Ruby Baker Grant, all
LaGrange College Academic and Merit scholarships, and LaGrange
College Work Aid.

Note: HOPE scholarship guidelines require a cumulative grade point
average of 3.0 to maintain eligibility.

Qualitative Standard

Federal regulations require a student to have a grade point average that
is consistent with the institution's policy governing academic progress.
LaGrange College has set the following minimum grade point average
requirements. The Registrar and Academic Dean monitor this
component of the policy each term.

Classification

Minimum Cumulative Grade Point Average

Freshman

1.65

Sophomore

1.75

Junior

1.85

Senior

2

Quantitative Standard

Students receiving funds from any of the financial programs covered
under this policy must demonstrate measurable progress toward the
completion of their degree program. LaGrange College requires students
to successfully complete 67% of the credit hours for which the student

35

enrolls each academic term. The credit hours considered under
this policy will be those for which the student is registered at the
conclusion of late registration. Grades of A, B, C, or D are considered
as successful completion of a course. Grades of F, W, WF, NR, or I are
considered failing and do not count as successfully completed courses.
Audited courses are not considered in either the quantitative or
qualitative standards.

Maximum Time Frame

Federal regulations allow a student to receive financial assistance for no
more than 150% of the credit hours required to complete the degree
program. Therefore, students pursuing a bachelor's degree must
complete their program within 162 attempted semester credit hours.
Most students will complete the program within the time frame.
However, frequent withdrawals from courses or school, change of
major, failed courses, repeated courses, or courses taken that are
not related to your degree program could jeopardize financial aid
eligibility. All attempted hours are considered when reviewing
maximum time frame.

Transfer students must complete their program within a maximum of
162 attempted semester credit hours. Hours transferred to and accepted
by LaGrange College from other institutions are considered in the
maximum time frame. For example, if a student has 75 credit hours
acceptable towards their degree program, the student may receive
financial assistance for 87 additional credit hours.

Students pursuing an additional bachelor's degree are allowed an
additional 60 semester hours to complete the degree.

Evaluation

The cumulative academic history of all financial aid recipients is
reviewed each term to determine if the student is meeting the
quantitative, qualitative and time frame standards. This includes all
courses attempted regardless of whether financial aid was received or
not. Transfer grade point averages are not considered in either of these
standards. However, accepted transfer credit hours will be considered in
the maximum time frame for completing a degree program. Students
who fail to meet both of these standards will be placed on financial aid
probation. Students placed on financial aid probation are eligible for
financial aid during the probationary term. If the student does not meet
the satisfactory academic progress standards at the end of the
probationary term, future financial aid will be terminated effective with

36

the next term of enrollment. Students whose financial aid is terminated
may appeal to the Financial Aid Appeals Committee for re-instatement
of financial aid. The chart below indicates the minimum credits a
student must earn to meet the quantitative standard.

Total Attempted Hours

Minimum Earned

40
60
80
100
120

Appeal Process

Student financial aid recipients who lose their eligibility for financial aid
may appeal in writing to the Financial Aid Appeals Committee except
for loss of eligibility due to time frame. Appeals must be submitted in
writing to the Director of Financial Aid outlining any mitigating
circumstance(s) that influenced the student's academic performance,

I documentation of circumstance(s), if applicable, and the manner by
which the deficiency will be resolved. The Director will convene the
Financial Aid Appeals Committee to evaluate the request for
reinstatement of financial aid eligibility. The Director of Financial Aid

i will notify the student in writing of the decision of the Committee and
any conditions associated with reinstatement. Students whose appeals
are approved will receive financial aid on probationary status for the
next term of enrollment and will have their academic performance
reviewed at the end of that term for continued eligibility.

Student Financial Aid Policies

Financial aid applications for the up coming academic year are
available beginning January 1 in the financial aid office or on the
web at www.lagrange.edu/finaid.htm by clicking on "Apply for
Financial Aid."

Due to the demand for financial assistance, the Financial Aid
Office awards aid to eligible students on a first-come, first-served
basis. In awarding, first priority is given to students pursuing their

37

first undergraduate degree. Transient, non-degree seeking, and
unclassified students are not eligible for financial assistance.

All financial aid applications and documentation for verification
must be submitted before an official financial aid award letter

is mailed.

In constructing a financial aid award, funding is awarded in this order:
grants and scholarships, student loans, and student employment.

External sources of financial aid available to a financial aid
recipient must be considered in the awarding of Federal, State, and
LaGrange College need-based financial aid programs. LaGrange
College reserves the right to cancel or reduce financial aid awards
in the event that these resources result in financial aid in excess of
financial need.

Financial aid awards are made assuming full-time enrollment.
Most LaGrange College and state financial aid programs require
full-time enrollment. However, financial assistance is available to
students enrolled at least half-time.

A student's enrollment status will be based on the credit hours for
which the student is registered at the conclusion of late registration.
All financial aid awards will be calculated using final registration
information. If it is later determined that attendance in all or some
courses cannot be documented, financial aid awards will be
adjusted and any ineligible funds must be repaid by the student.

Financial aid awards will be disbursed on the first day of
classes provided all required documents and eligibility
requirements are met.

Sources of Financial Aid

There are a variety of financial aid resources available to assist students
with funding their college education. These resources are in the form of
scholarships, grants, loans, or student employment and are made
possible by funding from federal, state, and institutional sources.
Although financial need is a primary factor in financial aid eligibility,
there are financial aid programs available to students who do not
demonstrate financial need. These programs may be awarded based on
residency, merit, academic excellence, talent, and or criteria.

38

LaGrange College Academic Scholarships

Presidential Scholarship is a four-year, renewable academic
scholarship awarded to incoming freshmen on the basis of academic
achievement in high school, SAT or ACT test scores, and interviews
with the Scholarship Selection Committee at the Scholar Weekend
Competition. Recipients of this prestigious award receive full tuition,
mandatory fees, room, and board.

The Founders Scholarship is a four-year, renewable academic
scholarship awarded to incoming freshmen on the basis of academic
achievement in high school and SAT or ACT test scores. The annual
scholarship award is $8,000 for freshmen enrolling fall 2005.

The LaFayette Scholarship is a four-year, renewable academic
scholarship awarded to incoming freshmen on the basis of academic
achievement in high school and SAT or ACT test scores. The annual
scholarship award is $6000 for freshmen enrolling fall 2005.

The Quadrangle Scholarship is a four-year, renewable academic
scholarship awarded to incoming freshmen on the basis of academic
achievement in high school and SAT or ACT test scores. The annual
scholarship amount is $4500 for freshmen enrolling fall 2005.

The Hilltop Scholarship is a four-year, renewable academic
scholarship awarded to incoming freshmen on the basis of academic
achievement in high school and SAT or ACT test scores. The annual
scholarship amount is $3000 for freshmen enrolling fall 2005.

LaGrange College HOPEMatch is awarded to enrolling freshmen,
beginning with Fall 2002, who graduate from high school as a HOPE
Scholar or from an out of state high school with a 3.0 or better grade
point average. The award is a maximum of $3,000 per year. Students
awarded academic scholarships will receive the greater of the
HOPEMatch or the academic award.

LaGrange College Fine Arts Scholarships are scholarships awarded to
students who excel in the areas of Art and Design, Music, and Theatre
Arts. Scholarships are awarded based on academic promise, audition and
portfolio. The departments' Scholarship Committee determines
scholarship recipients. Auditions or portfolio reviews are required.

Sandra Kratina Nursing Scholarship is a renewable academic
scholarship awarded to students pursuing careers in Nursing.
Scholarships are awarded based on academic excellence, promise,
character and interview. The Division of Nursing determines
scholarship recipients.

39

Phi Theta Kappa Scholarship is a two-year, renewable academic
scholarship awarded to qualified transfer students who are U.S. citizens
or permanent resident aliens fully inducted into Phi Theta Kappa
Honor Society. Recipients must hold Associates of Arts or Associate
of Science degrees from an accredited two-year college and have
earned a minimum grade point average of 3.5. This scholarship is
$6,000 annually.

Transfer Scholarships are awarded to students transferring to
LaGrange College from a college or university with a minimum of 30
semester hours and a minimum grade point average of 3.0 or higher.
The number and amount of scholarships varies.

Troup County Scholarship is a four-year, renewable academic
scholarship awarded to incoming freshmen who reside in Troup County
and have a 3.0 or better high school grade point average, a SAT score of
1000 or ACT score of 22 or better. The Office of Admission determines
the recipients of this scholarship.

LaGrange College Methodist Scholarships are available to active
members of the United Methodist Church. These scholarships are non-
need based and are awarded based on academic excellence, church
activities, essay and recommendation from the minister. The Office of
Admission determines the recipients of this scholarship.

Federal Financial Aid Programs

Federal Pell Grant is awarded to undergraduate students pursuing a
first bachelor's degree. The student's Expected Family Contribution,
Cost of Attendance, and enrollment status determines the Pell award.
Students enrolling less than full-time qualify for a prorated amount of
Pell Grant based on their enrollment status.

Federal Supplemental Educational Opportunity Grant is awarded to
undergraduate students with exceptional financial need. Priority is
given to students eligible for Federal Pell Grant.

Federal Work-Study provides employment opportunities for
undergraduate and graduate students with financial need to defray
educational expenses. Jobs are available on campus and off-campus in
community service activities. Students are paid at least the federal
minimum wage rate and are paid monthly.

Federal Perkins Loan is a low interest, repayable loan awarded to
undergraduate and graduate students with exceptional financial need.
The interest rate is 5% and no interest accrues on the loan while the

40

borrower is enrolled half-time and during the grace period. Repayment
i begins nine months after graduating or withdrawal from school. This
j loan program has cancellation provisions for critical fields of study.

Contact the Financial Aid Office for more information.

Federal Stafford Loan is a low interest, repayable loan available to
undergraduate and graduate students regardless of income. The interest
rate is variable but will not exceed 8.25%. Federal Stafford Loans have
a six (6) month grace period before repayment begins with a standard
repayment period often (10) years. Loans are available through banks,
credit unions, and other lending institutions. The Stafford Loan
Program is composed of two loan types, subsidized and unsubsidized. A
subsidized loan is awarded on the basis of financial need. Subsidized
loan borrowers will not pay interest on the loan while enrolled in school,
during the grace period or during authorized periods of deferment. The
federal government pays the interest. An unsubsidized loan is not
awarded on the basis of financial need. Any student regardless of
income may participate in this loan program. However, interest does
accrue while the student is enrolled in school, during the grace period,
and during periods of deferment. The borrower has the options of paying
the accrued interest or having the interest capitalized. Capitalization
j adds the interest to the principal amount of your loan. This option will
increase your loan indebtedness.

The annual maximum awards from the Federal Stafford Loan Program
are based on the borrower's classification and dependency status.

Federal Parent Loan for Undergraduate Students (PLUS) is

available to the parents of a dependent student to defray remaining
educational expenses after all other financial aid resources are
exhausted. Eligible applicants may borrower up to the cost of
attendance less other financial aid. The interest rate will not exceed 9%.
Unlike the Federal Stafford Loan program, PLUS borrowers must be
credit worthy to qualify for this loan and repayment begins within 60
days of the loan disbursement. If the parent borrower is denied a
PLUS, the borrower may appeal to the lender if an extenuating
circumstance exists.

State of Georgia Student Financial
Assistance Programs

The State of Georgia provides several financial aid programs to assist
residents of Georgia. Recipients of these programs must meet financial

41

aid eligibility and Georgia residency requirements. An applicant for
financial aid will be considered a resident of Georgia if he/she can
demonstrate that he or she has physically resided in the state for twelve
consecutive months prior to the term that state financial assistance is
sought and can provide documentation of intent to remain indefinitely.
Acceptable documentation of intent to remain indefinitely includes but
is not limited to a Georgia driver's license, voter registration card,
automobile registration or other definitive evidence. Residency is
established twelve months from the date the documentation was issued.
The residency of the supporting parent drives the residency of a
dependent student. The Director of Financial Aid makes final
determination of residency.

Georgia LEAP Grant is a State of Georgia need-based grant awarded
to Georgia residents who qualify for Federal Pell Grant and have
substantial financial need. The annual amount is contingent upon
appropriations by Congress and the Georgia Legislature.

Georgia Tuition Equalization Grant is a non-need-based grant
awarded to Georgia residents attending a private college or university as
a full-time student. The annual amount is contingent upon funding by
the Georgia Legislature.

The HOPE Scholarship Program is a lottery-funded scholarship for
Georgia residents who graduate from high school with a 3.0 or better
grade point average in specific academic courses as reported by their
high school. A HOPE Scholar is eligible for $1,500 per semester as a
full-time student. Effective fall 2004, HOPE Scholars at private
colleges and universities enrolled half-time are eligible for $750 per
semester. HOPE Scholars must maintain a 3.0 or better grade point
average for continued eligibility. HOPE Scholars are evaluated at
increments of 30, 60, and 90 semester hours for continued eligibility. In
addition to these evaluation points, effective spring 2005, all HOPE
Scholars will be evaluated each spring semester regardless of whether an
evaluation point has been reached for continued HOPE Scholarship
eligibility. Students who did not graduate from high school as a HOPE
Scholar may become eligible for the HOPE Scholarship after completing
30, 60, or 90 semester hours. This is provided the student's cumulative
grade point average is a 3.0 or better and the student is a Georgia
resident at the time the student becomes eligible for the HOPE
Scholarship. The calculation of grade point averages for HOPE purposes
must include all courses attempted since their high school graduation.

42

HOPE Promise Scholarship provides forgivable loans to
undergraduate students who plan to teach in Georgia upon
completing their education degree. Applicants must be of junior
standing with a 3.0 or better grade point average. Georgia residency
or full-time attendance is not a requirement.

Law Enforcement Personnel Dependents Grants provides non-
repayable grants of up to $2,000 per year to eligible Georgia
residents who are dependent children of Georgia law enforcement
officers, prison guards, or firemen who were permanently disabled or
killed in the line of duty.

Service Cancelable Stafford Loans provide forgivable Stafford
loans to Georgia residents who are pursuing degrees in areas where
there is a critical shortage of qualified professionals. The terms and
conditions of a service cancelable loan are the same as for a Federal
Stafford loan except the student may cancel the loan in full by
working one year at an approved Georgia location for each academic
year funding was received. The cancellation benefit will be principal
i and accrued interest. The only approved critical field at LaGrange
College is nursing. Funding in this program is limited. Awards are
made on a first-come, first-serve basis.

LaGrange College Financial
Assistance Programs

LaGrange College assists students in defraying the cost of attending our
institution by offering institutional grants, scholarships and student
employment to eligible students.

LaGrange College Grant is available to undergraduate degree seeking
students enrolled full-time. Eligibility is based on financial need and
academic promise. Recipients of this grant assistance must be in good
academic standing.

Lettie Pate Whitehead Grant is available to female students enrolled
full-time with financial need. Eligible recipients must reside in Georgia,
Alabama, South Carolina, Tennessee, Florida, Mississippi, or Louisiana.
The funds are made possible by an annual gift from the Lettie Pate
Whitehead Foundation.

LaGrange College Methodist Scholarships are available to active
members of the United Methodist Church. These scholarships are non-

43

need based and are awarded based on academic excellence, church
activities, essay, and recommendation from the minister.

LaGrange College Work Aid Program provides students, regardless
of financial need, with opportunities to earn additional money for
school through employment in campus departments and community
service activities.

Student Financial Aid and Federal Tax
Implications

Students receiving scholarships and grants that exceed their tuition, fees,
books and supplies should be aware that these funds are taxable under
federal and state tax law. It is important that students maintain records of
their grants and scholarships and documentation of educational expenses
for reporting purposes.

Federal tax law allows for only qualified scholarships and grants to be
excluded from income. Qualified scholarships are any amount of grant
and scholarship received that is used for tuition, fees, books, supplies
and equipment required for course instruction. Scholarships and grants
that are specifically designated for educational expenses other than those
described under qualified scholarships (room, board, transportation, or
living expenses) are taxable.

For information, please read IRS Publication 520, "Scholarships and
Fellowships," for more details on reporting requirements or consult a
tax professional.

Suspected Fraud

Institutions are required to report cases of suspected fraud to the Office
of the Inspector General of the Department of Education, or, if more
appropriate, to the state or local law enforcement agency having
jurisdiction to investigate these allegations. Fraud may exist if the
institution believes the applicant misreported or altered information in
order to increase their financial aid eligibility or fraudulently obtained
federal funds.

44

Student Life

The Student Life staff is concerned with providing those services which
assist individuals in their personal growth. Their purpose is to provide
assistance which facilitates the development of the total person. At
LaGrange College, the emphasis is upon the intellectual, social, physical
and spiritual development of each student.

Student Life involves a wide variety of programs and activities. The broad
range of available services is an outgrowth of complex student needs:
orientation, activities, student government, organizations, health services,
wellness programs, parking, food service, discipline, leadership
development, personal counseling, career development and placement,
fraternities and sororities, and all residence programming. The Student
Life staff is committed to creating a positive climate within which personal
growth and development occur.

Student Conduct

! LaGrange College, as a church-related college, is committed to an
honorable and seemly standard of conduct. As an educational institution
; the College is concerned not only with the formal in-class education of
| its students, but also with their welfare and their growth into mature
men and women who conduct themselves responsibly as citizens.

| Regulations of the College are formulated to meet changing student
needs within the framework of college policy. These regulations become
I effective when the student enrolls. Some regulations may not be
) agreeable to everyone because they have been formulated to meet the
( needs of the entire group. This however, does not lessen the individual's
I obligation to uphold them. Regulations do not have as their primary
purpose the punishment of the individual. The regulations are formulated
I to insure the right of all community members to have the best possible

; living and learning conditions.

i

j The College reserves the right to dismiss at any time a student who, in its
judgment, is undesirable and whose continuation in the school is
detrimental to himself or his fellow student.

1 Furthermore, students are subject to federal, state and local laws as well
| as College rules and regulations. A student is not entitled to greater
] immunities before the law than those enjoyed by other citizens generally.
Students are subject to such disciplinary action as the administration of
I the College may consider appropriate, including possible suspension and
; expulsion for breach of federal, state or local laws, or College

45

regulations. This principle extends to conduct off campus which is likely
to have adverse effect on the College or on the educational process or
which stamps the offender as an unfit associate for the other students. A
complete description of student conduct policies, rules and regulations
can be found in the Student Handbook, which is published in the Panther
Planner each year.

Statement of Policy on Harassment

All members of the college community have the right to be free from
discrimination in the form of harassment. Harassment may take two
forms: (1 ) creating a hostile environment, and (2) quid pro quo .

A hostile, demeaning, or intimidating environment created by
harassment interferes with an individual's full and free participation in
the life of the College.

Quid pro quo occurs when a position of authority is used to threaten to
impose a penalty or to withhold a benefit in return for sexual favors,
whether or not the attempt is successful. Sexual harassment may
involve behavior by a person of either gender against a person of the
same or opposite gender. It should be noted that the potential of
sexual harassment exists in any of the following relationships:
student/student, faculty/student, student/faculty, and faculty/faculty.
Here and subsequently "faculty" refers to faculty, staff, and
administration. Because of the inherent differential in power between
faculty and students, sexual relationships between faculty and students
are prohibited.

Sexual harassment may result from many kinds of behavior. These
behaviors may range from the most egregious forms, such as sexual
assault, to more subtle forms. Explicit behaviors include but are not
limited to requests for sexual favors, physical assaults of a sexual nature,
sexually offensive remarks, and rubbing, touching or brushing against
another's body. More subtle behaviors may be experienced as
intimidating or offensive, particularly when they recur or one person has
authority over another. Such behaviors may include but are not limited
to unwelcome hugs or touching, inappropriate staring, veiled suggestions
of sexual activity, requests for meetings in non-academic settings, and
risque jokes, stories, or images.

Accusations of harassment which are made without good cause shall not be
condoned. Such accusations are indeed grievous and can have damaging
and far-reaching effects upon the careers and lives of individuals.

46

Any member of the college community having a complaint of
harassment may raise the matter informally and/or file a formal
complaint. The informal process is an attempt to mediate between the
parties in order to effect a mutually agreeable solution without entering
into the formal hearing process.

A. Informal Procedures

The following informal procedures may be followed:

Clearly say "no" to the person whose behavior is unwelcome.

Communicate either orally or in writing with the person whose
behavior is unwelcome. The most effective communication will
have three elements:

a factual description of the incident(s) including the time, place,
date, and specific behavior,

a description of the complainant's feelings, including any
consequences of the incident,

a request that the conduct cease.

Speak with a department chair, dean, director, counselor, or
chaplain who may speak to the person whose behavior is
unwelcome. The name of the complainant need not be disclosed.
The purpose of such conversation is the cessation of the
unwelcome behavior.

In the case of harassment of a student, it may be appropriate first
to seek the advice of his or her advisor.

B. Formal Procedures

To initiate a formal grievance procedure the complainant shall submit a
written statement to the President of the College. The President, after
such consultation as is deemed appropriate, will appoint a three-member
Review Committee from among the membership of the Institutional
Planning Council, the Academic Council, or other College committees
as the President deems appropriate. Members of the Review Committee
will then meet to discuss the complaint. Unless the Committee
concludes that the complaint is without merit, the parties to the dispute
will be invited to appear before the Committee and to confront any
adverse witnesses. The Committee may conduct its own inquiry, call
witnesses, and gather whatever information it deems necessary to assist
in reaching a determination as to the merits of the accusation. Once a
determination has been reached, the Committee shall report its findings
to the President of the College.

47

Possible outcomes of the investigation are (1) that the allegation is not
warranted and cannot be substantiated, (2) a negotiated settlement of the
complaint, or (3) that the allegation is substantiated requiring a
recommendation to the President that disciplinary action be taken.

C. Faculty

In the case of a faculty member subject to the provisions of the Parts A
or B of the 1977 tenure settlement, the Tenure Committee will be
involved. Discipline or dismissal of a faculty member will follow the
procedure outlined in the LaGrange College Tenure Regulations.

For those faculty members subject to the provisions of the 1999 tenure
policy, the Promotion and Tenure Committee will be involved according
to the procedures defined in the 1999 tenure policy.

D. Appeals

Faculty, staff, administration, and students can appeal a final decision
regarding a complaint to the Executive Committee of the Board
of Trustees.

E. Special Circumstances

If the President of the College is the accused, the case is referred to the
Executive Committee of the Board of Trustees.

If the chairperson of the Review Committee is the accused, the
complaint shall be submitted to the President of the College. If any
member of the Review Committee is the accused or for reason of
prejudice must be recused, the President of the College shall appoint
another member.

F. Confidentiality

The right to confidentiality of all members of the college community
will be respected in both formal and informal procedures insofar
as possible.

LaGrange College is committed to preventing harassment. To that end,
this policy and these procedures will be printed in appropriate College
publications. In addition, educational programs will be conducted
annually by the College to (1) inform students, faculty, staff, and
administration about identifying harassment and the problems it causes;
(2) advise members of the college community about their rights and
responsibilities under this policy; (3) train personnel in the
administration of this policy. The Harassment Policy and Procedures
will be issued to all incoming students and personnel.

48

Aims of Student Development Services

To facilitate the transition from high school to college.

To develop and sustain through student-involvement activities,
organizations and services a campus life encouraging the cultural,
intellectual, social, physical and religious development of all
students.

To assist students in discovering life goals and exploring career
opportunities.

To create an environment which stimulates qualities of self-
discipline and personal responsibility.

To provide a suitable context whereby the student can explore new
ideas, skills and life styles, thus gaining the insight and experience
necessary to make intelligent choices.

To provide opportunity for the student to develop the understanding
and skills required for responsible participation in a democratic
community through involvement in self-government.

To serve a supervisory role in campus disciplinary concerns; to
develop, with campus community involvement, and to distribute the
necessary rules and regulations for a harmonious and productive
college community.

To mediate, where necessary, conflicts between individuals and
campus community standards.

To provide a comfortable, clean, safe environment that enhances the
personal growth as well as the academic pursuits of resident
students.

To collect retention data and to suggest/plan programs and
strategies to increase retention based on data collected.

Residence Programs
Resident Classification

All traditional day students taking eight or more hours are required to
live in college housing, so long as appropriate campus housing is
available. The Dean of Students may exempt a student for one of the
following reasons:

1. The student is married.

49

2. The student is residing exclusively with parents or legal guardian
in the parent's primary residence within a thirty-mile radius of
the College.

Students are assigned rooms of their choice in so far as facilities
permit. Generally, freshmen are assigned to double rooms in
Boatwright (men) and Pitts or Hawkes Hall (women). Roommates
are assigned by mutual preference whenever possible. The College
reserves the right of approval of all room and residence hall
assignments. Also, the College reserves the right to move a student
from one room or residence hall to another room or residence hall
during the year. Resident students are required to subscribe to the
board plan.

Room Deposit

A room and tuition deposit of $200 is required of all resident students.
The room deposit ($100) is not a prepayment to be applied to residence
hall charges but will remain on deposit with the College to be refunded,
provided the student's account with the College is cleared, upon one of
the following: (1) change of status from resident student to commuter
student, (2) formal withdrawal, or (3) graduation. The room
reservation/damage deposit serves as a room reservation while the
student is not occupying college housing and is refundable if a student
cancels his/her reservation by the following dates: May 1 for fall
semester, December 1 for spring semester. It serves as a damage deposit
while the student is occupying college housing and is refundable when
the student leaves the College housing minus any unpaid assessments
and/or any debt owed to the College. Complete residence information
and regulations can be found in the Student Handbook.

Residence Hall Activities

Residence Advisors also function as a governing body and coordinating
committee. They plan activities within the residence halls such as
cookouts, movie nights, decorating contests and other special events.

Student Government and Other
Organizations

The Student Government Association exists to serve as a medium for
student expressions, to coordinate campus activities, to promote good
citizenship and to govern within the parameters granted by the
President of the College. The SGA is an important part of student life.
Upon acceptance into the College, a student automatically becomes a

50

member of the association. All students are encouraged to become
i active members, so that the association is a truly representative body of
I student thought and opinion, voicing the needs and concerns of the

student body.

The SGA is charged with responsibility of planning and presenting
student programs. They sponsor concerts, dances, movies, and many
other special events.

Student publications are supported by the LaGrange College; these
include The Hilltop News, a student-produced newspaper, and The
Scroll, and annual creative arts magazine.

Traditional Activities

Homecoming Fall weekend featuring a concert, a

parade various alumni activities and
culminating with crowning of Queen.

May Day Step sing and concert

Greek Week Week of activities centering around campus

Greek life

Quadrangle Dance Spring Formal scheduled around
Valentine's Day

There are numerous activities planned by the SGA and the Programming
Board. Please consult the Student Handbook for specific dates.

All clubs and organizations are sanctioned by LaGrange College. These
include:

Social Sororities

Alpha Omicron
PiKappa
DeltaPhi Mu

Service Clubs

Hilltoppers

The Environmental Club

Habitat for Humanity

Religious Organizations

Baptist Student Union
Interfaith Council
Wesley Fellowship

Social Fraternities

Delta Tau Delta
Kappa Sigma
Pi Kappa Phi

Student Publications

The Hilltop News (newspaper)
The Scroll (magazine)

51

Fellowship for Christian Athletes

Honorary Organizations

Alpha Psi Omega (drama)

Delta Mu Delta (business administration)

Lambda Alpha Epsilon (social work)

Phi Alpha Theta (history)

Omicron Delta Kappa (leadership)

Omicron Delta Epsilon (economics)

Psi Chi (psychology)

Sigma Tau Delta (English)

Phi Eta Omega (pre-health professions)

Kappa Delta Pi (Education Honor Society)

CRIS- Campus Recreation Interest Groups and Intramural Sports

Student Nurses Association

Art Student League

Business and Economics Society

Student Education Association

Association of Computer Machinery

The Student Handbook is published by the Student Development
Office and contains guidelines and regulations for successful
campus life. It appears in each year's Panther Planner.

Programs, Exhibitions and Forum Lectures

A balanced and comprehensive program of lectures, music
performances, dramatic presentations, workshops and other activities
contribute to student enrichment. Tuesdays and Thursdays from 11:15
a.m. until 12:20 p.m. are reserved for programs, exhibitions, and
forum lectures.

Athletic Program

LaGrange College is a member of the NCAA Division III and the Great
South Athletic Conference. College colors are red and black.
Intercollegiate teams compete in women's soccer, basketball, cross
country, volleyball, Softball, swimming and tennis, and men's baseball,
basketball, cross country, golf, soccer, swimming and tennis. Football
will begin in 2006. It is the philosophy of LaGrange College that the
team participants are attending college primarily for a quality education,
and no athletic scholarships are offered. The coaching staff is a group of
highly qualified teachers who stress the educational aims of the College.

LaGrange College is committed to a full program of non-scholarship
athletics that encourages the student-athlete to reap the benefits of

52

educationally sound activity that encourages and promotes a strong
academic regime. Students are given the opportunity to participate fully
in their given sport and to compete with other teams locally, statewide,
and regionally.

Philosophy Statement for
Intercollegiate Athletics

Intercollegiate athletics at LaGrange College provide students with an
integral complement to their total educational experience. Recognizing
the importance of athletics to the individual student while seeking to
strike an appropriate balance between the life of the mind and
participation in co- curricular offerings, the College is committed to
providing a program of intercollegiate athletics that is student-centered
for both participants and spectators. The College believes that the
primary function of intercollegiate athletics at a small church-related,
liberal arts college is one of a high quality co-curricular complement to
its overall mission. As such, academics have priority over athletic or
other co-curricular pursuits.

LaGrange College seeks to recruit and retain student athletes who
understand the balance of priorities between academics and co-
curricular programs, whether the latter are athletics, the performing arts,
or other student activities. The College employs coaches who
understand that balance of priorities, and its coaches seek to recruit
students who will be successful student-athletes. Because the College
awards no financial aid based upon athletic ability, the aim of student-
athlete recruitment by coaches is not solely for athletic success but
rather for student contribution to the College's enrollment goals,
although by no means do those have to be mutually exclusive.

The College embraces a commitment to instill and develop the values of
superlative ethical conduct and fair play among its athletes, coaches,
spectators, and other constituents. Further, LaGrange College
recognizes that student-athletes are role models to their peers as well as
representatives of the College, and the College actively encourages
student-athletes to conduct themselves in a manner which befits
those roles.

LaGrange College is committed to gender equity and values cultural
diversity. The College will invest sufficient resources to ensure that
medical and athletic training services are available to all athletes at
appropriate times. It shall strive to ensure that all individuals an all
teams are treated with the same level of fairness, resources, and respect
so that all athletes are afforded and an equal opportunity to develop

53

their potential as a student-athlete.

INTRAMURALS

Intramurals provide opportunities for wholesome recreation and
competition among members of the campus community. Teams
representing campus organizations and independents compete in
organized tournaments and events throughout the year. Competitive
events include flag football, volleyball, basketball (regulation, 3 on 3,
H*0*R*S*E), softball, badminton, tennis, water volleyball and Ultimate
Frisbee. Winners of the campus tournaments in some of these events are
eligible to represent LaGrange College in state or regional tournaments.

Many opportunities are available for recreational use of the facilities in
the LaGrange College Aquatics Complex: recreational swimming and
lap swimming all year round in the indoor pool; the aquarius water
work-out stations, water aerobics or aqua exercise or aqua exercise class
(non-credit).

The facilities and equipment of the Physical Education Department also
are available for student recreational use when these are not scheduled
for instructional, athletic, or intramural sports use. The use of outdoor
equipment (canoes, sailboats, backpacks, tents, stoves, lanterns) requires
the payment of a small deposit which is refunded upon the safe return of
the equipment. The fitness center, gymnasium, and pools are available
for student/faculty/staff use during posted hours. A valid LaGrange
College ID is necessary for admittance to all facilities.

Religious Life

College is a point of transition. Regardless of the student's age or
reason for being on campus, college is a turning point. It is a time of
exciting intellectual and social growth. During their collegiate
experiences, students will wrestle with new ideas, discover new
interests, and explore issues of intimacy and identity. In contrast, the
struggle to define identity and personal values is an opportunity for
spiritual growth and faith development. Therefore, Religious Life
programs at LaGrange College offer students a chance to examine their
faith, to assess what is important, and to forge a system of values that
will sustain them through their adult years.

Growing out of its history of service and its affiliation with The United
Methodist Church, LaGrange College is committed to creating a caring
and ethical community that challenges student's minds and inspires their
souls. As a result, the College offers a number of opportunities for

54

students, faculty and staff members to celebrate life and explore God's
I intention for human living. Included in these opportunities are
1 occasions for worship, fellowship, and service. Chapel services are
scheduled every Sunday at 10:00 p.m., and there are special worship
services throughout the year. Book discussion groups and student
forums are scheduled throughout the year. The Alternative Spring
Break Initiative during the College's Spring Break allows interested
students, faculty and staff members to experience life and service in
another culture.

Office of the Chaplain

The College employs a full-time chaplain who is available for
counseling and informal conversation. The Chaplain engages with many
different people throughout the campus community. In all the Chaplain
does, the goal is to enable a clearer understanding of what one believes,
of how one relates to one's own faith and to those of other faiths. As
such, much of the Chaplain's work is done in conversation with
individuals and small groups for questions on matters of faith on
campus; offering liturgical/sacramental services; assisting students with
vocation discernment, and addressing pressing moral, ethical and
theological questions.

Mission of the Chaplain's Office

The mission of the Office of the Chaplain is to lead the members of
the college community in fostering a sustaining vision for a caring
and ethical community through faith development, worship, and
vocational discernment. This vision is manifested by:

Efforts within the college community to discern the ways in which
one is called to respond to his/her individual dreams from God.

Efforts that help students grow as a "sign and instrument" of the
Peaceable Realm for common good.

Efforts to enrich humanity and the world through the articulation of
ethical and religious values and their implications.

Student Health Services

/All students must have proof of medical insurance. For those not having

coverage through individual or group plans, LaGrange College makes

available accident and sickness coverage through a private carrier at

reasonable rates. Application forms are available at registration or

through the Business Office. In order to register for classes, students

must have a medical history form on file with the Student Deans Office.

J

jFor a description of health services available to LaGrange College

students, refer to the Student Handbook.

55

Career Planning and Placement Center

The LaGrange College Career center provides services to students,
alumni and staff. The counselor assists students with the total career
development process.

From their first year at LaGrange College, students are encouraged to
use Center's resources to identify and prioritize their values, interests,
and skills and to recognize the impact they have on career decisions.

The Career Center provides resources to support students in locating
part-time employment, internships, fellowships and graduate
assistantships, summer jobs, and full-time, career employment.
Additional resources and training provide students with job search skills
(resume preparation, interview skills, etc.) as well as graduate school
application skills (e.g., test preparation, online resources).

LaGrange College is a member of the Georgia Consortium of College
which each year provides a Career Fair in Atlanta that enables our
seniors and recent graduates to meet with employers from over one
hundred industries and agencies.

Personal and Academic Counseling

An important part of the philosophy of LaGrange College is that each
student should have advice and counseling throughout his/her academic
career. The counseling office, located at the end of Smith Hall directly
behind the patio, offers a variety of counseling services to assist students
in reaching their academic and personal goals. The counseling office
does this by providing short-term personal counseling in the following
areas: resolving conflicts, adjustment to college life away from home,
relationships with friends and family members, reducing stress, feelings
of depression, eating disorders, and alcohol or substance abuse. The
counseling office also provides study skills workshops, maintains the
campus-tutoring center, and offers one on one academic coaching. In
addition, the counseling office works with students who have
documentation of a learning disability to ensure that the students receive
the accommodations they need to help reach their academic goals. The
counseling office also strives to help students make the most of
themselves as developing persons, to be more effective in their
relationships with others, to understand feelings and behavior, and to
enhance positive traits. Discussions are confidential in keeping with
professional standards.

56

Vehicle Registration

To insure efficient control of traffic and parking on campus and the
safety of all persons and vehicles, every vehicle must be registered and
must have a parking permit. These permits are issued to students,
along with a copy of existing parking regulations. There is a fee.
Failure to adhere to published policies may result in vehicles being
ticketed and/or towed.

Student Appeal of Decisions

Recognizing that decisions must be made and that some students may
feel aggrieved by some decisions, LaGrange College provides the
following procedures:

A student must first attempt to resolve an issue with the college staff
member first rendering a decision. If this does not resolve the issue, a
decision rendered by a college staff member may be appealed by a
student as follows:

I. Student Life:

(a) A disciplinary decision rendered either by a duly constituted
student judicial board or to the Dean of Students. Disciplinary
decisions rendered originally by the Dean of Students may be
appealed in writing to the Vice President and Dean for Student
Life and Retention who shall seek, in an informal conference, to
settle the grievance to the satisfaction of the two parties involved.
If no resolution can be found, the Vice President will deliver

the appeal to the Student Affairs Committee of the faculty for
its determination.

(b) Other grievances in the area of student life may be appealed
to the Dean of Students. If the grievance involves an original
decision rendered by the Dean of Students, the decision may be
appealed as above.

II. Financial Aid. See the Financial Aid Section.

III. Academic Matters. See the Academic Advising Section.

57

Academic Advising

Honor Code

Students at LaGrange College sign the Honor Code, which states,

As a member of the student body of LaGrange College, I
confirm my commitment to the ideals of civility, diversity,
service, and excellence. Recognizing the significance of
personal integrity in establishing these ideals within our
community, I pledge that I will not lie, cheat, steal, nor tolerate
these unethical behaviors in others.

The Honor Council is selected each spring from student candidates by
the outgoing President of the Honor Council, the outgoing President of
the SGA, the Vice President for Academic Affairs and Dean, the
President of the Faculty Assembly, and the Advisor to the Honor
Council. A member of the faculty serves as advisor to the council. Both
members of the faculty and the student body are expected to report any
suspected violation of the Honor Code to the Honor Council, either to
the Vice President for Academic Affairs and Dean or to the President of
the Honor Council. Students who suspect a violation may, in a course-
related case, first report the suspected violation to the course instructor.
(For a complete description of the Honor Code and policies, please see
the Student Handbook.)

The following are examples of violations of the Honor Code:

1 . Lying in any academic matter

2. Cheating by either giving aid to or receiving aid from a student
or other source without the consent of the instructor

3. Plagiarizing (using another's words or ideas without proper
citation)

4. Failure to report a violation of the Honor Code

5. Failure to appear before the Honor Council as requested by
written notice

6. Failure to maintain confidentiality regarding an Honor
Council case

58

Sanctions include the following:

1 . Assigning a grade of zero to the related academic work
(assignments, exams, reports, projects, case studies, etc.)

2. Lowering the final grade in the course by one letter, in a grade-
related offense

3. Assigning a grade of F in the course, in a grade-related offense

4. Suspension for the next semester, either fall or spring; or
suspension for the next semester and an F in the course, in a
grade-related offense; or

5. Dismissal from the College; or dismissal from the College and
an F in the course, in a grade-related offense.

When a student accused of a violation does not appear for a preliminary

interview when notified to do so, a hold will be placed on the student's

transcript. A hold will also be placed on the transcript when the

President of the Honor Council and the Vice President for Academic

Affairs and Dean determine that the case will proceed to a hearing. This

hold will be removed when the case has been resolved.
I

If a case cannot be heard before the end of a grading period, the

instructor will submit the grade of "I" until the Honor Council acts on

the case.

jThe Honor Council reserves the right to conduct a hearing in absentia
when a party to the case fails to appear as directed.

hAn investigation and hearing shall be confidential and those within the
founds of confidentiality shall not divulge anything that is said or done
with regard to these proceedings to anyone outside the bounds of
confidentiality. Should anyone outside the bounds of confidentiality
receive information which is considered to be confidential, he or she
fwill automatically be bound by confidentiality. Those within the
bounds of confidentiality include Council members, the faculty advisor
|to the Council, the Vice President for Academic Affairs and Dean, the
President, accusers, the accused, witnesses, persons interviewed during
the investigation, and the College's attorney. In addition, the accused
may include within the bounds of confidentiality his or her parents,
faculty, staff, minister, personal or legal counsel.

All tests at the College are conducted under the Honor Code.
Accordingly, instructors may leave the room during the examination
and students are on their honor to do their own work. The Honor Code
should be abbreviated on the outside of the test and signed by the

59

student before handing in the examination. Students should leave all
books and materials not pertaining to the test either in the hall outside
the classroom, or next to the wall in front of the classroom. Students
should take the test in the designated classroom, except under
extenuating circumstances or by prior arrangement.

Work prepared out of class should be that of the individual. Any
assistance from fellow students, books, periodicals, or other materials
should be carefully acknowledged. Instructors should give specific
guidance regarding what constitutes a violation of the Honor Code.
If any doubts about plagiarism arise, a question should be raised by
the instructor.

As early as possible in the term, the instructor should make clear to his
or her classes how the specifications of the Honor Code apply to class
requirements. For example, what constitutes a legitimate use of source
material, especially material on the Internet, should be made clear.

Orientation

All new students are introduced to LaGrange College through an
orientation program which takes place during the summer and just
before spring semester. The orientation program is designed to acquaint
the new students with various phases of the life of the College including
traditions, procedures, and regulations. Students profit from a proper
introduction to the opportunities and responsibilities of college life.

One course in particular serves to further the College's orientation and
counseling efforts. Freshman Cornerstone, a course designed to focus
on the valuing and decision-making processes with a particular
emphasis on Christian influences on ethical behavior, facilitates
students' use of skills of comparison, contrast, analysis, and synthesis of
multiple perspectives as they examine an issue of common concern.

The course emphasizes active learning, small group problem solving,
and service learning, including reflection on these experiences. A
laboratory experience associated with the course is designed to identify
and enhance students' abilities. Assessment of abilities as well as
sessions on study skills, career counseling, computer skill, and library
skills, among others, are offered to maximize students' success.

Registration and Advising

All students should register on the dates specified. All registration
procedures for all terms are under the direction of the Vice President for
Academic Affairs and Dean. Students have not completed registration
until they have cleared the Registrar, Office of Student Life and the
60

Business Office. Students enrolled for twelve or more hours must obtain
a campus post office box. Communications to the student will be
through campus email or campus mail.

Each student is assigned to a faculty adviser who assists the student in
planning an academic program. However, the ultimate responsibility for
meeting all requirements rests with the individual student.

A student interested in a particular major should inform his/her general
adviser in order that special prerequisite courses for the major may be
scheduled. A major may be formally declared anytime after the student
has earned 18 hours of credit. The student must declare his/her major
in writing to the Department by the time the student has earned 45
semester hours of credit. The student will then be assigned to an
adviser in the department in which the student will major.

A student's major program requirements are those described in the
College Bulletin at the time of declaration of the major.

Withdrawal

To withdraw from an individual course, a student must confer in the
office of the Registrar. Failure of a student to withdraw officially
through this office may result in the assignment of a "WF." A student
who wishes to withdraw completely from the college must confer with
the Director of Counseling. Except in cases of medical or medical
necessity, withdrawals are not permitted the last week of class.

Medical Withdrawal

Medical withdrawal is defined as complete withdrawal without
academic penalty for reasons of health. Except in circumstances of
emergency, a physician licensed health care provider, or a qualified
counselor must provide a written recommendation for medical
withdrawal to the Vice President for Academic Affairs and Dean. This
iwritten recommendation must be on file prior to approval for
Withdrawal. Anytime medical withdrawal is initiated, the student's
instructors, the Office of Financial Aid, and the Business Office will be
'notified by the Registrar. The re-entry of the student following medical
withdrawal for medical reasons requires a clearance from the attending
physician, licensed health care provider, or a qualified counselor with an
evaluation of the student's potential to resume study successfully at
LaGrange College. The Vice President for Academic Affairs and Dean
will review this evaluation and make the decision concerning the
student's re-entry.

61

Class Attendance Regulations

A student is expected to attend all classes, including labs, for all courses
for which he/she is registered. The student is solely responsible for
accounting to the instructor for any absence. An instructor may
recommend that the Vice President for Academic Affairs and Dean drop
from class, with a grade of "W" or "WF", any student whose absences
are interfering with satisfactory performance in the course.

Course Repetition

A student is prohibited from repeating a course in which he has made a "C"
or better (while enrolled at LaGrange College or any institution) without the
approval of the Vice President for Academic Affairs and Dean, and the
Academic Council. All courses in which a student receives an
unsatisfactory grade must be repeated at LaGrange College. A student may
not remove from the transcript an unsatisfactory grade earned at LaGrange
College or elsewhere even if he repeats the course.

ACCELERATION

Students desiring to accelerate their college program may complete
requirements in less than four academic years. This may be
accomplished by attending summer schools and/or taking an academic
overload. Permission to take an overload in any semester is granted
only to those students who have earned at least a cumulative average of
"B" (3.0), except that a student may take an overload during one
semester of his or her senior year without respect to grade-point average.

Students may be eligible for credit and/or exemption in certain areas
through the College Level Examination Program (CLEP) and other
recognized testing procedures. Advanced placement credit is accepted
for those students who present evidence from their high schools that
advanced placement programs have been completed and appropriate
scores earned on the advanced placement test of the College Entrance
Examination Board administered by Educational Testing Service. The
Registrar and department chairs keep up-to-date standards for AP credit.

TRANSIENT WORK

( 1 ) Students who have failed a course at LC are not allowed to take
the course elsewhere

(2) Students must take ENGL 1 101 and 1 102 here.

(3) Students must take all CORE courses here.

62

Credit through United States Armed Forces
Institute and Service Schools

Courses taken through The United States Armed Forces Institute and
other recognized military educational programs are accepted in
accordance with the policy governing transfer work when presented on
official transcripts from accredited institutions. Nine semester hours of
elective credit will be allowed for military service credit, including
USAFI correspondence courses and military service school courses as
recommended by the American Council on Education. Academic credit
for one activity course in physical education, up to a maximum of four,
will be awarded for each two months served in the Armed Forces.

International Students

Students who are on a student visa in the United States are subject to
special regulations mandated by the U.S. Citizenship and Immigration
Services (USCIS) of the United States Government. As the institution
which issues documents certifying student status, LaGrange College is
subject to USCIS regulations as a matter of law. USCIS regulations
change from time to time, so students are encouraged to contact the
Vice President for Academic Affairs and Dean or the Registrar when
questions about USCIS regulations arise. Under current guidelines,
persons with student visas must be enrolled for a full academic load (at
least 12 semester hours) at all times. Federal regulations concerning
"status" for all international students on an F-l visa state that any
student who falls below 12 semester hours at any time will be
considered out-of-status and must be reinstated by the U.S. Citizenship
and Immigration Services (USCIS).

English proficiency is fundamental to a successful academic course at
LaGrange College. Therefore, in addition to the minimum TOEFL
score required for admission, the Vice President for Academic Affairs
and Dean may require that a student attend a special, intensive English
language course if it is apparent that a student's English continues to
dil jeopardize a successful academic career. If such a requirement is
placed on a student, failure to attend the English language course can
result in withdrawal of the student visa.

International students must enroll in an English course each
semester they are in school until they satisfactorily complete their
English studies.

63

International Studies

Increasing international understanding is valued at LaGrange College. In
promoting that understanding, LaGrange College seeks to enroll an
internationally diverse student body. The College serves as a host or
home base institution for short-term international visitors and has
executed cooperative agreements with Nippon Bunri in Oita City, Japan,
Instituto Laurens in Monterrey, Mexico, and Oxford-Brookes University
in Oxford, England.

Grades and Credits

The definitions of grades given at LaGrange College are as follows:

A superior

B above average

C average

D below average

F failing

I incomplete. This grade is assigned in case a student is doing
satisfactory work but for some reason beyond the student's
control has been unable to complete the work during that term.

P pass

NC no credit or non-credit

W withdrawn. During the first three weeks a student may withdraw
from a class with an "automatic" "W." After this trial period the
student may withdraw, but the grade assigned, "W" or "WF,"
will be at the discretion of the professor.

WF withdrawn failing. The grade of "WF" is included in computing
the grade-point average.

AW audit withdrawn

AU audit complete

NR grade not reported by instructor at the time the report issued.

A student may register for a course on a non-credit basis, for which he
or she pays full tuition. To have a grade of "NC" recorded, he or she
must fulfill all course requirements.

64

\ student may audit a course by paying the audit fee. All requests for
audit courses must be approved in writing by the instructor and Vice
''resident for Academic Affairs and Dean. Only lecture courses may be
audited. No new freshman student may audit any course during the first
emester of residence at LaGrange College.

I

\n "I" is a temporary grade, assigned by an instructor within the last
hree weeks of the term to students who are doing satisfactory work and
vho cannot complete the course due to circumstances beyond their
ontrol. Should conditions prohibiting completion of a course arise
/ithin the first eight weeks, students should withdraw.

kD "I" is to be removed by the date indicated in the academic calendar,
ailure to remove an "I" by the date set initiates the following action:
'he Registrar will write a letter to the student using the address on file,
'he letter indicates that the student has two weeks to respond. Otherwise
ie "I" grade will be converted to an "F".

irades are assigned and recorded for each course at the end of
ach term. Grades are available to students on the web. Transcripts
re withheld for any student who is under financial obligation to
le College.

icademic Standing Probation Regulations

tudents are placed on academic probation when the quality of work
. such that progress toward graduation is in jeopardy. The purpose of
robation is to warn. It is not a penalty. Students on probation will
e notified, and the regulations governing probation will be called to
fieir attention.

reshmen (fewer than 27 hours) must maintain a cumulative grade point
verage (GPA) of at least 1.65 to avoid being placed on probation,
ophomores (27-53 hours), a 1.75 GPA; Juniors (54-80 hours), a 1.85
PA; and Seniors (81 or more hours), a 2.00 GPA. In most cases,
udents have two semesters to remove their probationary status. Failure
do so could result in suspension.

tudents are also subject to suspension for failure to earn at least three
mester hours of academic credit in any semester, or for other valid
:ademic reasons (such as violating cheating and plagiarism standards).
i the case of part-time students, the extent of application of these
gulations will be at the discretion of the Vice President for Academic
ffairs and Dean. Normally, all applications of the regulations will be
ised upon a full academic load.

65

A letter from the Vice President for Academic Affairs and Dean is sent
to the student providing information on standing. "Probation One"
means that the student's next term will be the first term on probation, etc.
"Dean's Decision" means that the student's academic records have been
given to the Vice President for Academic Affairs and Dean for action.

Student Grade Appeals

The initial determination of a student's grade is entirely the prerogative
of the instructor. However, a student who wishes to contest a course
grade or other academic decision may initiate an appeal by the
procedures outlined below. Grade appeals must be initiated no later than
mid-term of the academic term following that in which the grade was
assigned. The date of the academic term is defined in the College
calendar in the front of this Bulletin.

The following procedures govern all student requests for grade changes:

The student should first attempt to resolve the matter by
discussing the question with the course instructor.

If the student and the instructor are unable to reach a resolution,
the student must then submit a written appeal to the Vice
President for Academic Affairs and Dean. The appeal must state
the manner in which the course syllabus was violated.

The Dean shall then seek an informal conference between the
student and the instructor to settle the grievance to the satisfaction
of the two parties involved. If no resolution can be found, the
Dean will deliver the student's appeal together with any other
pertinent documents provided by the student and/or the instructor
to the Review Subcommittee of the Academic Standards
Committee for its determination.

The Review Subcommittee shall then convene to conduct a
preliminary review of the appeal, after which the Chair of the
Review Subcommittee will set times convenient to the student and
the instructor for hearing both sides of the dispute.

Upon completion of its hearings, the Review Subcommittee will
report its findings to the Vice President for Academic Affairs and
Dean. The Dean will in turn inform the principal parties involved
of whether the student's request for a change of grade or other
decision was denied or approved.

66

It is the responsibility of the Review Subcommittee to make every
reasonable effort to complete its deliberations prior to the end of
the term in which an appeal was initiated.

Academic Forgiveness

Academic forgiveness is a process which allows a student to have his or
her prior academic record adjusted if:

1 . four or more calendar years have elapsed since the period of last
enrollment at LaGrange College;

2. the student applying for forgiveness has successfully completed
since readmission to LaGrange College a minimum of 12 semester
hours and has no course grade lower than "C" since the time

of readmission.

I The student may petition for forgiveness through the Academic
Advisory Council and, if approved, the College will:

1 . apply toward the student's common core, general education
curriculum, and electives requirements but not necessarily toward
the student's academic major or minor, all those courses in which
the student earned a grade of "C" or better;

2. set the student's cumulative grade point average to 0.0;

3. require the student to successfully complete a minimum of 30
semester hours after bankruptcy declaration in order to graduate;
and allow all graduation requirements (see LaGrange College
Bulletin) to remain the same and apply equally, except that students
who have

4. petitioned for and received academic forgiveness will not be eligible
to receive honors at graduation.

LaGrange College will maintain the student's complete record, including
those courses excluded from the GPA by the granting of forgiveness.
No course work will be expunged from the student's academic record.
The student's official transcript will clearly indicate that the student has
been granted academic forgiveness. Ordinarily, no transfer or transient
credits will be accepted after academic forgiveness. A student may be
granted academic forgiveness only once during his or her academic
career at LaGrange College.

67

Requirements for Bachelor Degrees:
A Summary

LaGrange College's Undergraduate Day Program offers the Bachelor of
Arts degree, the Bachelor of Science degree, the Bachelor of Music
degree, and the Bachelor of Science in Nursing degree. To obtain a
second bachelor's degree, at least 27 additional semester hours must be
earned beyond the first degree, in a minimum of two semesters.
Baccalaureate degrees require a minimum of 108 semester hours of
credit including required course work in the core curriculum and the
major. There is often an opportunity to select course work electives.

The minimum work required for graduation is 108 semester hours and a
2.0* quality-point average in all course work taken at LaGrange
College. To be eligible for the degree, a student must meet all
requirements for the degree (core curriculum, major program, all
necessary assessments, 108 semester hours and 2.0 cumulative grade
point average) and make application for the degree before the beginning
of his or her final term. A student who does not earn a degree in ten full
semesters or the equivalent may be denied further registration.

In order to graduate in four academic years a student, at a minimum,
should enroll for 12-semester hours credit in each regular term and one
interim term each year. A student who takes at least 12 semester hours
credit is classified as full-time. The maximum full load is 15 semester
hours; anything beyond is considered an overload. No student whose
average is below 3.0 is permitted to enroll for more than 15 (16 if lab is
involved) hours in any one term without the written permission of the
Vice President for Academic Affairs and Dean.

Quality points are earned as follows: A, 4; B, 3; C, 2; D, 1; F, 0. The
quality-point average is computed by multiplying the grade point by the
course credit, summing, and then dividing the total quality points earned
by the total GPA hours. If a student has received credit for a course and
repeats that course, he or she receives no additional credit toward the
degree. In computing the student's average, GPA hours and quality
points are counted on all attempts.

Not more than 54 semester hours of credit earned at a junior college are
counted toward the degree. No credit is granted toward the degree for
course work taken at a junior college after a student has attained junior
standing except that up to 9 hours of transient credit from a junior
college may be granted for courses that are below the LaGrange College
3000-level. (The 54 credit-hour limit still applies.) A transfer student is
not given credit toward graduation for any Ds earned elsewhere.

68

Transient work with a grade of "C" or better is acceptable. Academic
averages are computed on work done only at LaGrange College.

I There are two ways by which a student must meet residency
requirements for graduation:

(1) The student must be in residence the last 36 credit hours;
Or

(2) 45 credit hours of the last 54 credit hours must be earned at
LaGrange College.

With prior approval of the adviser and the Vice President for Academic
a Affairs and Dean up to nine hours of transient study may be earned at
another accredited institution. Transient credit is awarded only for
courses in which the grade is "C" or better.

Grades earned for transient work are not included in the cumulative
grade average. Normally, after receiving an unsatisfactory grade in a
course at LaGrange College, a student will not be given permission to
repeat that course at another institution. Credits totaling six hours or
more earned as a transient student during the last 54 hours or final four
semesters precludes that student being granted credit for any course
work taken by extension or by correspondence during the period.

Transient credit for courses within a student's major will only be
accepted from a four-year baccalaureate degree conferring, regionally
accredited institution that offers a major in the specific discipline of the
course being requested for credit. The department chair retains the right
to deny the request.

Any regularly enrolled LaGrange College student who desires to take
course work for credit by extension, correspondence, or through on-line
vendors must obtain prior approval in writing from his academic adviser
and from the Vice President for Academic Affairs and Dean. Such
extension, correspondence, and on-line credit may in no case exceed six
hours (grades of "C" or better); however, (no credits earned in this
manner may be applied toward the fulfillment of the core
curriculum requirements of LaGrange College. No core course
requirements may be met at institutions other than LaGrange
College.) Any course or courses so taken must be completed and all
grades recorded before the end of the student's final term, in order to be
graduated that term.

ntfl

69

A student is classified as a freshman if he or she has earned fewer than
27 hours of credit. A student is classified as a sophomore if he or she
has earned 27-53 hours of credit. To be classified as a junior, a student
must have completed 54 earned hours of credit. A student is classified as
a senior upon having earned 81 hours of credit. A student should be alert
to the fact that a minimum of 108 hours are required for graduation and
that some majors may require more than 108 hours. Attaining these
minimum progression requirements may not be sufficient to insure
graduation within the two semesters of the senior year.

No grade below "C" in any course above 1000-level may be applied
toward a major

*2.5 for Education, Nursing, Business Management, and Accountancy.

Academic Honors

Upon graduation, students who have been in residence at LaGrange

College for at least their last 54 hours (90 quarter hours for Evening
College students) and

1. have attained a quality point average of 3.50 to 3.74 may be granted
the bachelor degree cum laude or

2. have attained a quality point average of 3.75 to 3.89 may be granted
the bachelor degree magna cum laude or

3. have attained a quality point average of 3.90 to 4.0 may be granted
the bachelor degree summa cum laude.

At the end of each academic semester, students who have maintained a
3.60 cumulative grade point average on a minimum of 12 GPA hours of
work will be placed on the Dean's List.

Upon graduation, students who have been in residence at LaGrange
College (as transfer students in the day program, in the Evening College,
or in the Albany program) for at least 42 semester hours (70 quarter
hours) and have attained a grade point average of 3.50 or higher may be
granted the bachelor degree with distinction.

Cultural Enrichment Requirement at
LaGrange College

Because the intellectual and cultural opportunities during one's college
years are exceptionally rich, and because exposure to a variety of
cultural experiences, and participation in a lively collegial atmosphere,
during one's intellectually formative years, are vital to the concept of a

70

liberal education, LaGrange College is dedicated to assisting in this
enrichment by requiring all students to accumulate a prescribed number
of Cultural Enrichment credits over the course of their careers. Each
semester a list of approved Cultural Enrichment programs lectures,
presentations, events, performances, recitals, etc. will be published in a
brochure and on the college web page. Attendance at a maximum of six
designated athletic events will count toward the total required for
graduation. Many of these events will occur during the Contact Hour on
Tuesdays and Thursdays, and some will double as required programs in
the Core classes. Students will meet their obligation according to the
following schedule.

EARNED HOURS

CULTURAL

UPON ENTRY TO

EVENTS

LAGRANGE

NEEDED TO

CLASSIFICATION

COLLEGE

GRADUATE

New/Transfer

Freshman

0-11 Sem. Hrs.

40

Transfer Freshman

12- 26 Sem. Hrs.

35

Transfer Sophomore

27- 39 Sem. Hrs.

30

Transfer Sophomore

40- 53 Sem. Hrs.

25

Transfer Junior

54- 66 Sem. Hrs.

20

Transfer Junior

67- 80 Sem. Hrs.

15

Transfer Senior

81-108 Sem. Hrs.

10

Graduation Requirements

A student who enters LaGrange College under a given Bulletin
generally will be graduated under the core curriculum, hours
-equirement, and grade point average requirements of that Bulletin.
Major requirements are those in force at the time a student formally
declares a major. If a student suspends his or her study and re-enters
nore than four years later, he or she will graduate under the
-equirements of the Bulletin in effect at the time of re-entry.

Students in their last year of college work must have an audit of their
:ourse credits and planned courses examined prior to registration for
heir final semester in residence. This is called a "graduation petition.'
The major adviser and the Office of the Vice President for Academic
Affairs and Dean assist the student in completing this petition. No

71

student may participate in Commencement exercises if he or she has not
completed a graduation petition. Also, no student may participate in
Commencement unless all graduation requirements have been
certified as completed by the Registrar and the Vice President
for Academic Affairs and Dean.

Students at LaGrange College will participate in the evaluation of the
extent to which institutional education goals are being achieved. This
evaluation will be in both the core curriculum and the major. Students
who graduated in June of 1990 were the first to participate in these
comprehensive evaluations. Consult the specific majors for the details.

Transcripts

Students are entitled to transcripts of their record free of charge. No
transcripts will be issued for any student under financial obligation to
the College. Transcript requests must be made in writing to the Registrar
well in advance of the time the transcript is needed. Transcripts will be
issued promptly; however, at the beginning and end of terms some delay
may be unavoidable. Unofficial transcripts may be obtained from the
online student module of the web.

Student Appeal of Academic Policy

Students may petition for exception to published academic policy.
The Academic Advisory Council reviews the petition.

72

Academic Support and
I Information Technology

LaGrange College Policy for the Responsible
Use of Information Technology

The purpose of this policy is to ensure a computing environment that
will support the academic, research, and service mission of LaGrange
College. Simply stated, continued and efficient accessibility of campus
computing and network facilities depends on the responsible behavior of
the entire user community. The College seeks to provide students,
faculty, and staff with the greatest possible access to campus
information technology resources within the limits of institutional
priorities and financial capabilities and consistent with generally
accepted principles of ethics that govern the College community. To that
end, this policy addresses the many issues involved in responsible use of
the College's information technology resources, including systems,
software, and data. Each authorized user of information technology
assumes responsibility for his or her own behavior while utilizing these
resources. Users of information technology at LaGrange College accept
that the same moral and ethical behavior that guides our non-computing
environments also guides our computing and networking environment.
Any infraction of this policy may result minimally in loss of computer
and network access privileges, or may result in criminal prosecution.

Use

All users of the College's information technology resources agree to
abide by the terms of this policy. Information technology resources
include, but are not limited to, College owned computers and
information technology hardware, the College campus network,
I information sources accessible through the campus network, and
| Internet access. When accessing any remote resources utilizing
\ : j LaGrange College information technology, users are required to comply
with both the policies set forth in this document and all applicable
policies governing the use and access of the remote resource. The
College, through a review and amendment process directed by the
Instructional and Information Technology Round Table (IITR), reserves
the right to amend this policy. For the most up-to-date version of this
responsible use policy, see the information technology helpdesk
(helpdesk.lagrange.edu). As far as possible, changes will be made only
after consulting with the user community. LaGrange College computing

73

resources and associated user accounts are to be used only for the
College activities for which they are assigned or intended. The
computing systems are not to be used for any non-college related
commercial purpose, public or private, either for profit or non-profit.
Unless placed in public domain by its owners, software programs are
protected by Section 1 1 7 of the 1976 Copyright Act. It is illegal to
duplicate, copy, or distribute software or its documentation without the
permission of the copyright owner. Copyright protection of text,
images, video and audio must also be respected in all uses of College
technology resources. The LaGrange College Campus Network must
not be used to serve information outside of LaGrange College without
written permission approved by the IITR.

User Accounts

Many technology resources at LaGrange College are accessed through
user accounts. No user accounts should be used to execute computer
software or programs or attempt to gain access to resources other than
software, programs or resources specifically granted and offered for use
by LaGrange College. All users are responsible for both the protection
of their account passwords and the data stored in their user accounts.
Sharing a password is prohibited. Users must change their password
periodically to help prevent unauthorized access of their user account.
When working on computers that are in general access areas
(laboratories and public access), users must log off or lock the computer
before leaving to protect the security of their data and the network.
Leaving the web-based email page (Outlook Web-Client) open on an
accessible computer, especially outside of campus, leaves the account
available to anyone who passes by, and allows the changing of the user's
password giving the passerby access to the LaGrange College Network.
Before leaving a computer, users must log off the web-based email. If a
student becomes locked out of their account or for other reasons needs
to have their password reset, they must make the request in person to an
Information Technology staff member and present a valid LaGrange
College ID. Any suspected unauthorized access of a user's account
should be reported immediately to the Executive Director of
Instructional & Information Technology or another College authority.
User accounts will be deactivated when the user's affiliation with the
College is terminated and all files and other data will be removed from
those accounts.

74

College Email Accounts

The College provides email accounts for students, faculty and staff. All
course and advising related email and other official College electronic
communication with students must be sent to the student's campus email
address or via WebCT. Official College email communications with
faculty and staff will use their College email address. Email must not be
used for purposes inconsistent with the mission of the College. Users
may not conceal, mask or misrepresent their identity when sending
email or other electronic messages. Transmission of abusive, harassing
or libelous electronic messages is forbidden. Deliberate transmission or
propagation of malicious programs such as viruses, worms, Trojan
Horses, data mining programs or participation in denial of service
attacks are subject to disciplinary and possible criminal action.

LaGrange College maintains faculty and staff mail groups (distribution
lists or aliases) for the purposes of communications concerning the
operation of the College. The College maintains a Community mail-list
for communications of a less formal nature. Users must make
appropriate use of the subject line in postings to all College related mail
groups (distribution lists or aliases) and mail-lists (list servers).
Announcements to faculty and staff about campus events should be
made through FY I. These announcements should be sent to the
Communications and Marketing staff for inclusion in FYI. A single
reminder close to the date of the event may be made to the faculty and
staff mail groups. Exceptions to this policy may be made by approval of
the Instructional and Information Technology Round Table. Daily
reminders of an upcoming event are inappropriate. Examples of
\ messages appropriate for the FYI/email reminder procedure are Cultural
Enrichment Events, Faculty Meetings, Staff Council Meetings, Faculty-
Staff Coffees, and Sports Events. Messages not directly related to the
operation of the College should be posted to the Community mail-list.
For example, items for sale, contests, fund-raisers, sports scores,
humorous items and commentaries belong on the Community mail-list
rather than being sent to the faculty and staff mail groups. Users can
unsubscribe from and re-subscribe to the Community mail list as they
desire. Instructions for subscribing and unsubscribing are available on
the helpdesk (helpdesk.lagrange.edu).

Posting of messages to the email group containing all students must be
cleared through the appropriate Vice President's Office or their
delegates. Use of the electronic signs on the Patio and in the Dining
Hall, posters and flyers are suggested alternative means of reaching all
students. Messages to the student body should not be made through the

75

faculty mail group. Messages to faculty containing variations on
"Please announce to your class" are ineffective in reaching all students.

Campus Computing Facilities

Microcomputer labs on the LaGrange College campus are available for
general use by students, faculty and staff except during the periods when
the rooms have been reserved for teaching purposes. Additional
computers are placed in public access areas for student, faculty and staff
use. It is the responsibility of every user to use lab and public access
facilities in a responsible manner. Accidental damage or damage caused
by other parties should be reported as soon as possible so that corrective
action can be taken. Use of laboratory or public access facilities to view
material that may be considered offensive to others which includes, but
is not limited to, racially hateful and sexually explicit material, is
considered a form of harassment. The viewing of harassing material is
inconsistent with the Mission of LaGrange College. Viewing such
harassing material in a lab or public access area may result in
disciplinary action.

Personal Web Pages

Any authorized user or group at the College may have a personal home
page on a LaGrange College World Wide Web server, provided that the
graphical images, multimedia information, text, or the intent of the home
page do not refute the mission of LaGrange College. Users must sign a
Registered Information Provider Agreement before web pages are
placed on the server. Groups must designate an individual as their
Registered Information Provider, who is responsible for the content of
their web pages. Registered Information Provider Agreements must be
renewed annually. Failure to renew will result in removal of content
from the web server. No individual user is authorized to create and
serve a web site on the World Wide Web utilizing College computer
resources. Applications for personal web pages should be made to the
Director of Information Technology.

Student Computer Configurations

Access to the LaGrange College Campus Network is available in
dormitory rooms for students who bring to campus personal computers
meeting the minimum specifications defined by Information
Technology. These specifications are revised annually and will be made
available to all new students. The Campus Network will allow students
to access the World Wide Web (WWW) and email. By accessing the
College network, students agree to abide by this usage policy. Students

76

m

must not change network configurations specified by Information
Technology. The Information Technology staff will only support
software installed by Information Technology personnel, and do not
provide support for personally owned computer equipment other than
verifying that the network link is functional.

i Students are responsible for all network traffic originating from their
network access. Students should employ appropriate and up-to-date
antivirus software.

Campus Network

The College provides network access in classrooms, laboratories, the
library, offices, public access locations and student dormitory rooms.
While the College is committed to free speech and open access to
information and communication, these must be tempered by the need to
respect others' rights to speech, access and communication. Each user is
expected to balance their needs with the needs and expectations of the
College community as a whole. The College reserves the rights to limit
bandwidth to users and access to non-academic, resource intensive
applications if they threaten to interfere with academic uses of the
campus network.

the 1 1 Users on the network must not attempt to conceal, mask or misrepresent
their identity or the identity of computers when using the network.
Users shall not employ software or hardware that interferes with the
operation or security of the network. Users shall not interfere with the
administration of the campus network nor shall they attempt to breach
any network or resource security system. In administering the network,
network activities of users may be monitored as to type and quantity.

Users are responsible for all network activities originating from
resources provided to them by the College.

Wireless Network

Wireless networking provides many benefits to the College, but with
these benefits comes unique security threats. In order to make a
reasonable effort to prevent access to network resources from
unauthorized users via the Wireless Local Area Network (WLAN), the
following policy and associated best practices exist.

An unsecured Wireless Access Point (WAP) has the potential to open a
backdoor into an otherwise secure network. All WAPs located in
academic and administrative buildings must be managed by IT. Faculty
and staff are prohibited from installing a WAP without explicit

77

permission from the Director of Information Technology. Requests for
expansion of the wireless network should be made to the Network
Manager via the IT Helpdesk. In order to allow flexibility for students
to utilize wireless networking in the residence halls, secured personal
WAPs are allowed. IT must be notified of intent to install a WAP via
the IT Helpdesk. WAPs must be physically located in the vicinity of the
owner's conventional wired jack and they must be secured in at least
one of two ways. At least 40-bit Wired Equivalent Privacy (WEP) must
be enabled on the WAP and client. Ideally the WAP's internal MAC
address table should be set to only allow access from authorized clients.
IT reserves the right to scan for and disable any unauthorized or
unsecured WAPs.

WAP Best Practices:

Activate WEP on the WAP and client

Change the default administrator password to a more secure
password

Don't use the default Service Set Identifier (SSID)
Don't broadcast the SSID if possible

Use the lowest power radio output possible to minimize propagation
outside the building

Disable the WAP in non-usage periods

Remote Access

LaGrange College provides very limited direct telephone dialup access
to the Campus Network for college business. This service was created
for technical and administrative access to the network not available
through a regular Internet connection, and is not intended to provide
general Internet access to members of the LaGrange College
community. In order to be granted dialup access to the Campus
Network, a user must submit a request to the IITR via their department
chair/supervisor. The request should indicate the period of time for
which this access is to be granted and indicate how this access is
consistent with the technical and/or administrative purpose of the dialup
resource. For regular dialup needs, service through a commercial
Internet Service Provider is recommended.

78

Data Security

Within institutional priorities and financial capabilities, LaGrange
College provides reasonable security against unauthorized intrusion and
damage to data, files and messages stored on its computer systems. The
College maintains facilities for archiving and retrieving data stored in
user accounts. If a user needs to recover data after an accidental loss,
Information Technology staff should be contacted and every reasonable
attempt will be made to recover the lost or corrupted data. Neither the
College nor any Information Technology staff can be held accountable
for unauthorized access by other users, nor can they guarantee data
protection in the event of media failure, fire, criminal acts or natural
disaster. Backing up critical files regularly is recommended.

Information Resource Use by Guests
and Alumni

Use of physical facilities for information technology by guests
(individuals not currently enrolled as students or currently employed as
faculty or staff members of LaGrange College) and alumni is allowed
only within William and Evelyn Banks Library and under the
supervision of library staff. Additionally, such access is allowed only
when existing resources are not being fully utilized by LaGrange
College students, faculty, or staff. The use of technological resources
may be extended to alumni and friends of LaGrange College without the
imposition of a "user fee." A "per printed page" user fee established by
Banks Library will be assessed for use of College printing resources.

User Awareness:

Because Information technologies change at so rapid a rate, updates to
the Responsible Use Policy may be made between printings of College
publications. It is the responsibility of the user to keep informed of the
changes in this policy, which will be available on a LaGrange College
web site (http://panther.lagrange.edu).

LaGrange College Cell Phone and Pager Policy

The carrying and use of cell phones, pagers and other electronic
communications devices are allowed on the LaGrange College campus.
Users of these devices, however, must be attentive to needs and
sensibilities of other members of the College community. Furthermore,
the use of these devices must not disrupt the functions of the College.

79

Devices must be off or ringers silenced in classes, laboratories, the
library, study spaces and other academic settings and during events such
as plays, concerts, speakers and College ceremonies. The term
'laboratories' explicitly includes computer laboratory spaces.
Answering or operating the device during classes, laboratories, meetings
or events is only appropriate in case of emergency. If the device must
be answered, the user must move to a location where the class,
laboratory, library patrons, etc. will not be disrupted before making use
of the device.

80

Academic Programs

Introduction

Faculty members and the staff of LaGrange College implement
academic and non-academic programs toward the fulfillment of the
mission of the College. Undergirding all of the academic programs at
LaGrange is the fundamental commitment to the liberal arts. Therefore,
LaGrange College is first and foremost a liberal arts college. The
underlying philosophy of liberal learning is found in all parts of the
curriculum of the College but is most obvious in the structure of the
Liberal Studies Core Curriculum, that part of the curriculum that serves
as foundation and complement to the major. All baccalaureate majors
share the same Liberal Studies Core Curriculum, which represents just
under fifty percent of a student's formal study at the College.

The curriculum is designed to provide the components of a liberal arts
education that historically have proved to be of lasting value. Those
components include skills such as writing, computation, speaking,
problem solving, computer utilization, ethical decision-making, and
analytical thinking. Additionally, specific courses are designed to
integrate knowledge from diverse disciplines including history, the arts,
literature, religion, health, and the social sciences.

The desired results of this curriculum are that students will be better able
to communicate clearly; to interpret and evaluate the influence of
historical, cultural and religious developments upon human experiences;
to gather, interpret and evaluate information to assist in problem solving
and decision making; and to establish personal values, applying them to
service to the community.

Core Program in the Liberal Arts

As a Methodist related institution, LaGrange College offers an
educational experience which emphasizes the inter-relatedness of
knowledge and the importance of understanding and evaluating human
experience. The Core Program in the Liberal Arts (also known as the
Common Core Program) uses an interdisciplinary approach to develop
the students' creative, critical and communicative abilities. The specific
objectives of the Core Program are noted elsewhere in this Bulletin (see
"Core Curriculum").

The Core Program is designed to be integrated with other courses during
the first three years of the student's experience at LaGrange College.
The forty-eight semester hours included in the Core Program are

arranged in three divisions: foundation studies, integrative studies, and
exploratory studies. The twelve hours of integrative studies, which
bring an interdisciplinary focus to the humanities, the social sciences,
and quantitative reasoning, are central to the entire Core Program. Other
interdisciplinary courses required in the Core Program are Freshman
Cornerstone I and Dimensions of Well Being. No transient credit will
be allowed for any Rhetoric and Composition course (ENGL 1101 or
1 102) or for the Integrative Studies courses (Quantitative Reasoning,
Humanities I and II, The American Experience).

Foundation Studies 30 Hours

Course Taken

Freshman Cornerstone CORE 1101)*

Freshman Cornerstone Laboratory
(CORE 1102)*

Rhetoric and Composition (ENGL 1101,

Mathematics

(MATH 1 101, 2105, 2221, or 2222)

(Entry level by placement)

World Languages and Culture

(2 sequential courses in languages: FREN, GERM, SPAN)

Laboratory Science I and II 8 as best scheduled

(BIOL 1 101-1 102, 1 148-1 149*; CHEM 1 101-1 102;
PHYS 1101-1102; PHYS 1121-1122)

Min. Credit

Year

3

Freshman

1

Freshman

102) 6

Freshman

3

Freshman

6

as best scheduled

Dimensions of Well Being (CORE 2000)
* Mandatory for BSN students
Integrative Studies

3 as best scheduled

30 Hours

3 as best scheduled

Quantitative Reasoning (CORE 1110) 3

(either MATH 1114 or a second MATH course of those listed above may

be substituted for some majors)

Humanities I and Humanities II (
CORE 2001, 2002)

The American Experience (CORE 3001)

6
3
12 Hours

Sophomore
Junior

82

iled

iled

iled

mre

Exploratory Studies

Fine Arts 3 as best scheduled

(any beginning level classes in the Fine Arts Division Courses that
satisfy this requirement are markedwith an asterisk (*) in the Art,
Music, and Theatre Sections of the Bulletin)

Religion (RLGN 1101,1 102, 1 103, 1 104, or 1 105) 3 as best scheduled

6 hours

TOTAL CORE PROGRAM 48 Hours

TOTAL CORE PROGRAM 48 hours**

* Transfer students with 27 or more hours may be waived from the
CORE 1 101/1 102 requirement.

** Although not considered a part of the Core Program, each student is
required to pass 3 interim term courses (one three semester hour course per
term) as part of the graduation requirements. Students may elect to
complete 4 interim terms, and are encouraged to do so. Most interim term
courses offer a Pass/ No Credit grade option. "Requirements for Bachelor
Degrees: A Summary" (pp. 83) in this Bulletin for details.

Please read carefully the next section titled Placement.

Placement

Appropriate placement in certain courses is essential.

During the first few days on campus all students will participate in
placement evaluation inventories. These inventories are necessary for
(1) planning for majors and careers, (2) providing the comparison levels
for subsequent assessment of the CORE Program curriculum, and (3)
determining current skill levels for placement purposes. Placement in
mathematics and English is based on skills assessment or standardized
test scores. Students who are not predicted to be successful in
Mathematics 1101 are required to enroll in Mathematics 0100. This is a
pre-Core Program mathematics course, and credit in this course does
not count toward the fulfillment of the 48 hours of core requirements,
but does count toward hours required for graduation. English placement
is based on scores obtained on the Scholastic Aptitude Test (SAT).
Based on scores obtained students are placed in an appropriate section
(standard, honors, or grammar-intensive) of English 1 101 (cf.
description of English program).

83

Students entering LaGrange College with two (2) years of high school
level foreign language are placed in an intermediate level course of
that language; or if the students choose, they may start the study of
another language at the beginning level. Any student for whom English
is not the native language may have the language requirement waived
by submitting a written request to the Registrar from the student's
advisor, the Director of International Student Services, or the Chair of
the Humanities Division. Those students who are allowed to waive
the language requirement must still complete the minimum 108 hours
for graduation.

General Education Program, Time Restrictions

There is no time limit on the credit or validity of coursework in the
CORE Program. It should be noted, however, that students who have
not been enrolled at LaGrange College for four years, or who transferred
from LaGrange College and subsequently return, enter the college under
the Bulletin in force at the time of re-entry.

Credit-by Examination and Exemption

Students may be eligible for credit and/or exemption in certain areas
through Advanced Placement (AP) Tests or the College Level
Examination Program (CLEP) and other recognized testing procedures.
To determine the test scores that qualify for college credit and/or
exemption, students should contact the Registrar. This information is
also available in the individual department sections of the Bulletin.
Credit by examination (AP or CLEP) may reduce the 48 semester hour
requirement of the General Education Program by the number of credit
hours earned by this process.

Assessment of the General Education Program

Prior to graduation, students take an inventory, The Academic Profile,
designed to determine the extent to which they have achieved the
objectives of the curriculum of the Core Program. The optimal time to
take The Academic Profile is during the semester following the
completion of CORE 3001, the American Experience (usually either
second semester of the junior year or first semester of the senior year).
Meaningful participation in this testing program is a requirement for
graduation with a baccalaureate degree.

84

xs

;ider

The Major Programs

A major is defined as a primary program of study in which the student
completes a designated number and sequence of courses within a
specific discipline, department or subject area. A major may or may not
offer concentrations for focused course work within the major.

A student may choose to pursue one of four baccalaureate degrees: the
Bachelor of Arts, the Bachelor of Science, the Bachelor of music, or the
Bachelor of Science in Nursing. Most students pursue one of these
baccalaureate degrees.

Bachelor of Arts

Art and Design

Biochemistry

Biology

Chemistry

Computer Science

Education
Early Childhood
Middle Grades

English

History

Bachelor of Science

Accountancy
Business Management
Business Management
Chemistry
Computer Science
Mathematics

Human Services

Mathematics

Music

Political Science

Psychology

Religion

Sociology

Spanish

Theatre Arts

LM

Bachelor of Science in Nursing

Nursing

Bachelor of Music

Creative Music Technologies

Performance (voice, piano, organ, guitar, percussion)

Church Music

Students enrolled in the Evening College may pursue the Bachelor of
Arts in Business Administration, the Bachelor of Arts degree in Human
Development or an Associate of Arts in Liberal Studies. Please refer to
the Evening College Bulletin for more details about these programs.

85

LaGrange College also offers graduate programs. In these programs,
students may complete the Master of Arts in Teaching or the Master of
Education in Curriculum and Instruction. Please refer to the Graduate
Bulletin for more information about these programs.

Interdisciplinary Major

The Interdisciplinary Major at LaGrange College allows highly
motivated students to pursue a self-designed, individualized program
leading to a Bachelor of Arts degree in Interdisciplinary Studies.

To be eligible to pursue the interdisciplinary major, a student must
exhibit a high-level of maturity and self-direction. A grade point average
of 3.3 or permission of the Academic Dean is required at the time of
submission of the proposal The major may be declared upon completion
of 27 semester hours, but no later than 66 semester hours.

Policies and Procedures:

1) The proposed major must stem from at least two separate
disciplines, but no more than three, and be supportable by the
existing resources of the college.

2) The student must select an advisor in each discipline with one
agreeing to serve as the principal advisor.

3) The student must research and select classes totaling at least 36
semester hours that relate to the proposed major and justify the
inclusion of each course. At least 30 semester hours must be
from courses at the 3000 level or above.

4) The proposal must include a clear sense of where the
interdisciplinary major would lead the student (graduate school
or career possibilities). The proposal should also state why the
Interdisciplinary Studies Major better suits the student's needs
than existing majors/minors offered at LaGrange College.

5) The final major curriculum will be determined by the student in
consultation with all advisors. All general education
requirements must be met for graduation. The major must
culminate in a capstone paper or project approved by all advisors
and supervised by the principal advisor. The student must
register for INDV 4499 during his or her senior year.

6) The student must complete the Interdisciplinary Studies Proposal
Form, which may be acquired from the registrar's office. The
proposed major must be approved by all advisors, the curriculum

86

committee and the Academic Dean. It must also be filed with the
registrar's office. Any changes to the approved curriculum must
have the approval of all advisors, the curriculum committee and the
Academic Dean. An amendment form with these approvals must
be submitted to the registrar's office.

Major Requirements, Time Restrictions

Course work requirements in major programs necessarily change in
response to evolving curriculum concerns and changing student needs.
Students' major requirements are governed by the Bulletin in force at the
time of the declaration of the major. The declaration of major is initiated
with the head of the respective department.

At the discretion of the department chair, students may be required to
demonstrate proficiency and/or currency in the subject matter if the
major course work is older than five (5) academic years. Normally
credit hours earned in the major may not be applied to the completion of
the major, if the hours earned are older than eight years, dated from the
student's initial matriculation.

Students who have been out of school longer than two years must again
declare their majors.

Independent Study in the Major

In certain majors, independent study courses are offered. These courses
are limited to upper-class major and minor students who have completed
at least two-thirds of their particular major or minor program, and who
wish to pursue a special problem or course of reading beyond that taken
up in any formal course and lying within the capabilities of the library
and laboratories. In order to be eligible for independent study, the
student must have at least a 3.0 average in major courses. Total credit
which can be earned through independent study normally will not be
more than six semester hours. Written permission to enroll in such a
course must be obtained from the instructor, the chair of the department
I concerned, and the Vice President for Academic Affairs and Dean. A
descriptive syllabus including the method of evaluation must be
i submitted with the petition.

Assessment in the Major

The faculty members who are responsible for instruction in the major
programs have identified specific objectives for a major in that
discipline. There is an assessment, devised by the faculty in the

87

discipline that determines the extent to which the objectives have been
met by the student. That assessment is a requirement for students who
graduated in June 1990, or who will graduate thereafter. The assessment
styles are varied. Students should carefully explore with their adviser in
their intended major the nature of the assessment. A satisfactory
assessment in the major is a requirement for the degree. The chair of the
department offering the major must certify satisfactory completion of
the assessment component.

Students who fail to complete satisfactorily the assessment in the major
and exhaust reassessment opportunities at the departmental level may
appeal the decision of the department as described in the Academic
Procedures and Regulations section.

Advice and Counseling in the Major

All students are assigned an academic adviser. Prior to the declaration of
a major a student is advised by his or her Freshman Cornerstone
instructor. Subsequent to declaring a major, the student and the
department chair work together in planning a program. The ultimate
responsibility for selecting the proper courses in order to complete the
desired degree is the responsibility of the student.

Minors

Academic minors may be earned in most departments. A minor must
include at least 12 semester hours, 6 of which must be in 3000-level or
above courses. Some departments do not designate the courses required
for the minor, but the courses selected must be approved by the chair of
that department.

Pre-professional Programs of Study

LaGrange College has a curriculum and environment that is well suited
to preparation for further study in fields such as law and medicine.
These programs include, but are not necessarily limited to, preparation
for the following areas.

Dentistry

Dr. William McCoy is the general adviser. Students should consult
frequently with Dr. McCoy in addition to their primary advisors for
their majors. The pre-dental student should select a major as early as
possible and work toward the B.A. degree. Some dental schools accept
students with fewer than four years of college training, but most of them
prefer a student with the baccalaureate degree.

88

The pre-dental student should be familiar with the specific requirements
set by the dental schools to which he or she plans to apply. There is
some variation in the requirements of the various schools, but the
minimum requirements set by most schools of dentistry are:

Inorganic (General) Chemistry with lab 8 semester hours

Organic Chemistry with lab 8 semester hours

Biology with lab 8 semester hours

Physics with lab 8 semester hours

English 9 semester hours

All applicants must complete the Dental Admission Test not later than
the October 31 testing preceding the year of desired entry. Dental
schools also expect experience in the dental field. The student should
keep records of dates, duration and type of experience when involved in
shadowing, volunteer, or paid work.

Engineering

LaGrange College has an engineering-oriented program designed to
provide a broad liberal arts background while preparing the student for a
professional engineering program. Dual-degree programs in
engineering have been established with Georgia Institute of Technology
and Auburn University. Students accepted in the dual-degree program
will attend LaGrange College for approximately three years (81
semester hours if entering under this Bulletin) while they complete
the Core Curriculum and the pre-engineering courses listed at the end
of this section. The student will then attend the engineering institution
and complete a major in engineering, a process that generally takes two
to three additional years. After completion of the degree requirements
for both institutions, the student will receive an engineering degree
from the engineering institution and a Bachelor of Arts degree from
LaGrange College.

All students considering either the dual degree option should contact the
pre-engineering adviser, Dr. Bill McCoy, prior to registration. Students
must complete all components of the Core Curriculum, including the
exit Academic Profile exam before transferring to the engineering

89

institution. Pre-engineering students must complete all of the following
courses before attending the engineering institution:

Calculus I, II and III

Differential Equations

Linear Algebra (Ga. Tech.)

General Chemistry

General Physics I and II

Please note that calculus based physics (General Physics PHYS 1 121-1122)
is required. Students must begin the study of calculus as early as possible in
order to be prepared for the physics sequence.

Journalism

The student who plans a career in journalism needs a wide range of
courses in many areas. A recommended basic program would include:
ENGL 2260 Journalistic Writing I (3), ENGL 2262 Journalistic Writing
II (3), ARTD 2201 Graphic Design I: Fundamentals (3), ARTD 2223
Basic Photography (3), plus experience working on one of the
student publications:

The Hilltop News (paper)

The Scroll (magazine)

Specific courses to prepare for admission to individual schools should
be selected in consultation with the student's advisor.

Law

The pre-law advising committee is chaired by Dr. Tracy Lightcap and
is composed of Dr. Lightcap, Dr. Frederick Mills, and Dr. Brenda
Thomas. Students considering law school should consult with one of
these faculty members beginning in their freshman year and should
meet regularly with other students interested in pre-law. Law school
bulletins and LSAT study guides are located in the William and Evelyn
Banks Library.

Students entering law school come from varied undergraduate programs.
It is not really possible to say which major serves as the best preparatory
background for law school. Almost every law school bulletin, however,
suggests that entering students must have a strong background in
history, political science and English as well as some preparation in
economics, business, sociology, psychology and mathematics.

90

Medicine (M.D.)

Dr. William McCoy is the general adviser. Students should consult early
and frequently with Dr. McCoy in addition to their primary advisers for
their majors. The pre-medicine student should select a major as soon as
possible and seek the B.A. or B.S. degree. Medical schools rarely accept
candidates with less than the baccalaureate degree.

The student should be familiar with the requirements of the several
medical schools to which he or she plans to apply. Requirements vary
somewhat in the various medical schools, but the minimum
requirements of most medical schools are:

Biology with lab 8 semester hours

General Chemistry with lab 8 semester hours

Organic Chemistry 8 semester hours

Physics 8 semester hours

| Every applicant must take the Medical College Admission Test,
preferably in the spring preceding the submission of his or her
application to medical school, but no later than the fall of that year.
Students should take General Chemistry (CHEM1 101-1 102) as a
freshman to be on-track for the MCAT exam, normally taken in the
spring of Junior year. Biology 1 101-1 102 is also suggested for freshmen
year if scheduling allows. Medical schools also expect experience in
the field of medicine. Students should keep records of dates, duration
and types of experience when participating in shadowing or volunteer or
paid work in a hospital, doctor's office or other medical facility.

Optometry

The pre-optometry general adviser is Dr. William McCoy. Students
should consult early and frequently with Dr. McCoy in addition to their
primary advisers for their majors. Though selected students may be
admitted to optometry school after three years of preparation, most are
admitted after receiving Bachelors or Masters degrees. Optometry
involves fours years of study after admission to the program and in some
areas also includes a brief internship. Majors in any academic area are
acceptable though the student should include emphasis on the sciences.
The pre-optometry requirements are the same as pre-med plus a course
each in statistics and calculus. Preparation for admission to a specific
school can be planned with the assistance of the advisor. Prospective
optometry students must take the Optometry Admission Test (OAT) in
October or February.

91

Pharmacy

The pre-pharmacy general adviser is Dr. William McCoy. Students
should consult early and frequently with Dr. McCoy in addition to their
primary advisers for their majors. While the admission requirements
vary, the following is standard course work as a minimum: CHEM
1101-1102, 2201-2202, BIOL 1101-1 102, MATH 2221 and 1114,
PHYS 1101, ECON 2201-2202, ENGL 1101-1102, and 6 semester
hours each of Humanities and Social/Behavioral Science. POLS 1101
and HIST 1111 or 1112 may be required as well as electives to reach 60
semester hours.

Physical Therapy

The pre-physical therapy general adviser is Dr. William McCoy. A few
schools which offer training in physical therapy award a Bachelor's
degree after successful completion of classroom and clinical work.
Students are admitted to such programs after completion of 60 semester
hours of work including approximately 12 hours in Humanities, 12
hours in math and science, 12 hours in social science plus 24 hours in a
major field such as biology.

Specific courses to prepare for admission to individual schools should
be selected in consultation with the adviser. Many schools have moved
to the Doctor of Physical Therapy (DPT) degree. These schools require
a bachelor's degree as well as completion of the pre-physical therapy
core. Most schools look for experience working with or observing a
certified physical therapist. Students should keep records of dates and
duration of such experience.

Veterinary Medicine

Dr. William McCoy is the general adviser. Students should consult early
and frequently with Dr. McCoy in addition to their primary advisers for
their majors. The pre-veterinary student should be familiar with the
specific requirements of the school to which he/she plans to apply. The
minimum requirements set by most schools of veterinary medicine are
as follows:

A candidate must have completed at least 54 semester hours of college
credit by the end of the spring semester before fall matriculation at the
veterinary school. The baccalaureate degree is preferred. The following
courses should be completed prior to entry into veterinary school.

92

English 6 semester hours

I Biology with lab 8 semester hours

Advanced Biological Science 8 semester hours

Physics 8 semester hours

Biochemistry 3 semester hours

Inorganic (General) Chemistry with lab 8 semester hours

Organic Chemistry with lab 8 semester hours

The candidate must have worked with a veterinarian, and must have had
hands-on experience working with large and small animals.

Each applicant will be required to take the Graduate Record
Examination (GRE) and the GRE biology subject test. These tests
should be taken in October or December of the year prior to probable
admission to veterinary school. The results should be received by
VMCAS by February 1 of the year following the application.

Summary List of Majors and Minors Offered at
LaGrange College

Major

Minor

Accountancy

X

X

Art and Design

X

X

Biochemistry

X

Business Management

X

X

Chemistry

X

X

Coaching

X

Computer Science

X

X

Education

X

English

X

X

cont on 94

93

Major

Minor

French

X

History

X

X

Human Services

X

X

Interdisciplinary Studies

X

Latin American Studies

X

Mathematics

X

X

Music (B.A.)

X

X

Music (B.M.)

X

X

Nursing

X

Philosophy

X

Political Science

X

X

Psychology

X

X

Religion

X

X

Church Leadership

X

X

Sociology

X

X

Spanish

X

X

Theatre Arts

X

X

Women's Studies

X

Evening College degrees:

Associate of Arts In Liberal Studies

Bachelor of Arts in Business

Bachelor or Arts in Human Development

Graduate degrees:

Master of Education in Curriculum and Instruction

Master of Arts in Teaching

Art Education (MAT)

Secondary Education (MAT)

94

Endowed Lectureship

The Jennie Lee Epps Memorial Lecture was re-established in 1997 by
a gift from Dr. Grace Hadaway Boswell '49 and her husband, Dr. R.
Dean Boswell. Dr. Epps was a faculty member from 1931 until her
death in 1961.

The Waights G. Henry, Jr., Endowed Lectureship was established by
a gift from the Neighbors Fund, Inc. in memory of Dr. Henry, president
and chancellor of LaGrange College over a period of 42 years. Income
from the endowment is to be used in funding the Waights G. Henry
Lecture for the benefit of our students and as approved by the trustees of
the College.

The Arthur H. Thompson Lectureship brings to the campus a noted
scholar to address the faculty and student body on the interrelationship
of a field knowledge and the Christian religion. The endowment was
established by Mrs. Mary Will Thompson, class of 1898, in memory of
her husband, who served as chairman of the Board of Trustees of the
College. He expressed his philosophy in the statement: " The greatest
thing in life is the simple faith of an honest man."

The Lorenzo Valla Visiting Scholar Program was established in 1996
by Mr. and Mrs. Tom Bushar (Linda Doolittle Bushar '96) The program
was named for the 15 th century Italian humanist and brings to campus a
recognized scholar.

Awards and Recognitions

The Nancy Alford Award is awarded each year to the sorority
accumulating the greatest number of points in the areas of scholarship,
leadership, sportsmanship, and community service.

The Irene E. Arnett Drama Award is presented annually to the
member of the senior class who shows that greatest potential for
contribution to the field of theatre, devotion to the tasks in the theatre,
and dedication to the principles of good theatre- to amuse the heart and
lift the spirit to a better understanding of man and his struggle in this
world and towards his God.

The Needham Avery Art Award is a purchase award granted
annually in visual arts, provided by Dr. and Mrs. R.M. Avery in
memory of their son.

The Josephine A. Case Scholarship is awarded to a junior for
excellence in art and promise of achievement in that field. This award
carries a stipend and is associated with the Josephine A. Case Collection
of American Indian Art which Mrs. Case and her husband, the late Dr.

95

Leland D. Case of Tucson, donated to LaGrange College. Both hold
honorary doctorates from this school.

The Frances Marion Chalker Medlock Prize for Poetry is awarded to
a student exhibiting profound love and appreciation of poetry in memory
of Frances Marion Chalker Medlock. The deserving student is chosen by
the English Department.

The Austin P. Cook Award is presented annually by the Student
Government Association to the organization that made the most positive
impact on campus life during the year.

The Roger Guptill Award is presented annually in memory of the late
Dr. Roger Guptill, minister, teacher, and Christian gentleman, to a senior
class student of the Department of Religion preparing for full-time
church service.

The Mamie Lark Henry Drama Scholarship is presented annually
to a student in recognition of superior contribution to the Theatre
Arts Department.

The Mamie Lark Henry Scholarship Cup is presented each semester
to a sorority with the highest grade-point average the previous semester.

The Waights G. Henry, Jr., Leadership Award is given annually by
the Student Government Association to a student who has actively
demonstrated effective leadership skills. Selection of the recipient is
made by a committee composed of students, faculty, and administrators.

The Evelyn Powell Hoffman Drama Scholarship is provided by her
family in memory of their wife, mother and sister, a graduate of the class
of 1930. It is to be awarded annually to a freshman student through
audition. The selection of the recipient is to be made by the Theatre
Arts Department faculty.

The Karen Sue Kafrouni Award is presented annually by the History
Department for a member of Phi Alpha Theta and a graduating senior
with the highest academic achievement.

The Mary Hunter Lindsey Award is provided by the late Rev.
William Oliver Lindsey, Sr., in memory of his wife, Mary Hunter
Lindsey, class of 1914. It is awarded annually to United Methodist
students entering the senior class in college and preparing for a full-time
church ministry. The selection of the awardees is made by the faculty of
the Religion Department.

The John Love Scholarship Cup is presented each semester to the
fraternity with the highest grade point average the previous semester.

96

The Weston L. Murray Award is presented to the senior class member
of the Georgia Delta Chapter of Pi Gamma Mu who has the highest
record of achievement and contribution in the field of Social Science.

The Meri Meriwether Norris Award was established in 1998 in
memory of this 1980 alumna by her husband, Dr. Tommy Norris. This
award is presented annually to a nursing student who demonstrates
extraordinary compassion.

The Outstanding Achievement in Psychology Award is presented
annually by the psychology department to the senior psychology major
who, through academic excellence and service, has made an outstanding
contribution to the field of psychology.

The Pike Award is provided by Mrs. William C. Key (Ruth Pike) and
the late Mrs. William Franklin Daugherty (Ethel Pike) in memory of
Adelia Hunter and Christian Nathaniel Pike. It is awarded annually to
Methodist or Baptist students entering the senior class in college and
preparing for a full-time church vocation or majoring in Religion or
Religious Education.

The Walter Malcolm Shackelford Award is presented annually
to a graduating senior who has majored in Education and has
demonstrated outstanding academic performance, leadership, and
service to the College.

The Annie Moore Smith Award is a purchase award given annually in
visual arts, provided by Mrs. Rebecca Moore Butler, class of 1924, in
memory of her sister, Annie Moore Smith, class of 1915.

; The W. Lee Wilson, Jr., Art Award is presented annually by the Art
Department to a graduating senior who has excelled in the art of
photography. Mr. William L. Wilson established the award in 1998 in
memory of his son.

The Jean Young Award in Photography granted annually, was
established in memory of Jean Young who was the first curator of the
Lamar Dodd Art Center. The award is a book on contemporary
photography and is presented to the student who has demonstrated an
exceptional commitment to photographic art.

Departmental Awards are presented annually at Honors Day in the
spring. Numerous departmental awards are made at that time.

97

Departments and Courses

Table of Contents 4

Academic Divisions 100

Abbreviations and Numbers 102

Art and Design 103

Professor John Lawrence

Biology 112

Dr. William McCoy

Business 115

Dr. Jon Birkeli

Accountancy 121

Dr. Lydia Rosencrants

Chemistry 129

Dr. William McCoy

Computer Science 140

Dr. Fay Riddle

Core Curriculum 149

Dr. Sarah Beth Mallory

Education 151

Dr. Don Livingston

English 160

Dr. Laine Scott

Health and Physical Education 168

Professor Nancy Alford

History 175

Dr. Fred Mills

Human Services 180

Professor Anton Flores

Latin American Studies and Modern Languages 185

Dr. Amanda Plumlee

Mathematics 194

Dr. Greg McClanahan

Music 202

< Dr. Toni Anderson

Nursing 216

Dr. Celia Hay

Physics 226

Dr. William McCoy

Political Science 227

Dr. Tracy Lightcap

Psychology 234

Dr. Chuck Kraemer

Religion and Philosophy 240

Dr. David Ahearn

Sociology 248

Dr. Susan Cody

Theatre Arts 253

Professor Kim Barber

Women's Studies 260

Dr. Amanda Plumlee

99

ACADEMIC DIVISIONS,
DEPARTMENTS, AND COURSES

Arts Kim Barber, Chair

Professors: Anderson, Lawrence, Taunton

Associate Professors: Barber, M. Brown, Edwards, L. Johnson, Reneke

Assistant Professors: Tomschek, Turner

This division includes the Departments of Art and Design, Music, and

Theatre Arts. The B.A. and B.M. degrees are offered.

Core Program and Interim Term Sarah Beth Mallory, Chair

Humanities and Social Sciences David Ahearn, Chair

Professors: Cafaro, Dulin-Mallory, Mills, Slay, Thomas

Associate Professors: Ahearn, Cook, O'Connor, Plumlee,

Scott, Williams, Lightcap, Simmons

Assistant Professors: Cody, Flores, Gulley, Lee, Lingenfelter, Shirley,

Tures , Wilson

This division offering the B. A. Degree includes the following

departments:

English Language and Literature, History, Human Services, Latin

American Studies and Modern Languages,

Political Science, Religion and Philosophy

Professional Programs Maranah Sauter, Chair

Professors: Birkeli, Sauter

Associate Professors: Barrett, Hillyer, Rosencrants, Williamson

Assistant Professors: Alford, Bearden, Blair, Frederick, Geeter,

Hampton, Hay, Livingston, Messer, Yates

This division includes the following departments:
Department of Business offering The B. S. in Business Management, B.
S. in Accountancy, minor in Business Management, minor in
Accountancy, Department of Education offering: The B.A. M.A.T. and
M.Ed, degrees Department of Health and Physical Education,
Department of Nursing offering the B.S.N.

Science and Mathematics Greg McClanahan, Chair

Professors: Evans, Hurd, Kraemer, McClanahan, McCoy, Riddle,

Shelhorse,

Associate Professors: Haas, Mallory, Paschal, C. Yin, W. Yin

Assistant Professors: Hall, Hwang, Pomeroy-Black

100

The Natural Sciences and Mathematics Division includes the
Departments of Biology, Chemistry and Physics, Computer Science,
Mathematics and Psychology. The B.A. and B.S. degrees are offered.

Course Numbering System and Abbreviations

The projected schedule of classes will be followed insofar as possible,
but is subject to change.

Courses numbered 1 100 through 1 199 are intended primarily for
freshmen and sophomores. Courses numbered 2200 to 2299 are intended
primarily for sophomores; the number may, alternately, mean credit of
less than three semester hours.

Courses numbered 3300 through 3399 and above are intended primarily
for juniors and seniors.

Courses numbered 4400 through 4499 are intended primarily for seniors.
The number in parentheses following the course title indicates the number
of semester hours credit for the course.

101

Abbreviations

Accountancy

ACCT

Art and Design

ARTD

Biology

BIOL

Chemistry

CHEM

Computer Science

CSCI

Core

CORE

Economics

ECON

Education

EDUC

Early Childhood

EDUC

Middle Grades

EDUC

English

ENGL

Finance

FNCE

French

FREN

German

GERM

Health and Physical Education

HPED

Physical Education

PEDU

History

HIST

Human Services

HUSV

Language

LANG

Latin American Studies

LAST

Library Science

LIBR

Management

MGMT

Marketing

MRKT

Mathematics

MATH

Music

MUSI

Nursing

NURS

Philosophy

PHIL

Physics

PHYS

Political Science

POLS

Psychology

PSYC

Religion

RLGN

Spanish

SPAN

Theatre Arts

THEA

Women's Studies

WMST

102

ART AND DESIGN

Introduction

The Department of Art and Design offers major concentrations in
painting/drawing, graphic/surface design, printmaking,ceraics/sculpture,
photography and in art history/museum studies. The courses required of
the studio concentration are specific and scheduling should be
determined in consultation with an art faculty advisor. A student may
choose a studio concentration in more than one area.

Objectives

The follow objectives are established as a basis for the Art and Design
Studio Program at LaGrange College:

to develop technical knowledge pertaining primarily to the
student's chosen area of concentration, but not limited to it.

to assist students in finding and focusing their creative ideas into a
consistent body of work.

to instruct students in the correct means of presenting their work in
a portfolio and culminating a required senior exhibition.

to encourage students to exhibit their work and acquaint them with
the gallery system.

to encourage students to pursue graduate study.

to provide students with a basic understanding of the history of
Western art.

to provide the students with a creative environment by using all
available resources. This would include field trips to galleries
and museums, course work in locations of artistic interest,
guest lectures and workshops related to the exhibitions in the
College's galleries.

Requirements for a Studio Concentration
major in Art and Design:

9 hrs. Art History - ARTD 1 109, 1 1 10, 1 1 1 1 or an
Art History elective

9 hrs. Basic Core - These should be taken during the

freshman/sophomore year as these courses are generally
considered to be prerequisites for all other studio courses -
ARTD 1151, 1152, 1153

103

12 hrs. Introductory Studio Courses: One course from each
of the following studio disciplines:

Painting or Drawing

Design or Printmaking

Photography

Ceramics or Sculpture

9 hrs. Major Concentration - three additional courses in

one of the above disciplines including Senior Seminar.

3 hrs. Senior Seminar - A course in which senior art majors
bring into focus their artistic objectives in a body of
work to be presented in an exhibition. The student
will also create an artists' statement, resume and a
slide portfolio.

42 hrs total hours required

Assessment

Success in achieving the objectives of the Art and Design major will be
measured in the following ways:

Completion of each major course with a grade of C or better

Exemplary completion of assignments and independent study, and
the presentation of work in scheduled critiques.

An Exit or Senior Exhibition of work done in the student's major
studio discipline.

requirements for art hlstory/museum studies
Concentration

The Art History/Museum Studies Concentration offers two options. A
student may focus on art history or may choose a combination of art
history and museology. Courses include art history, graphic design,
studio courses, and an internship. The program also offers hands-on
experience in the exhibition program and the regular collection of the
Lamar Dodd Art Center.

104

Requirements for a Concentration in Art
History:

6 hrs. Art History Survey I and II - ARTD 1 109, 1 1 10

15 hrs. Art History courses - Modern Art, The Art of Greece
and Rome, Art of the Renaissance, Art of the
Seventeenth and Eighteenth Centuries in Europe and
America, Art of the Nineteenth Century in Europe and
America.- ARTD 1111,3103,3105,3106,3107

12 hrs. Studio Courses

3 hrs. Internship or Independent Study in Art History

3 hrs. Senior Seminar - A course in which senior art history and
museum studies students work on research and writing
skills. They also prepare a resume and focus on applying
for graduate school.

39 total hours required

Requirements for a major in Art History/
Museum Studies Concentration:

6 hrs. Art History Survey I and II - ARTD 1 109, 1 1 10

12 hrs. Art History electives - Modern Art, The Art of Greece
and Rome, Art of the Renaissance, Art of the
Seventeenth and Eighteenth Centuries in Europe and
America, Art of the Nineteenth Century in Europe and
America.- ARTD 1111,3103,3105,3106

9 hrs. Studio Coursework - Three courses in elective studio

3 hrs. Graphic Design - ARTD 2201

6 hrs. Museum Studies I and II - ARTD 3102, 3102

3 hrs. Internship

39 hrs. total hours required

105

Assessment

Success in achieving the objectives of the Art History/Museum Studies
Concentration will be measured in the following ways:

Sophomore review

Completion of each major course with a grade of C or better

Participation in the Art History Forum or other public presentation
of research

Awards

The Art and Design Department presents four awards annually during
Honor's Day Convocation. These are purchase awards that allow the
college to acquire works of art by the award recipients. The faculty of
the Art and Design Department presents these awards to students for
superior performance and a proven commitment to their craft.

Minor

A minor in Art and Design, Art History/Museum Studies consists of 18
semester hours: at least one course in art history, at least one course at
the 1000 level, and 4 other courses selected in consultation with your
minor advisor.

Course Descriptions (ARTD)

ARTD 1109 Art History Survey I. (3) * Fall
A course in the visual arts of western civilization from the Paleolithic
period through the 16 th century. Cultures surveyed will include
Egyptian, Mesopotamian, Greek, Roman, Early Christian, Byzantine,
Medieval, Gothic and the Early Renaissance.

ARTD 1110 Art History Survey II. (3) * Spring - alternate years
This course will survey the history of Western art and architecture from
the High Renaissance to the beginning of the 20 th century, including the
stylistic movements of the Baroque, Rococo, Neoclassicism,
Romanticism, Realism, Impressionism, Expressionism and Cubism.

ARTD 1111 Modern and Contemporary Art History. (3) *

Spring- alternate years.
This course traces the development of 20th century painting and
sculpture beginning with Picasso and cubism and includes the
movements of surrealism, futurism, abstract - expressionism, pop, op,

106

minimalism, conceptual art, super realism and neo-expressionism.
While emphasis is given to painting and sculpture, developments in
architecture, photography and crafts are also included.

ARTD1151 Basic Drawing. (3)* Fall
A course in drawing fundamentals, including line, value,
composition, perspective, and chiaroscuro. A variety of drawing
media will be explored.

ARTD 1152 2-D Design. (3) * Spring

A study of the basic design elements and principles. Emphasis will be
on creative problem solving and development of unified designs. A
study of color theory and relationships will be included.

ARTD 1153 3-D Design. (3) * Fall

This course will explore the fundamentals of three-dimensional form
using various materials such as wood, clay, plaster, paper, etc.
I Craftsmanship, creative thought, and transformation of ideas into
form while becoming familiar with proper use of tools and equipment is
also emphasized.

ARTD 2201 Graphic Design I: Fundamentals. (3) Fall
An introduction to the fundamentals of graphic design, including
typography, and layout. Basic Macintosh computer skills will be
covered, including working with fonts, system basics, printers and
service bureaus, and understanding file formats.

ARTD 2211 Life Drawing. (3) Spring

A course in the study of human anatomy and the expressive potential of
the human form. Drawing from the model, both nude and clothed, and
from the skeleton using a variety of drawing media.

Prerequisite: ARTD 1151 (Basic Drawing) or permission of instructor

I ARTD 2222 Graphic Design II: Logos and concepts. (3) Spring
A course exploring the development of graphic ideas through projects in

i advertising, layout, corporate identity, magazine and poster design.
Students will be exposed to basic concepts of logo design.
Prerequisite: ARTD 2201

ARTD 2223 Basic Photography. (3) * Fall

An introductory course in black and white photography. The course
i includes the mechanics of the camera, film exposure for zone placement,
| film processing and printing from the negative as well as a survey of the
; history of photography.

107

ARTD2224 Photography II . (3) Spring
A course in studio and large format photography using both black /
white and color materials. Projects are assigned in lighting, exposure
controls using sheet film with the 4 x 5 and 8x10 view camera, film
processing, printing, and advanced techniques of photographing the still
life, portraits, architecture, landscape, and in commercial applications
of photography.

ARTD 2227 Ceramics-Methods and Materials (3) * Fall
This course is an introduction to ceramic methods and techniques. It
will explore both wheelthrowing and hand building used in forming
vessels and sculpture. This will include using the potter's wheel, slabs,
coils, textures to create form. Glazing, decoration and firing methods
such as raku, pitfire and standard reduction will also be emphasized.

ARTD 2229 Ceramics-Wheelthrowing. (3) * Spring
This course is an introduction to basic wheelthrowing techniques,
beginning with centering and opening then progressing to pulling basic
cylindrical forms, teapots and bottles. Glazing, decoration and firing
methods such as raku, pitfire, and standard reduction are also included.

ARTD 2271 Beginning Painting, (3) Fall
An introduction to painting with acrylics of oils. Projects will explore
the fundamentals of composition and modeling with color and light, as
well as abstraction and mixed media.
Prerequisite: ARTD 1151 (Basic Drawing) or permission of instructor

ARTD 2272 Sculpture I . (3) * Spring
The projects in this class will address both traditional and
contemporary issues in sculpture such as figure modeling, carving,
found object sculpture, narrative imagery, environmental sculpture and
metal working.

ARTD 2273 Printmaking I. (3) * Fall

A course in the basics of intaglio and relief printmaking techniques,

selected print and book arts media, and the development of creative

imagery.

ARTD 3101 Museum Studies I (3) Fall
In addition to textbook study, students are actively engaged in the
activities of the Lamar Dodd Art Center: cataloguing the collection,
organizing and hanging exhibitions, and overseeing the gallery's daily
activities. Students visit area museums not only to view their collections
and special exhibitions, but also to learn from museum personnel about
the functioning of a museum.

108

ARTD 3102 Museum Studies II (3) Spring
This course traces the history of museums, discusses contemporary
practice in museums, and examines current issues in the Museology. It
explores the museum's mission and its role in society through case
studies and exhibitions in a variety of museums: art, living history,
history, children's, and ethnographic.
Prerequisites: ARTD 3101 (Museum Studies I)

ARTD 3103 The Art of Greece and Rome (3)* Spring
This course focuses on the art of Greece and Rome, emphasizing the
historical and cultural context of the works studied.
Prerequisite: ARTD 1 109 (Art History Survey I) or permission
of instructor

ARTD 3105 Art of the Renaissance (3)* Fall
This course focuses on the painting, sculpture, and architecture of the
Renaissance, considering the works in their historical and cultural context.
Prerequisites: ARTD 1110 (Art History Survey II) or permission
of instructor

ARTD 3106 Art of the Seventeenth and Eighteenth Centuries in

Europe and America (3)* Spring
This course examines works of painting, sculpture, and architecture
created in Western Europe and in the United States during the
seventeenth and eighteenth centuries and explores the cultural and
historical circumstances of their creation.
Prerequisites: ARTD 1110 (Art History Survey II) or permission

of instructor

ARTD 3107 Art of the Nineteenth Century in Europe

and America (3)* Fall
This course focuses on the painting, sculpture, photography, and
graphics of the nineteenth century in Europe and America.
Prerequisites: ARTD 1110 (Art History Survey II) or permission

of instructor

ARTD 3108 Art of the Non-Western World. (3)* Spring

This course treats the art of non-western cultures: South and Southeast

Asia, China, Japan, Korea, Pre-Columbian America, Africa and Oceania.

ARTD 3222 Digital Imaging. (3) Spring

A course dealing with the art of computer technology, with emphasis on
' photographic image manipulation. Emphasis will be placed on
developing creative personal imagery.
Prerequisite: ARTD 2201 or permission of instructor

109

ARTD 3301 Advanced Graphic Design. (3) Fall
This course explores advanced design principles in such areas as applied
surface design, fundamental web design, and advanced topics in
typography, layout and corporate identity. The course is designed to
assist students in developing a portfolio of their work.
Prerequisite: ARTD 2201, ARTD 2222, ARTD 3222

ARTD 3311 Advanced Life Drawing. (3) Spring
Advanced work with the figure in projects exploring composition and
subjective expression.
Prerequisite: ARTD 2211

ARTD 3323 Photography III. (3) Fall

Advanced work in black and white photography to illustrate social and
narrative issues relevant to the photographer's concerns. Emphasis will
be placed on documentary photography, its history and the stylistic
techniques of contemporary photojournalism. Projects dealing with
reportage, illustration, documentation and the photographic essay will
be assigned.
Prerequisite: ARTD 2223 or consent of instructor.

ARTD 3324 Photography IV. (3) Spring

Independent studio experience in advanced large format photography.
Each student will create a series of projects based on the concepts
presented in ARTD 2224.

Prerequisite: ARTD 2224

ARTD 3327 Intermediate Ceramics. (3) Fall
This course will emphasize ceramic design using hand building and/or
wheelthrowing techniques. Projects are flexible in their construction
method in order to accommodate different ability levels and interests.
Projects with commercial potential such as lamp bases, teapots, covered
jars and tile, etc. will be explored. Glazing, decoration and firing methods
such as raku, pitfire, and standard reduction are also emphasized.
Prerequisite: ARTD 2227, 2229 or consent of instructor

ARTD 3329 Advanced Ceramics (3) Spring
This course is designed to allow the student to independently explore
methods and techniques covered in previous ceramic classes.
Prerequisite: ARTD 2227, ARTD 2229, 3327

ARTD 3341 Internship. (3-9) Fall, January, Spring
A supervised experience in an off campus professional environment
such as a photography studio, a surface or graphic design studio, or a
museum or gallery administrative office.

110

ARTD 3351 - 3352 Senior Seminar. (3-6) Fall and Spring

An independent studio experience where the advanced and senior status
art major brings into focus and produces a body of work in one or two
disciplines. The student may take from 3 to 6 hours of credit in this course
depending on the student's interest. The course includes discussion and
readings in contemporary theory and criticism, field trips to museums and
galleries, the creation of a personal artist statement, group critiques,
writing a vitae, and business and graduate school opportunities.

ARTD 3371 Intermediate Painting. (3) Fall

Advanced work in either acrylics or oils. Projects will allow for the
development of personal imagery, experimental approaches to the
media, and other advanced concepts.

Prerequisite: ARTD 2271 or 2275

ARTD 3372 Sculpture Methods II. (3) Spring
This course is designed to allow the student to independently explore
ideas, methods and techniques covered in previous sculpture classes.
Prerequisite: ARTD 2272

ARTD 3373 Printmaking II. (3) Fall

A continuation of Art 2273 including advanced exploration of color
prints and other selected print and book arts media.
Prerequisite: ARTD 2273

ARTD 3375 Advanced Painting. (3) Spring
A further exploration of either oils or acrylics. Students develop a series
of paintings that explore specific imagery, materials, or techniques.
Prerequisite: consent of instructor

* Denotes courses in Art and Design that may satisfy Fine Arts
requirements in Core Curriculum

111

BIOLOGY

Specific Objectives for the Major

The biology faculty works with their majors to help them develop an
understanding and working knowledge of the life phenomenon from the
subcellular through the organismic level. All majors will have the
opportunity to learn about the diversity of living organisms and the
significance of these organisms to the natural ecosystem and to man's
economy. All majors will learn about the human as a model for
anatomy, physiology, histology and embryonic development, as a host
of parasites and as a product of organic evolution. Biology students will
also gain an understanding of life on a smaller scale as they encounter
patterns of inheritance, gene action, microbiology, life at the cellular
level and the impact of microorganisms.

Method of Accomplishing Objectives

The student is presumed to have accomplished the general and specific
objectives by satisfactorily completing the courses which constitute the
major. A major in biology consists of the following courses: Biology
1101-1102, 2201-2202, 3301-3302, 4401-4402 and Chemistry 1101-
1 102. The student may choose from Math 2105 (precalculus), Math
2221 (calculus I), Math 1 1 14 (statistics), and Core 1 1 10 (quantitative
reasoning) to satisfy the math requirement for the Biology Major.
Typically a student who starts in Biology 1101 and 1 102 as a freshman
will take the Organismic Biology block as a sophomore, the Human
Biology block as a junior and the Cell and Molecular Biology block as a
senior. It is recommended that the student take Biology 1101 and 1 102
as a freshman or sophomore. Students who are preparing for entrance
into graduate school or professional schools may need to take additional
chemistry, math and physics courses as indicated in the Pre-Professional
and Co-operative Programs section of this catalog.

Demonstration of Accomplishment of
Objectives

The student will demonstrate that he has accomplished the objectives of
the major by passing the departmental exit exam at the 70% level or
higher. The Biology department continues to use the success of its
graduates in the job market and in advanced study as a gauge of the
applicability of its goals and the success of its students in attaining
these goals.

112

Career Options

Graduates of the College who have majored in biology typically pursue
careers in teaching, pharmacy, medicine, dentistry, veterinary medicine
or physical therapy. In addition, many graduates find employment in
industry-some in laboratories, some in management and others in
research and development. Most careers require further formal study in
graduate or professional schools.

Course Descriptions (BIOL)

BIOL 1101 General Biology I. (4) Fall, Spring
This is the beginning Biology course for majors and non-majors. It is a
pre-requisite to all other biology courses except for Human Anatomy
and Physiology. General Biology deals with the phenomenon of life as
is manifested in all types of living organisms. The origin of life,
chemistry of life, cellular and tissue organization, metabolism, cell
division, genetics, gene action and functioning of the organ systems are
among topics covered in General Biology. There are no pre-requisites
to General Biology I.

BIOL 1102 General Biology II. (4) Spring
This course is a continuation of General Biology I.
Prerequisite: BIOL 1101

BIOL 1148 Human Anatomy and Physiology I. (4) Fall
A study of the structure and function of the human body. Designed for
nursing majors. May be taken as core science requirement and may be
substituted for BIOL 1 101 as a prerequisite to BIOL 2320.
Prerequisite: none

BIOL 1149 Human Anatomy and Physiology II. (4) Spring
A continuation of Human Anatomy and Physiology I.
Prerequisite: none

BIOL 2201 Organismic Biology I. (4) Fall
Organismic Biology deals with the organisms, populations and
ecosystems as the targeted level or organization. Organic evolution as
a source of diversity of organisms, schemes of classification of
organisms and the biology of the organisms themselves are the chief
targets of this course. Population dynamics and ecological interactions
are also included.
Prerequisites: BIOL 1101 and 1102

113

BIOL 2202 Organismic Biology II. (4) Spring
This course is a continuation of Organismic Biology I.
Prerequisite: BIOL 2201

BIOL 2320 Medical Microbiology. (4) Spring
A study of human disease caused by pathogenic microbes and
helminthes. Laboratory activities focus on bacteria as model organisms.
Prerequisites: BIOL 1 101 and 1 102, or BIOL 1 148 and 1 149

BIOL 3301 Human Biology I. (4) Fall

An examination of the human body emphasizing embryology, anatomy,
physiology, histology, neurobiology and evolution. Designed for upper-
level Biology majors.
Prerequisites: BIOL 1101 and 1102

BIOL 3302 Human Biology II. (4) Spring
A continuation of Human Biology I.
Prerequisite: BIOL 3301

BIOL 4401 Cell and Molecular Biology I. (4) Fall
A study of morphology, physiology, heredity, classification, ecology,
pathology and host defense at the cellular level, with laboratory
activities involving prokaryotes and eukaryotes. Senior status required.
Prerequisite: BIOL 1102

BIOL 4402 Cell and Molecular Biology II. (4) Spring
A continuation of BIOL 4401.
Prerequisite: BIOL 4401

BIOL 4495 Independent Study/Internship (1-4) On demand
Although not required as part of the biology major nor available as a
substitute for any of the biology major courses, this course provides an
opportunity for students, on an individual basis, to pursue in-depth study
of a particular biology topic or to gain added experience and insight
through internship in off-campus settings.
Prerequisite: Consent of the instructor and the Academic Dean

114

BUSINESS AND ACCOUNTANCY

Introduction

The Business Department of LaGrange College is committed to
academic excellence through degree programs designed to prepare
students for a wide variety of careers in business. The liberal arts
education that students receive at LaGrange College provides the
foundation for critical thinking, communication, and the leadership
skills needed for a successful professional career. The department seeks
to enhance the College's liberal arts curriculum by offering coursework
and internship opportunities that give students a fundamental
understanding of business and provide them with the knowledge and
skills needed for effective decision making in a dynamic, global, and
technologically oriented environment.

Mission Statement

We are dedicated to the development of our students' abilities to
think critically and creatively and to the enhancement of their
communication skills.

We seek to integrate and extend liberal arts-based values through
discussion, discovery, and reflection based on contemporary
business content.

We seek to provide a safe, caring and ethical place for all our
students to grow and mature.

Learning Outcomes of Our Programs

Upon completion of a degree from the Business Department, a student
should be able to:

Demonstrate general knowledge and comprehension of business
concepts and the ability to integrate this knowledge.

Synthesize and make connections among different ideas, as well as
demonstrate the ability to think creatively and critically, and to
formulate logical arguments.

Show an intrinsic desire to learn and a curiosity about the world and
about business by actively participating in class, group work, and
individual research.

Formulate and defend ethical judgments and develop an
understanding of individual moral responsibility, particularly in a
group or corporate setting.

115

Communicate in a professional manner, both orally and in writing,
using technology appropriately.

Work in teams and demonstrate an understanding of interpersonal
relations, and the leadership and followership processes.

Accept and embrace risk and uncertainty in the business
environment.

Programs

The following programs are available:

Bachelor of Science (B.S.) in Accountancy

Bachelor of Science (B.S.) in Business Management

Minor in Accountancy

Minor in Business Management

Bachelor of Arts (B.A.) in Business Administration (See separate
LC Evening College Bulletin)

The Bachelors programs are accredited nationally by the Association of
Collegiate Business Schools and Programs (ACBSP).

Accountancy and Business Majors

Business majors (B.S. in Accountancy and B.S. in Business
Management) should note that the applicable requirements for the
major, including required courses, are those in effect when they declare
their major, not those in effect at the time of their matriculation.

In addition to the course requirements, students pursuing a Bachelor's
degree offered by the Business Department must participate in a
comprehensive Departmental Assessment Program (DAP).

Program Requirements for the B.S. in
Accountancy

The B.S. in Accountancy gives students the accounting foundation
needed for effective decision making in an organization. Today's
accountants must be able to communicate, synthesize and innovate;
they not only provide the information upon which the business world
depends, but also make crucial decisions and act as trusted advisors.
The Accountancy major builds upon the liberal arts skill base to give
students the business and accounting knowledge they will need. The

116

student planning to work in the accounting function will receive the
necessary skills and knowledge to pursue the CMA and CFM
professional designations and be prepared for the fifth year of study for
the CPA.

To declare a major in Accountancy the student must meet the
following criteria:

1 . Have a GPA of 2.75/4.00 or better.

2. Complete MGMT 2200, ECON 2200, and ACCT 221 1 with a grade
of 'B' or better.

To remain a major in Accountancy in good standing, the student must
meet the following criteria:

1 . Complete all other major requirements with a grade of C or better.

2. Maintain an overall and major GPA of at least 2.50/4.00.

Exceptions to the above criteria may be made at the discretion of the
departmental faculty. Any accountancy major whose overall GPA or
major GPA falls below a 2.50/4.00 will be placed on probation and has
one semester in which to remove the probationary status. Failure to do
so will result in being dismissed from the Accountancy program.

Students pursuing a Bachelor of Science degree in Accountancy must
complete 57 semester credit hours of accountancy and business
coursework (above the general education requirements) for a total of
1 17 semester hours. The required courses for the B.S. in Accountancy
include the following:

ACCT 2211
ACCT 3354
ACCT 4430
ECON 2200
MGMT 3312
MGMT 4440
Major Elective

ACCT 3301
ACCT 4401
ACCT 4440
FNCE 3353
MGMT 3351
MRKT 3380

ACCT 3302
ACCT 4410
ACCT 4488
MGMT 2200
MGMT 3370
Major Elective

Accountancy majors must complete all of the general requirements
except CORE 1110, Quantitative Reasoning. MATH 1 1 14 must
substitute for this requirement.

117

Students will complete the 1 17 hours in the following manner:

Core requirements 48 hours

Major requirements 57 hours

Interim 9 hours

General Elective 3 hours

Total 117 hours

Students planning to pursue licensure as a Certified Public Accountant
(CPA) are required by Georgia law to complete 150 semester credit
hours. Although a total of 1 17 hours are required for a B.S. degree in
Accountancy, it is recommended that students pursuing CPA licensure
complete 120 semester hours during their first four years of study. The
Accountancy Program Director will assist students in determining how
they should acquire the final 30 semester hours needed. Students are
eligible to sit for the uniform CPA examination upon graduation with
the B.S. in Accountancy degree.

Program Requirements for the B.S. in Business
Management

The B.S. in Business Management degree program is designed to help
students develop ideals that are ethically sound and socially desirable,
cultivate an awareness of the social, political, and economic
developments to which businesses must adapt, develop sound judgment
and effective communication skills, and develop individual interests and
talents. Coursework provides both the theoretical and practical
foundation needed for those entering businesses, as well as government
and not-for-profit organizations.

To declare a major in Business Management the student must have an
overall and major GPA of 2.75/4.00 or better.

To remain a major in Business in good standing, the student must meet
the following criteria:

1 . Complete all other major requirements with a grade of 'C or better.

2. Maintain an overall and major GPA of at least 2.50/4.00.

Exceptions to the above criteria may be made at the discretion of the
departmental faculty. Any Business major whose overall or major GPA
falls below a 2.50/4.00 will be placed on probation and has one semester
in which to remove the probationary status. Failure to do so will result
in being dismissed from the Business program.

118

Students pursuing a Bachelor of Science degree in Business must
complete 48 semester credit hours of major coursework (above the
general education requirements). A total of 108 semester hours is
required for graduation. The required courses for the B.S. in
Business include the following:

ACCT2211
MGMT 2200
MGMT 3370
MGMT 3385
MRKT 3380
Major Elective

ECON 2200
MGMT 3312
MGMT 3372
MGMT 3388
Major Elective

FNCE 3354
MGMT 3351
MGMT 3377
MGMT 4440
Major Elective

Business majors must complete all of the general requirements except
CORE 1110, Quantitative Reasoning. MATH 1114 must substitute
for this requirement.
Students will complete the 108 hours as follows:

Core requirements 48 hours

Major requirements 48 hours

Interim 9 hours

General Elective 3 hours

Total

108 hours

Accountancy and Business Minors

Program Requirements for the Minor in Accountancy

The department offers a Minor in Accountancy. With the accountancy
minor, business majors will develop a deeper understanding of financial
reporting and the use of financial information.

A minor in Accountancy consists of the following 15 hours of
coursework:

ACCT 3301

ACCT 3302

ACCT 4410

ACCT 4440

FNCE 3353

119

To declare a minor in Accountancy the student must meet the
following criteria:

Have a GPA of 2.75/4.00 or better.

1 . Complete MGMT 2200, ACCT 221 1 and ECON 2200 with a grade
of 'B' or better.

2. The remaining courses in the minor must be completed with a grade
of 'C or better.

Students must take at least four of the minor courses at LaGrange
College.

Program Requirements for the Minor in
Business Management

A Minor in Business Management is available to any LaGrange
College student, regardless of major. Courses cover the basic functional
areas of business. The minor is designed to help students develop the
ability to recognize and solve business and organizational problems and
understand the role of business in the community, nation, and the world.
Such exposure should enhance the student's employment opportunities.

A Minor in Business Management consists of the following 15 hours of
coursework:

ACCT 22 11

ECON 2200

MRKT 3380

MGMT 2200

MGMT 3370

To declare a minor in business, the student must have a GPA of at least

2.75/4.0.

Courses in the minor must be completed with a grade of 'C or better.
Students must take at least four of the minor courses at LaGrange College.

120

Course Descriptions

Note that most courses have prerequisites and, generally, 2200-level
courses are introductory. Prerequisites are shown after the course
description.

All major and minor courses must be completed with a grade of f C
or better. (Note: All B.S. in Accountancy students and Accountancy
minors must complete MGMT 2200, ACCT 2211 and ECON 2200
with a grade of 'B' or better.)

To take any course other than MGMT 2200, ACCT 2211 or ECON
2200, students must have a GPA of at least 2.5/4.0.

Accountancy (ACCT)

ACCT 2211 Principles of Accounting. (3) Spring
This course focuses on the accounting cycle and preparation of financial
statements. Students will engage in professional research and work with
a variety of computer applications.
Prerequisite or Corequisite: MGMT 2200

ACCT 3301 Intermediate Financial Accounting I. (3) Fall
This course focuses on the decision-making implications of information
provided to external stakeholders including investors, creditors,
customers, and regulators, and regulation theory and practice as
applied to accountancy. Topics include regulation of accountancy
procedures for external reporting, current problems in reporting financial
position, income determination, and an integration of current
professional pronouncements.
Prerequisite: ACCT 2211

ACCT 3302 Intermediate Financial Accounting II. (3) Spring
Continuation of Intermediate Financial Accounting I.
Prerequisites: ACCT 3301

ACCT 3354 Financial Statement Analysis. (3) Fall

This course focuses on the structure and analysis of financial statements
prepared in accordance with US GAAP, providing students with a
framework for using financial statement data in a variety of valuation
and business analysis contexts.
Prerequisite: ACCT 3301

ACCT 4401 Auditing and Accounting Ethics and Liability.

(3) Spring
This course focuses on the legal and ethical environment in which the
accounting professional practices and in which financial statements are
prepared and presented. Students will consider the conflict between

121

profit motive and accurate and complete financial reporting, examining
the participation in the financial reporting process by internal
accountants, internal auditors, other business managers, and the
independent auditors engaged to attest to the accuracy and completeness
of management's financial statements. These conflicts will be discussed
in relation to the business's responsibility to employees, investors, and
other stakeholders. Traditional auditing practices will also be studied to
determine the efficiency and the effectiveness of such methods.
Prerequisite: ACCT 3301

ACCT 4410 Federal Income Tax Concepts and Practice. (3) Spring
This course introduces students to U.S. Federal income tax concepts and
principles and the application of such concepts to business operating,
investing, and financing activities. Ethical and legal issues confronting
tax practitioners are discussed throughout the course. Students engage
in tax research utilizing professional databases and gain expertise in
technical writing.
Prerequisites: ACCT 221 1

ACCT 4415 Accounting for Internal Decision Makers.

(3) On demand
This course focuses on the decision making implications of information
provided to organization managers. Concepts from economics, statistics,
and psychology emphasize the use of quantitative techniques to manage
uncertainty and risk. Topics include planning and control techniques,
construction of static and flexible budgeting, and product costing
mechanisms.
Prerequisite: ACCT 221 1

ACCT 4430 Advanced Accounting. (3) Spring
This is an intensive course that integrates the disciplines of accounting,
finance, and taxation with respect to selected complex business
transactions. Topics will include: business combinations, goodwill,
inventory costing, property exchanges and advanced stockholders'
equity transactions.
Prerequisites: ACCT 3302

ACCT 4440 Accounting Information Systems. (3) Fall
This course is an introduction to the systems, procedures, and processes
management employs to control operating activities and information
reporting systems.
Prerequisite: ACCT 221 1

122

ACCT 4460 Internship in Accounting. (1-3) On demand
This course represents a unique opportunity for a qualified student to
expand his/her understanding of the practical applications of accounting
concepts by entering into a specific "help rendered learning
accomplishment" contract with a cooperating area enterprise. The
contract will specifically identify the student's obligations and duties,
the nature and extent of the host enterprise's commitment to assist the
student in further extending his/her knowledge of enterprise operations,
and the basis on which the student's learning accomplishments will be
measured. No more than 6 credit hours may be applied toward the
student's graduation requirements.
Prerequisites: Accountancy major with demonstrated superior
capabilities and prior approval of the contract by the department
faculty

ACCT 4480 Special Topics in Accounting. (3) On demand
A series of special topic courses will provide students with exposure to
issues and concepts not covered in their regular course work. Most
topics will include work with "real-world" organizations.
Prerequisite: ACCT 221 1 and consent of instructor

ACCT 4488 Research and Current Topics in Accounting.

(3) Spring
This course provides a conceptual understanding of the accounting
process and the background skills to do research in the authoritative
accounting literature. Students will gain proficiency using FARS.
Current topics in accounting will be researched and discussed. Technical
writing abilities will be stressed.
Prerequisite: ACCT 3302

Economics (ECON)

ECON 2200 Principles of Economics. (3) Fall
An introduction to the science of economics and its analytical tools.
This course is devoted to providing the student with a thorough
understanding of the basic principles of a) microeconomics: the study of
the economic behavior of individual households and firms and the
determination of factor prices, and b) macroeconomics: the study of the
determination of the aggregate levels of income, output, employment
and prices and the examination of fiscal and monetary policy.
Prerequisites: ENGL 1 101, MATH 1 101

123

ECON 2201 Principles of Microeconomics. (3) On demand
An introduction to the science of economics and its analytical tools.
This course is devoted to providing the student with a thorough
understanding of the basic principles of microeconomics: the study of
the economic behavior of individual households and firms and the
determination of factor prices.
Prerequisites: ENGL 1 101, MATH 1101

ECON 2202 Principles of Macroeconomics. (3) On demand
A general introduction to determination of the aggregate levels of
income, output, employment and prices and the examination of fiscal
and monetary policy.
Prerequisites: ENGL 1 101, MATH 1 101

ECON 3310 Managerial Economics. (3) On demand
Focuses on the use of microeconomic principles using mathematical and
statistical tools to make/analyze business decisions.
Prerequisites: MGMT 2200, ECON 2200, ACCT 221 1 and MATH 1 1 14

Finance (FNCE)

FNCE 3353 Corporate Finance. (3) Spring
The first half of this course focuses on various methods used by
corporate managers to evaluate alternative investment opportunities,
including discounted payback, internal rate of return, discounted cash
flow and "economic value added" analyses. The second half of the
course focuses on the methods used to finance corporate investments in
assets, including capital structure, cost of capital, bankruptcy risk,
informal workout and Chapter 1 1 reorganization issues. Relevant legal,
accounting and tax issues are integrated throughout the course content.
Prerequisites: ACCT 221 1

FNCE 3354 Business Performance Analysis. (3) Spring
A comprehensive survey of the basic tools and models used in
contemporary financial statement analysis.
Prerequisite: ACCT 221 1

FNCE 3357 Investments. (3) On demand
This course provides students with an introduction to the tools for
analyzing the potential returns and risks of individual securities and how
to combine them efficiently into portfolios. The subject matter will be
presented primarily from the viewpoint of the individual investor. The
course will also examine the market equilibrium pricing of capital

124

assets, risk-adjusted evaluations of portfolio performance, the efficiency
of the capital allocation process in security markets, the formulation of
investment policies and strategies, and other investment-related topics.
Prerequisites: ECON 2200, FNCE 3353

Management (MGMT)

MGMT 2200 Foundations in Business (3) Fall and Spring
This course will serve as an integrative introduction to the functional
areas of business. Projects based on current business dilemmas will
emphasize the need for constant research and innovation required to
address problems students will encounter in the business world.
Potential decisions will be evaluated in the context of reducing risk and
maximizing returns to a variety of stakeholders. Creative and critical
thinking, problem solving, and ethical decision making will be stressed.

Prerequisites: Completion of MATH 1 101 or MATH 2105 and

ENGL 1 102 with a "B" or better

MGMT 3312 Business Communication. (3) Fall and Spring
This course provides an opportunity for students to practice all forms of
business communication including: written documents and reports, oral
presentations, phone, e-mail, meetings, etc. Particular consideration will
be given to audience analysis, appropriate medium, cultural and gender
issues, feedback, and biases affecting communication.
Prerequisites: MGMT 2200, ECON 2200, ACCT 221 1

MGMT 3322 Business Ethics. (3) On demand
A study of current social problems faced by business with particular
attention paid to the background factors giving rise to those problems,
various proposed solutions, and the approach that is currently being
followed.
Prerequisites: Senior standing, MGMT 2200, ECON 2200, ACCT
221 1 or consent of instructor

MGMT 3351 Legal and Ethical Environment of Business. (3) Fall
This course addresses the legal and ethical implications of business
decisions. Topics may include legal organization, employment,
discrimination, contracts, workplace, safety, product liability, and
antitrust issues. Cost-benefit analysis will be used as a tool to evaluate
business decisions in light of existing legal rules and social
responsibility.
Prerequisites: MGMT 2200, ECON 2200, ACCT 221 1

125

MGMT 3370 Management and Organizational Behavior. (3)

Fall and Spring
A study of the science and art of management with special emphasis on
motivating and leading individuals in an organization.
Prerequisites: MGMT 2200, ECON 2200, ACCT 221 1

MGMT 3372 Operations Management. (3) Fall
A study of the application of the science of management in the
operations management environment. Primary emphasis placed on the
theories, principles, and tools that improve the efficiency and
effectiveness of the operations manager.
Prerequisites: MGMT 2200, ECON 2200, and ACCT 221 1

MGMT 3374 Interpersonal Relations in Organizations. (3)

On demand
A study of human interaction in the organization context. Topics to be
covered include self-concept, frames of reference, values and attitudes,
barriers and breakdowns in communications.
Prerequisites: MGMT 3370 or consent of instructor

MGMT 3376 Managing Human Resources. (3) On demand
The study of the basic principles and functions of effective personnel
administration and human resource management. Extensive use is made
of the case method of study. Students gain experience looking at
personnel problems, individually and as members of groups.
Prerequisites: MGMT 3370 or consent of instructor

MGMT 3377 Career Management. (3) Fall and Spring
This course is designed to help guide students through the process of
preparing for a career. Topics to be covered include experiences and
activities that enhance employability, resume preparation, cover, and
thank you letter development, identifying skills needed for a job,
question and answer preparation, and effective interviewing techniques.
Prerequisites: declared business or accountancy major

MGMT 3385 Management Information Systems. (3) Spring
This course is designed for future managers who need to understand and
critically evaluate the role and potential contribution of information
technology for their organizations, and understand and effectively apply
various computerized support systems to make better decisions.
Prerequisites: MGMT 2200, ECON 2200, ACCT 221 1

126

MGMT 3388 Research Methods. (3) Spring

Focuses on the survey research process and the analysis of data. Covers
topics such as problem definition, research design, sampling techniques,
questionnaire development, data collection methods and data analysis.
Prerequisites: MGMT 2200, ECON 2200, ACCT 221 1, MATH 1114

MGMT 3392 International Business. (3) On demand
A study of the major opportunities, challenges, and approaches to
increased effectiveness in the international business area.
Prerequisites: MGMT 2200, ECON 2200, ACCT 221 1

MGMT 4401 Entrepreneurship. (3) On demand
A study of the application of the science of management to the
development and management of the small business enterprise.
Opportunities, characteristics, and problems with the small business will
be evaluated. Students will be required to develop a business plan for a
small business and when possible students will be given an opportunity
to work on special projects with small businesses in the community.
The class requires active participation by students in and out of
the classroom.
Prerequisites: ACCT or FNCE 3354, MGMT 3370, MRKT 3380

MGMT 4440 Management Simulation. (3) Spring
This is the capstone course for majors in business. It incorporates the
use of a computer-based simulation in an effort to integrate all of the
functional areas of business into one comprehensive course. Students
are required to work in groups as managers of a simulated company and
make the necessary marketing, finance, economic, accounting, and
management decisions to run their company effectively. The student's
grades are a function of individual and group performance.
Prerequisites: Senior standing, completion of all course requirements
in major, or consent of instructor

MGMT 4460 Internship in Business. (1-3) On demand
This course represents a unique opportunity for a qualified student to
expand his/her understanding of the practical applications of enterprise
operations by entering into a specific "help rendered learning
accomplishment" contract with a cooperating area enterprise. The
contract will specifically identify the student's obligations and duties,
the nature and extent of the host enterprise's commitment to assist the
student in further extending his/her knowledge of enterprise operations,

127

and the basis on which the student's learning accomplishments will be
measured. No more than 6 credit hours may be applied toward the
student's graduation requirements.
Prerequisites: Business major with demonstrated superior capabilities

and prior approval of the internship contract by

department faculty.

MGMT 4483 Special Topics in Management. (3) On demand
A series of special topic courses providing students with exposure to
issues and concepts not covered in their regular course work.
Prerequisites: Senior standing and consent of instructor

Marketing (MRKT)

MRKT 3380 Principles of Marketing. (3) Fall and Spring
An introduction to the important principles of marketing management
and the role of marketing in a contemporary society, in business
enterprises and in the nonprofit organization. Considers the planning,
operation and evaluation of marketing and promotional efforts necessary
to the effective marketing of consumer and industrial offerings.
Prerequisites: MGMT 2200, ECON 2200, ACCT 221 1

MRKT 3381 Advanced Marketing. (3) On demand
Provides training in marketing decision making. Uses case studies
simulating actual business settings to help students develop analytical
abilities and sharpen their communication skills. Covers topics that
range from techniques used to analyze a market to the development of a
total marketing strategy.
Prerequisite: MRKT 3380

MRKT 4484 Special Topics in Marketing. (3) On demand
A series of special topic courses providing students with exposure to
issues and concepts not covered in their regular course work.
Prerequisites: Senior standing, MRKT 3380, and consent of instructor

128

Chemistry
Introduction

Chemistry is often referred to as the central science, because chemical
concepts are used throughout the other sciences. Therefore, in addition
to being a major in its own right, the study of chemistry is a part of
many curricula. The Chemistry Department focuses its introductory
chemistry course as an element in a liberal education, a service to other
departments, and the beginning of a comprehensive study of chemistry.
The department offers B.A. and B.S. majors as well as a minor which
can lead to a variety of future occupations. Students with a major in
chemistry have gone on to traditional pursuits such as graduate school in
chemistry or biochemistry, pharmacy, medical school and law school
(patent law and corporate law), as well as becoming laboratory
technicians and salespersons for chemistry and related industries.

The B.A. degree offers a broad background in chemistry while allowing
ample time for extensive coursework in other fields. The B.A. is
appropriate for those interested in one of the medical or law-related
professions, teaching, or for students desiring the broadest possible
education with an emphasis in natural science. The B.S. program is
designed for those going on to graduate school in a chemically related
field (chemistry, biochemistry, molecular biology, chemical physics,
environmental science, or forensics) or those seeking employment as
chemists after graduation. The B.S. degree is generally more highly
valued at professional schools because entrance standards are high.
While the B.S. degree is more demanding of a student's time, there is
sufficient time for electives outside the sciences.

Objectives

The specific objectives for the respective degrees are as follows:

The Bachelor of Science Degree

Students who earn the B.S. degree with a major in chemistry will be
appropriately competent in the following areas:

Atomic and molecular structure and chemical bonding

The language of chemistry: verbal, written, numerical and graphical
presentation of chemical concepts

Equilibria and stoichiometry

Periodic Relationships

Thermochemistry

129

Chemistry laboratory skills, including data organization and analysis

Recognition, structure and reactivity of the major organic functional

groups

Experimental synthesis and characterization of organic compounds

by physical and instrumental methods

Volumetric and gravimetric analytical theory and practice

Analytical instrumentation theory and practice

Thermodynamics

Chemical dynamics

Quantum mechanics and spectroscopy

Either advanced inorganic chemistry, advanced organic chemistry,
or biochemistry

Knowledge of the research process in chemistry

Students earn these competencies by pursuing the following Bachelor of
Science curriculum in chemistry:

General Chemistry 1101,1 102 8 semester hours

Organic Chemistry 2201, 2202 8 semester hours

Analytical Chemistry 225 1 4 semester hours

Physical Chemistry 3301, 3302, 3303L 8 semester hours

Junior Seminar, Chemistry 3371 2 semester hours

Senior Seminar, Chemistry 4471 2 semester hours

Instrumental Analysis 445 1 4 semester hours

Chemistry Elective (3000 or 4000 level) 4 semester hours

Additionally, a research experience is required. This should be taken
between the junior and senior years or during the first semester of the
senior year. This may be done on campus, in industry, or in a research
university summer program. Students may elect to earn 4900 credit for
this required activity. Supporting required courses include the following:

Mathematics 222 1 , 2222 8 semester hours

Physics 1121,1122 8 semester hours

A Computer Science programming course 3 semester hours

130

The scheduling of the B.S. curriculum is important. To be prepared to
take the physical chemistry sequence, students should take calculus during
the freshman year and physics during the sophomore year. It is highly
recommended that students take general chemistry during their freshman
year. The following would be a typical sequence of courses for the B.S.
chemistry degree:

Fall

First Year CHEM 1101

MATH 2221

Spring

CHEM 1102
MATH 2222

Second Year CHEM 2201
PHYS 1121

CHEM 2202
PHYS 1122

Third Year

CHEM 3301

CHEM 3302
CHEM 3371

Fourth Year

Computer Programming
Chemistry Elective or

CHEM 4451
Chemistry Elective
CHEM 4471

Students who earn the B.S. degree will have demonstrated their
attainment of the specific objectives by appropriate scores on the current
American Chemical Society (ACS) Examinations on the following three
topics: General, Organic, and Physical. The students will additionally
attain an appropriate score from one of the following examinations:
Analytical, Instrumental, Inorganic, or Biochemistry. The passing score
will be at or above the 40 th percentile of the national norms for these
exams or at an appropriate level, as determined by the Chemistry
Department, based on the accumulated data of the performance of
LaGrange College students on these exams. The results which are in the
best interest of the students will be used. These exams will be given at
the end of the appropriate courses and will be offered to students up to
three additional times prior to the time of the student's scheduled
graduation. The student must attempt a retest at least once a semester
until successful completion of the exam. In the event that a student
needs to repeat an exam for the second, third, or final time, evidence of
preparation must be presented. Reexamination cannot be scheduled
earlier than two weeks following a previous examination.

131

The Bachelor of Arts-Chemistry

Students who earn the B.A. degree with a major in chemistry will be
appropriately competent in the following areas:

Atomic and molecular structure and chemical bonding

The language of chemistry: verbal, written, numerical, and
graphical presentation of chemical concepts

Equilibria and stoichiometry

Periodic relationships

Thermochemistry

Chemistry laboratory skills, including data organization and analysis

Recognition, structure and reactivity of the major organic functional
groups

Experimental synthesis and characterization of organic compounds
by physical and instrumental methods

Either advanced inorganic chemistry, advanced organic chemistry,
or biochemistry

Students earn these competencies by pursuing the following courses
required for the Bachelor of Arts curriculum in chemistry:

General Chemistry 1 101, 1 102 8 semester hours

Organic Chemistry 2201, 2202 8 semester hours

Analytical Chemistry 225 1 4 semester hours

Physical Chemistry 3301 4 semester hours

Junior Seminar, Chemistry 337 1 2 semester hours

Senior Seminar, Chemistry 4471 2 semester hours

Chemistry Elective 4 semester hours

Required supporting courses include the following:

Physics 1101, 1102 or 1121, 1122 8 semester hours

Math 1121 or 2221 3 or 4 semester hours

132

The scheduling of the courses for the B.A. in chemistry can be flexible.
The following is a proposed sequence to fulfill the requirements for
the major.

Fall

Spring

First Year

MATH 2105

MATH 1121

Second Year

CHEM 1101

CHEM 1102

Third Year

CHEM 2201

CHEM 2202

PHYS 1101

PHYS 1102
CHEM 3371

Fourth Year

CHEM 3301

CHEM 4471

Chemistry Elective or

Chemistry Elective
CHEM 2251

Students who earn the B.A. degree will have demonstrated their
attainment of the specific objectives by appropriate scores on the current
American Chemical Society (ACS) Exams for (1) General Chemistry
and (2) Organic Chemistry. The passing score will be at or above the
40 th percentile of the national norms for these exams or at an appropriate
level, as determined by the Chemistry Department, based on the
accumulated data of the performance of LaGrange College students on
these exams. The results which are in the best interest of the students
will be used. These exams will be given at the end of the appropriate
courses and will be offered to students up to three additional times prior
to the time of the student's scheduled graduation.

The student must attempt a retest at least once a semester until
successful completion of the exam. In the event that a student needs to
repeat an exam for the second, third, or final time, evidence of
preparation must be presented. Reexamination cannot be scheduled
earlier than two weeks following a previous examination.

133

The Bachelor of Arts-Biochemistry

Students who earn the B.A. with a major in biochemistry will be
appropriately competent in the following areas:

Atomic and molecular structure and chemical bonding

The language of chemistry: verbal, written, numerical, and
graphical presentation of chemical concepts

Equilibria and stoichiometry

Periodic relationships

Thermochemistry

Physical measurements of chemical systems

Chemistry laboratory skills, including data organization and analysis

Recognition, structure and reactivity of the major organic functional
groups

Experimental synthesis and characterization of organic compounds
by physical and instrumental methods

In-depth study of biological molecules and metabolism

Techniques of biotechnology

Students earn these competencies by pursuing the following courses
required for the Bachelor of Arts-Biochemistry:

General Chemistry 1101,1102 8 semester hours

Organic Chemistry 2201, 2202 8 semester hours

Physical Chemistry 3301 4 semester hours

Junior Seminar, Chemistry 3371 2 semester hours

Biochemistry, Chemistry 4421, 4422 8 semester hours

Senior Seminar, Chemistry 4471 2 semester hours

Math 1 1 14 or 1 121 3 semester hours

Physics 1 1 1 , 1 1 02 8 semester hours

Suggested but not required Biology 8 semester hours

Students who earn the B A. with a major in biochemistry will have
demonstrated the attainment of the specific objectives by appropriate
scores on the current American Chemical Society (ACS) Exams for (1)
General Chemistry, (2) Organic Chemistry and/or (3) Biochemistry. The

134

passing score will be at or above the 40 percentile of the national
norms for these exams or at an appropriate level, as determined by the
Chemistry Department, based on the accumulated data of the
performance of LaGrange College students on these exams. The
results which are in the best interest of the students will be used.
These exams will be given at the end of the appropriate courses and
will be offered to students up to three additional times prior to the
time of the student's scheduled graduation. The student must attempt
a retest at least once a semester until successful completion of the
exam. In the event that a student needs to repeat an exam for the
second, third, or final time, evidence of preparation must be
presented. Reexamination cannot be scheduled earlier than two
weeks following a previous examination.

The scheduling for the B.A. degree in biochemistry is also flexible.
The following is a proposed schedule to meet the requirements for the
degree. This degree provides a flexible yet strong program for the
pre-health professional requirements.

Fall

First Year

Spring

MATH 1121 or
MATH 1114

Second Year

CHEM 1101

CHEM 1102

Third Year

CHEM 2201
PHYS 1101

CHEM 2202
PHYS 1102
CHEM 3371

Fourth Year

CHEM 3301
CHEM 4421

CHEM 4422
CHEM 4471

135

A suggested schedule to meet the Pre Health Professional Requirements
and earn a B.A. degree in biochemistry is the following:

Fall Spring

First Year CHEM1101 CHEM1102

BIOL 1101 BIOL 1102

Second Year

CHEM2201
PHYS 1101
MATH

CHEM 2202
PHYS 1102
MATH

Third Year

BIOL 4321
CHEM 3301

BIOL 4322
CHEM 3371
MCAT, PCAT,
VCAT, DAT, etc.

Fourth Year

CHEM 4421

CHEM 4471
CHEM 4422

The 4000 series Biology and Chemistry could be switched during the
third and fourth year depending on the interest of the student.

Declaration of Major

Before declaring a major in chemistry, a student must successfully (C or
better) complete the introductory sequence (CHEM 1 101, 1102). A
student may declare a major after one term of chemistry with permission
of the chair of the department.

Minor

A minor in chemistry shall consist of CHEM 1 1 1 , 1 1 02, 220 1 , 2202 and
two additional chemistry courses from the following: CHEM 2251, 3301,
3302, 442 1 , 4422, 443 1 , 445 1 . Students must demonstrate proficiency in
general chemistry by passing the ACS General Chemistry Examination as
stated above.

136

Chemistry Awards

The CRC Freshman Chemistry Award is awarded annually on Honors
Day to the student with the most outstanding achievement in the CHEM
1 101, 1 102 General Chemistry sequence A.M. Hicks Award for
outstanding achievement in organic chemistry, is awarded annually on
Honors Day to the student taking organic chemistry who has attained the
most outstanding record. The award is made in honor of Dr. A. M.
Hicks who was a long time faculty member and chair of the department.

Course Descriptions (CHEM)

Chemistry is a laboratory science and the department views the
laboratory experience as an essential component of those courses with
an associated laboratory. Consequently, students must achieve a passing
grade in both the lecture and laboratory portions of the course to obtain a
passing grade in the course.

CHEM 1101 General Chemistry I. (3 hrs. lee., 3 hrs. lab per

week) (4) Fall
A study of the foundations of chemistry including stoichiometry, atomic
structure and periodicity, molecular structure and bonding models, and
thermochemistry.
Prerequisite: MATH 1101 or placement in 2105 or higher.

CHEM 1102 General Chemistry II. (3 hrs. lee, 3 hrs. lab per

week) (4) Spring
A continuation of CHEM 1 101; a study of the gas, liquid, and solid
phases, chemical thermodynamics, kinetics, equilibria, acid/base
equilibria, oxidation-reduction reactions and electrochemistry.
Prerequisites: CHEM 1 101 , MATH 1 101 or placement in 2105 or higher.

CHEM 2201 Organic Chemistry I. (3 hrs. lee, 3 hrs. lab per
week) (4) Fall
! A study of the fundamentals of organic chemistry with respect to the
bonding, structure, nomenclature and reactivity of various classes of
organic compounds including aromatic compounds.
Prerequisite: CHEM 1102

CHEM 2202 Organic Chemistry II. (3 hrs. lee, 3 hrs. lab per

week) (4) Spring
A continuation of CHEM 2201 including spectroscopy, synthesis,
carbonyls, and biomolecules.
Prerequisite: CHEM 2201

137

CHEM 2251 Analytical Chemistry (3 hrs. lee, 3 hrs. lab per week)

(4) Fall
A study of the theory and practice of volumetric and gravimetric
quantitative analysis, chemical equilibrium, and acid/base chemistry.
Prerequisite: CHEM 1102

CHEM 3301 Physical Chemistry I. (3 hrs. lee, 3 hrs. lab per

week) (4) Fall
An overview of thermodynamics, dynamics and quantum chemistry.

Prerequisites: CHEM 2202 or permission of instructor, MATH 1114

or MATH 2105 or placement in MATH 2221

CHEM 3302 Physical Chemistry II. (3 hrs. lee, 3 hrs. lab per

week) (4) Spring
Selected topics in thermodynamics, dynamics and quantum mechanics
will be studied in additional depth. Statistical mechanics will be
introduced. Application of mathematics at the calculus level will be
applied to these topics.
Prerequisites: CHEM 3301 and MATH 2222 or MATH 1 121

CHEM 3371 Junior Seminar (2 hrs. class per week) (2) Spring
A course that acquaints the student with the chemical literature as well
as presentation and discussion of scientific data and information. In
addition, students will explore career opportunities, prepare a portfolio,
and develop career plans.

Note: Course is graded on a pass/no credit basis.
Prerequisite: Junior standing

CHEM 4421 Biochemistry I (3 hrs. lee, 3 hrs. lab per week)

(4) Fall
An introductory course in the principles of biochemistry, with emphasis
on the structure and function of biomolecules, membrane structure and
function and an introduction to metabolism and bioenergetics.
Prerequisite: CHEM 2202 or permission of instructor.

CHEM 4422 Biochemistry II (3 hrs. lee, 3 hrs. lab per week)

(4) Spring
A continuation of CHEM 4421 with emphasis on cellular metabolism,
fundamentals of molecular genetics, and current topics in biochemistry.
Prerequisite: CHEM 4421

CHEM 4431 Inorganic (3 hrs. lee per week) (3) On demand
An in-depth examination of atomic and molecular structure. Symmetry
concepts are introduced and used.
Prerequisite: CHEM 3301 or consent of the instructor.

138

CHEM 4451 Instrumental Analysis (3 hrs. lee, 3 hrs. lab per

week) (4) Spring
A study of instrumentation and advanced analytical techniques.
Prerequisite: CHEM 3301 or permission of instructor

CHEM 4471 Senior Seminar. (2 hrs. class per week) (2) Spring
A capstone course which is thematic. Emphasis is on integration of the
student's experience in chemistry and the presentation of chemical
literature in seminar and written form.
Prerequisite: Senior standing

CHEM 4800 Special Topics. (1-4 hours) On demand

A special topics course that may be designed to provide the student with

exposure to topics and concepts not covered in the regular course offerings.

CHEM 4900 Independent Study.

This course can vary and may be used to satisfy the research requirement
for the B.S. major and provide research experience for B.A. majors.

139

Computer science
Introduction

The Computer Science Department at LaGrange College has several
goals. With the goal of computer literacy for our general student
population, courses are offered to acquaint students with microcomputer
applications and networks. For students who want further study in
computer science, the following options are available:

A minor in computer science

B. A. degree in computer science

B. A. degree in computer science with a concentration in business

B. S. degree in computer science

Objectives

Graduates from the B.A. and B.S. degree programs at LaGrange College
should be able to do each of the following:

Write programs in a reasonable amount of time that work
correctly, are well documented, and are readable.

Determine whether or not they have written a reasonably
efficient and well-organized program.

Know which general types of problems are amenable to
computer solution and the various tools necessary for solving
such problems.

Assess the implications of work performed either as an
individual or as a member of a team.

Understand basic computer architectures.

Pursue in-depth training in one or more application areas or
further education in computer science.

In addition, students in the B. S. degree program should be able to do
research, be able to convey technical ideas in a clear writing style, and
have the mathematical background necessary for scientific problem-
solving. Students in the B.A. degree program with a concentration in
business should have the knowledge of the functional areas of business
necessary for working in that environment.

In order to be a major in computer science, a student must maintain a
GPA of 2.25 or better. Students pursuing a B.S. degree must have a 3.0
average in those courses required for the major. All of the 1000-level or

140

above courses in computer science, mathematics, and business that are
required for the B.A. or B.S. degree or the minor must be completed
with a grade of C or better.

The computer science curriculum at LaGrange College is based of the
recommendations of the A.C.M. (Association for Computing
Machinery). In addition, our students have the opportunity to take
courses that will make them more attractive in the job market. These
courses include programming languages (such as C++, COBOL, Visual
Basic, and Java), PC support and troubleshooting (including an A+
course), database administration (Oracle), network administration
(Windows NT), and web programming (including JavaScript, Perl, CGI,
HTML, DHTML, XML, CSS, and Macromedia applications).

The accomplishment of these objectives will be demonstrated by the
following:

1. Satisfactory performance on a programming test. This test will be
based on the concepts learned in CSCI 1990 and 2990 and must
be taken at the end of the semester in which the student completes
CSCI 2990. The test will be offered once at the end of every
semester in which CSCI 2990 is offered. The test must be
satisfactorily completed by the end of the semester in which the
student reaches senior status, but under no circumstances will a
student be allowed to take the test more than four times prior to
and including that semester. If the test has not been completed
satisfactorily by that time, the student will not be allowed to
continue in either the B.A. or the B. S. degree programs in
computer science.

2. Satisfactory performance by the student in delivering a
presentation at a regularly scheduled Computer Science
Department seminar. This presentation will be developed with the
approval of and possible input from the computer science faculty.
If the student does not arrive at the scheduled time for the seminar
or does not perform satisfactorily in the seminar, the department
reserves the right to impose additional requirements to substitute
for the seminar. A student who fails to fulfill these requirements
will not be allowed to graduate.

3. Satisfactory completion of an assessment portfolio to be kept on
each computer science major. The purpose of this portfolio will
be to aid in assessing the professional development of each
student and the growth of the student's programming skills as the
student progresses through the computer science curriculum. Each
portfolio will include the programming test described in item ( 1 )

I . 141

above, a program selected by the instructor from CSCI 3250,
three additional examples of the student's work, a copy of the
student's resume, material from the departmental seminar
presentation made by the student and described in item (2), a copy
of the student's web page, and a personal information sheet
(including forwarding address and phone number, e-mail address,
and plans after graduation). The three examples of the student's
work mentioned above must be approved for inclusion by faculty
consensus. Maintaining the portfolio is the responsibility of the
student. Additional information about the portfolio is available
from the department.

4. Attendance at Computer Science Department seminars. Each
student will be required to attend at least 50% of these seminars
each semester. A student who fails to attend 50% of the seminars
will be required to submit a short written report for each seminar
under the 50% missed. Details concerning such written reports are
available from the department. Failure to attend 50% of the
seminars and submit such reports will result in the student not
being certified as a computer science graduate.

Career Opportunities

Students who complete the computer science major have a wide range of
employment opportunities. These include positions in programming, PC
support and troubleshooting, database administration, network
administration, and web programming. Graduates of the computer
science degree program at LaGrange College have secured positions as
I.T. department managers, I.T. security specialists, systems analysts,
database administrators, webmasters, web designers, PC support
specialists, as well as other positions. Companies employing these
graduates include Milliken and Co., Interface, Duracell, Hitachi, Walt
Disney World (I.T. security), Chick-Fil-A (I.T. department), WestPoint
Stevens, Total Systems Services, BellSouth, Texas Instruments, General
Motors, and others.

In addition, a number of graduates have gone on to graduate school in
areas such as computer science, computer engineering, electrical
engineering, and management information systems.

142

Course Requirements

Core requirements for all students pursuing a minor, B.A., or B.S.
in Computer Science

(12 semester hours)

CSCI 1990

CSCI 2990

One of the following: CSCI 2500, 2850, or 2900

CSCI 3000
Requirements for the minor in Computer Science

(6 additional hours):

Two additional CSCI courses at the 3000-level or above

(excluding internship credit)
Requirements for the B.A. Degree

(30 additional hours)

CSCI 3050

CSCI 3700

Four additional CSCI courses at the 3000-level or above

(excluding internship credit)

MATH 1114

MATH 1121
Requirements for the B.A. with a concentration in Business

(39 additional Hours)

CSCI 3990

Five additional CSCI courses at the 3000-level or above

(excluding internship credit)

MATH 1114

MATH 1121
The five courses required for a minor in business: MGMT 2200, ACCT
221 1, ECON 2200, MGMT 3370, and MRKT 3380.

Requirements for the B.S. Degree
(41 additional hours)

CSCI 3050

CSCI 3250

CSCI 3990

CSCI 4100

CSCI 4250

CSCI 4900

Four additional CSCI courses at the 3000-level or above

MATH 1114

MATH 2221

MATH 2222

PHYS 1 101/1 102 or 1121/1 122 required as the laboratory

science courses in the Core Program

143

Course Descriptions (CSCI)

CSCI 1610 Introduction to Editing and System Languages. (2)

On demand
This course is designed to assist and familiarize the student with the
UNIX operating system. The course is designed for computer science
students and for those who need to learn a UNIX-like operating system.

CSCI 1630 Introduction to Microcomputers. (2) On demand
This course is designed to assist and familiarize the student with the
operation of a personal computer. The course covers personal
computer applications such as word processors and spreadsheets. It
also briefly covers how to use the Internet.

CSCI 1700 Microsoft Office and Information Systems. (3)

On demand
An introduction to information systems software. Microsoft Office
Professional will be the primary software utilized.

CSCI 1990 Introduction to Algorithmic Design. (3) Fall, Spring
Problem solving and algorithmic design using the language Java.
Structured programming concepts, debugging and testing
documentation.

CSCI 2050 PC Maintenance and Troubleshooting. (3)

On demand
A study of basic computer hardware, how to install hardware
components, and how to diagnose hardware problems. In addition, the
course will include a study of the basics of Windows and DOS
necessary for maintaining computer hardware. The course is designed
to begin to prepare students for A+ certification, as well as for the
benefit of those who just wish to upgrade and diagnose hardware and
operating system problems on their own computers.
Prerequisite: CSCI 1630 or consent of instructor.

CSCI 2500 Visual Basic. (3)

Fall Semester in odd-numbered years

The study of Visual Basic, an event-driven (as opposed to

procedural) language.

Prerequisite: CSCI 1990 or consent of instructor.

144

CSCI 2850 COBOL Programming I. (3) Fall Semester in

even-numbered years
The study of COBOL, a language used primarily in business data
processing applications. Emphasis on information retrieval problems.
Team project required.
Prerequisite: CSCI 1990 or consent of instructor.

CSCI 2860 COBOL Programming II. (3) On demand
Advanced programming concepts with a strong emphasis on ISAM files
and interactive programming.
Prerequisite: CSCI 285

CSCI 2900 Advanced Java Programming. (3) On demand
Advanced programming in Java, including the Java utilities package, bit
manipulation, collections, database connectivity, servlets, and JSP.
Prerequisite: CSCI 3990 or consent of instructor.

CSCI 2990 Algorithmic Design. (3) Spring
A continuation of CSCI 1990. Further development of techniques in
Java for program design, program style, debugging and testing,
especially for larger programs. Introduction to algorithmic analysis.
Introduction to the basic aspects of string processing, recursion, internal
search/sort methods, and simple data structures. Programming using
graphical user interfaces.
Prerequisite: CSCI 1990

CSCI 3000 Introduction to Computer Systems. (3) Fall

semester in odd-numbered years
Computer structure and machine language, assembly language
programming. Addressing techniques, macros, file I/O, program
segmentation and linkage, assembler construction, and interpretive
routines.

CSCI 3050 Introduction to Computer Organization. (3) Spring

semester in even-numbered years
Basic logic design, coding, number representation and arithmetic,
computer architecture, and computer software.
Prerequisite: CSCI 1990

CSCI 3150 Introduction to File Processing. (3) On demand
Concept of I/O management (fields, keys, records, and buffering). File
organization, file operations, and data structures. Time and storage
space requirements. Data security and integrity.
Prerequisite: CSCI 3000 or 3250 or consent of instructor.

145

CSCI 3250 Data Structures. (3) Fall semester in even-

numbered years
Review of basic data structures such as stacks, queues, lists, and trees.
Graphs and their applications. Internal and external searching and
sorting. Memory management.

Prerequisite: CSCI 2990 or consent of instructor.

CSCI 3310 Organization of Programming Languages. (3)

On demand
An introduction to the structure of programming languages. Language
definition structure, data types and structures, control structures and data
flow. Run-time consideration, interpreative languages, lexical analysis
and parsing.

Prerequisite: CSCI 3000 or consent of instructor.

CSCI 3350 Digital Computer Architecture. (3) On demand
Structures for the central computer are studied; arithmetic logic units,
machine language features, information transfer, memory hierarchy,
channels, etc.

Prerequisite: CSCI 3050

CSCI 3400 Computer Networks I. (3) Fall Semester in odd-

numbered years
An introduction to the Computer NetWare Administration (CNA) using
NetWare 4.x. It includes an in-depth study of the NetWare Directory
Services (NDS). Also covered will be NetWare installation and
management, the NetWare 4 file system and printing. The material
covered represents essentially that suggested by Novell for its CNA
certification.

Prerequisite: CSCI 1990 or consent of instructor.

CSCI 3450 Computer Networks II. (3) Spring Semester in

even-numbered years.
A continuation of CSCI 3400 including Windows NT.
Prerequisite: CSCI 3400

CSCI 3500 Web Programming. (3) Fall Semester in

odd-numbered years
The study and practice of the planning, construction, and programming
of web pages using HTML, CSS, SSI, and CGI. Graphics, sound,
video, and animation will also be discussed.
Prerequisite: CSCI 1990 or consent of instructor.

146

CSCI3700 Discrete Mathematical Structures in Computer
Science (3) Spring Semester in even-numbered years
An introduction to the mathematical tools for use in computer science.
These include sets, relations, and elementary counting techniques.
Algebra and algorithms, graphs, monoids and machines, lattices and
Boolean algebras, groups and combinatorics, logic and languages will
also be involved.
Prerequisites: MATH 1121, 2221, or consent of instructor.

CSCI3990 Object-Oriented Programming. (3) On demand

Object-oriented programming and design in the language Java.
Prerequisites: CSCI 1990 and 2990.

CSCI 4050 Database Management Systems Design. (3) Fall

Semester in even-numbered years
Introduction to database concepts using SQL and Oracle. Data
models, normalization, data description languages, query facilities.
File organization, index organization, file security, and data integrity
and reliability.
Prerequisite: CSCI 1990

CSCI 4100 Numerical Methods. (3) Spring Semester in

odd-numbered years
Introduction to numerical analysis with computer solution. Taylor
series, finite difference calculus, interpolation, roots of equations,
solutions of linear systems of equations, matrix inversion, least-squares,
numerical integration.
Prerequisites: MATH 1121, 2221, or consent of instructor

CSCI 4150 Advanced Program Design. (3) On demand

A formal approach to techniques in software design and development.
Includes structured programming concepts, organization and
management of software development. A large-scale software project
will be developed by students working in teams.
Prerequisite: CSCI 3250

CSCI 4200 Theory of Programming Languages. (3)

On demand
Review of grammars, languages, and their syntax and semantics.
Scanners, parsers, and translation.
Prerequisite: CSCI 3310

147

CSCI4250 Algorithms. (3) On demand

A study of problems and their algorithmic solution. Algorithms will be
chosen from areas such as combinatorics, numerical analysis, systems
programming, and artificial intelligence. Domain independent techniques
will also be included.
Prerequisite: CSCI 3250

CSCI 4300 Computer Graphics. (3) Fall Semester in

even-numbered years
An overview of graphical concepts and applications on the computer.
These include programming graphics, graphical manipulation software,
animation, web graphics, and graphics in multimedia presentations.
Prerequisite: CSCI 3000 or consent of instructor

CSCI 4500 Operating Systems. (3) Spring Semester in

odd-numbered years
A course in systems software that is largely concerned with operating
systems. Such topics as process management, device management,
and memory management are discussed, as are relevant issues
associated with security and protection, networking, and distributed
operating systems.
Prerequisite: CSCI 3000 or consent of instructor.

CSCI 4510 - 4520 - 4530 Special Topics. (3) On demand
This series of courses will provide the student with material not covered
in the courses above. Topics such as telecommunications,
microcomputer interfacing, artificial intelligence, automata theory,
survey of modern languages, fourth-generation languages, operating
systems, and object-oriented design will be covered.
Prerequisite: Determined by topic.

CSCI 4700 Research in Computer Science. (1-3)

On demand
Research project or paper in computer science. Designed for those
students who need it to fulfill a research component of the B. S. degree
in computer science. Student must present a course description in
writing to the department chairman to be approved by the end of pre-
registration during the semester prior to enrolling for the course.

CSCI 4900 Formal Languages. (3) Spring Semester in

even-numbered years
An introduction to the basic theoretical models of computability. Finite
automata, Turing machines, computability, decidability, and Godel's
incompleteness theorem.
Prerequisite: CSCI 3250, 3310, or 3700 or consent of instructor

CSCI 4950 Independent Study. (3) On demand

148

Core Program Curriculum

The principal outcomes of the LaGrange College Core Curriculum are to
assist students:

1. gather, interpret, and evaluate information to make decisions and
solve problems appropriately;

2. communicate clearly, both orally and in writing;

3. interpret and evaluate the influence of historical, cultural, and
religious developments upon human experience; and

4. establish personal values and apply them in service to the
community.

Course Descriptions (CORE)

CORE 1101 Freshman Cornerstone I. (3)

A course designed to enhance the valuing and decision-making
processes emphasizing Christian influences on ethical behavior.
Students use skills of comparison, contrast, analysis, and synthesis of
multiple perspectives as they examine an issue of common concern.
The course emphasizes active learning, small group problem solving,
and service learning, including reflection on these experiences.

CORE 1102 Freshman Cornerstone Laboratory II. (1)

A laboratory experience designed to identify and enhance students'
abilities. Assessment of abilities as well as sessions on study skills,
career counseling, computer skill, library skills, etc. are offered to
maximize students' success.
NOTE: Course is graded on a PASS/NO CREDIT basis.

CORE 1110 Quantitative Reasoning. (3)

Mathematical techniques and computer methods will be used in the
development of quantitative reasoning skills. This course focuses on
answering questions and solving problems that require quantitative
reasoning. These techniques and methods will be examined in
thecontext of examples taken from the social sciences, business,
economics and other disciplines. The applications of spreadsheets,
graphing and statistical methods will be used.

Prerequisite: MATH 1101 or higher; declaration of major.

CORE 2000 Dimensions of Well Being. (3)

A course designed to increase students' understanding of the

interrelationships among the physical, intellectual, emotional, and

spiritual dimensions of well being. Individual assessments and

evaluation of these abilities in addition to reading, analysis, and

discussion of research findings from various sources are central to

this course.

149

CORE 2001 Humanities I. (3)

This course is the first of a two-course sequence focusing on our cultural
heritage with an emphasis on the impact of the Judeo-Christian tradition
as it relates to all knowledge. The period from the emergence of human
history to 1660 is covered in this course. Students confront primary and
secondary source materials to gain an historical consciousness.
Prerequisites: ENGL 1101, 1102.

CORE 2002 Humanities II. (3)

This course is the second of a two-course sequence focusing on our cul-
tural heritage with an emphasis on the impact of the Judeo-Christian
tradition as it relates to all knowledge. The period from 1660 to the pre-
sent is covered in this course. Students confront primary and secondary
source materials to gain an historical consciousness.
Prerequisite: CORE 2001.

CORE 3001 The American Experience. (3)

This course provides an understanding of the unique American identity,
particularly from the social and behavioral science perspectives. The
American Experience enables students to understand the forces that
have given rise to the American Republic, articulate the basic concepts
of American civil discourse, understand the benefits and limitations of a
market-based economic system, and confront the perspectives conveyed
through selected works of American culture.
Prerequisites: CORE 2001 and CORE 2002.

150

Education

Introduction

The Department of Education offers several teacher preparation
programs: Bachelor of Arts programs at the Early Childhood
(PK - 5th) and Middle Grades (4 th - 8 th ) levels; a Master of Arts in
Teaching program for both the High School and Middle Grades level;
a post-baccalaureate certification program for Early Childhood and
Middles grades. The Master of Education in Curriculum and
Instruction program is designed for those who already have a
teaching certificate.

The education curriculum at LaGrange College serves four basic
purposes:

1 . to provide for the development of those professional
understandings and abilities which are essential for the
teaching profession.

2. to provide planned and carefully guided sequences of field
experiences (this requires that all students meet with their advisors
before making any work plans).

3. to provide initial preparation programs in Early Childhood and
Middle Grades education at the undergraduate level, and a Master
of Arts in Teaching initial preparation program for middle and high
school grades, all of which are fully accredited by the Southern
Association of Colleges and Schools and the Georgia Professional
Standards Commission.

4. to provide a program for certified teachers that leads to the Master
of Education degree in Curriculum and Instruction.

Teacher Certification

The education department offers a variety of programs that are approved
by the Georgia Professional Standards Commission and lead to
certification in Georgia. Students desiring to be certified upon
completion of their programs should plan to work closely with their
advisors since certification requirements are subject to change.

Upon successful completion of approved initial preparation programs in
Early Childhood, Middle Grades, and Secondary programs and
qualifying scores on the Praxis exam requirements, students are eligible
to receive Initial Clear Renewable Certificates.

151

Admission to Undergraduate Teacher
Education

The following are required for entrance into an undergraduate program:

Praxis I requirement or exemption

EDUC 1 199 - Foundations of Education (grade of "C" or better)

Completion of core curriculum

GPA of 2. 5 or better

Submission of application to program with recommendation from
EDUC 1 199 professor and current advisor

Background check to ensure that no criminal record or discharge
from the armed services would prevent teacher certification

Successful interview with Education faculty

After interviewing with education faculty, students may be admitted
conditionally if the results of the Praxis examination are pending, or if
one of the other criteria falls marginally short of the minimum
requirements. The student has one semester in which to remove the
conditional status. Failure to do so will result in being dropped from the
teacher education program. Admissions requirements are listed in the
Education Department Student Handbook.

All Education pre-service teachers have extensive field experiences each
semester. They are in schools for a minimum of 7 hours each week
prior to student teaching. Student teaching takes place in Troup County.

Core Program Requirements

All students planning to complete approved programs of Teacher
Education must complete the Core program requirements with a
minimum of 12 semester hours in the humanities, 6 semester hours in
natural sciences, and 6 semester hours in mathematics.

Objectives

Approved Program in Early Childhood Education

Students completing the Early Childhood Education Major will:

develop a thorough understanding of the social, intellectual,
physical, and emotional development of the child from birth to
approximately eight years

152

identify the nature of learning and behaviors involving the
young child

construct a curriculum appropriate to the needs of the young child

utilize existing knowledge about parents and cultures in dealing
effectively with children

gain a thorough knowledge of the fundamental concepts of
appropriate disciplines and how to relate them to the young child

identify and implement differentiated teaching strategies in lessons
designed for elementary students

understand diagnostic tools and approaches for assessing
students at all levels and how to remediate learning problems
in the various disciplines

develop their maximum potential through the provision of a
succession of planned and guided experiences

In order to achieve these objectives, students will take 51 semester hours
of Education courses to include: EDUC 1 199, 3317, 3319, 3342, 3354,
3355, 4356, 4360, 4449, 4456, 4457, 4459, 4460, 4480, 4490E and two
additional math courses (MATH 3001, 3002, 3003, 3004) and at least
one General Science course.

Approved Program in Middle Grades Education

Students completing the Middle Grades Education Major will:

demonstrate knowledge of middle grade learning in actual
learning situations

identify appropriate instructional strategies and created
environments to meet the social, emotional, physical and academic
needs of individual children and small groups of children with
diverse cultural backgrounds

understand research, professional practices, issues, trends and
literature essential for effective teaching throughout the teaching
field, with special emphasis on the middle grades (4-8)

understand diagnostic tools and approaches necessary for assessing
needs of individual students, planning to meet those needs, and
evaluating individual growth

be able to modify instruction and change strategies based on
the learning outcomes of previous activities and students'
individual needs

153

demonstrate appropriate professional traits in terms of
classroom management, discipline, preparedness, and
interaction with co-workers

In order to achieve these objectives, students will take 39 semester hours
of Education courses from the following: EDUC 1199, 3317, 3319,
3442, 3456, 4363, 4449, 4456, 4457, 4459, 4480, 4490M.
Students will also take a minimum of 30 semester hours in concentration
areas. Two concentrations will be selected from mathematics, language
arts, science or social studies. A minimum of 5 courses will be taken in
each area of concentration. Concentration courses must be approved by
the middle grades advisor.

BA and M.A.T Program of Study

Undergraduate students, who meet the admission requirements for the
MAT (passing Praxis I or a combined SAT score of more than 1000),
and those who have a G.P.A. of 3.0 or higher in their undergraduate
studies, have the opportunity to participate in BA and M.A.T program of
study after the completion of 80 semester hours. Once accepted,
candidates may take one graduate course in each Summer Semester.
Candidates may take one three credit graduate course during the Fall,
Interim and Spring Semesters only if enrolled with twelve undergraduate
credits.

Program of Study:

Semester

First Summer Semester I

(after 80 credit hours)

Course

EDUC 6040 Foundations of

Education

First Summer Session II

EDUC 6020 Educational Technology

First Fall Semester

EDUC 5060 Secondary/ Middle
Grades Exceptional Child

Interim

EDUC 5040 Affirming Diversity

First Spring Semester r

Research in Curriculum (3 cr.)
(formal observations)

Second Summer Semester I

Problems of Reading (3 cr.)

Second Summer Semester II

Assessment and Accountability
(3 cr.)

154

Second Fall Semester Methods of Teaching (3 cr.)

(formal observations )

Internship I (4 cr.) (formal observations )
Second Spring Semester Internship II Student Teaching (8 cr.)

Course Descriptions (EDUC)

EDUC 1199 Foundation in Education. (3) Fall and Spring
An introduction to teaching and learning. This course addresses
teacher behavior, teacher roles, teacher ethics and experiences;
historical perspectives; philosophical foundations, approaches to
curriculum development; the politics of education, school governance,
school funding and legal issues; school environments; and living and
learning in a diverse society. Prerequisite for admission to education
program and education classes. This course includes an initial school
visitation experience.

EDUC 3317 Science Methods. (3) Spring

This course addresses science content, process skills, attitudes, and real-
world applications that are developmentally appropriate for science and
instruction. Effective teaching strategies that incorporate integrated and
interdisciplinary approaches, technology, literature, multicultural
education, and the Georgia QCC objectives are combined with theories
of learning. Field experience required.

EDUC 3319 Math Methods. (3) Fall

The math methods course focuses on a constructivist approach to
teaching and learning with emphasis on problem-solving, NCTM
standards, and QCC objectives. The course stresses mental
mathematical exercises and activities with manipulatives that promote
mathematical confidence in children. There is an extensive field
experience that involves a semester relationship with exemplary math
teachers. Coursework involves implementation of the tenets that
underlie the conceptual framework of the Education Department.

EDUC 3342 Child Development Practicum. (3) Fall
A study of the principles of growth and development from conception
through twelve years of age. Specific attention will be given to the
influences of family on physical maturation, cognitive development,
social skills, and personality development. Major contributions from
the leading authorities in the field will be emphasized during the study
of each area of development. A nursery and preschool field experience
is required.

155

EDUC 3354 Theories of Reading Instruction. (3) Fall
Different theories of reading instruction will be the focus for this course.
Special emphasis will be on children's literature and its role in
successful reading programs. Other topics include: reading process,
principles of reading instruction, and emergent literacy. IRA standards
and Georgia QCC objectives will provide a basis for lesson plans and
field experiences in local schools.

EDUC 3355 Fundamentals of Reading Instruction. (3) Spring
A study of word recognition strategies with emphasis on phonics.
Teaching techniques for vocabulary and comprehension, reading in
content areas, and interrelatedness of reading and writing will also be
addressed. Standards from IRA and Georgia QCC objectives will be
used in combination with various approaches to effective instruction in
planning effective lessons for experiences in local schools.

EDUC 3442 Nature, Needs and Diversity of Young Adolescents.

(3) Fall
A study of the physical, emotional, social, and intellectual growth and
development of middle grades students. This course will address special
populations, gender issues, cultural and socioeconomic differences and
through a field experience will assist pre-service teachers in
understanding young adolescents and preparing classroom environments
where middle grades students can learn at high levels. NMSA and
Turning Points guidelines will be examined.

EDUC 3456 Reading and Writing in the Middle Grades.

(3) Spring
This course provides an interdisciplinary, literature-based approach to
methods for teaching reading in the content areas to middle school
students. Emphasis will be on reading and writing processes and
strategies, vocabulary, comprehension, study skills, and literature. A
variety of teaching techniques will be developed based on IRA and
NCTE standards as well as Georgia QCC objectives. Field experience
is required.

EDUC 4356 Diagnosis and Remediation of Problems in Reading.

(3) Fall
The focus of this course is the identification and correction of reading
problems in elementary school students. Special attention is given to
testing and teaching materials for corrective work including reading
inventories, formal and informal assessment, and computer programs. A
variety of assessment techniques, IRA standards, and technology, will
be incorporated throughout the course.

156

EDUC 4360 Curriculum and Accountability in Elementary

Grades. (3) Fall
This course addresses the practical aspects of curriculum development
along with the role of preparation and its contribution to successful
classroom management. A variety of assessment techniques, use of
Georgia QCC objectives, technology, and portfolio development are
among other key areas that are studied. EDUC 4360 Curriculum and
Accountability in the Elementary Grades is taken in conjunction with
EDUC 4480 Senior Seminar.

EDUC 4363 Curriculum and Accountability in the Middle

Grades. (3) Fall
This course emphasizes the need for a developmentally responsive
curriculum that addresses the needs of young adolescents and is
academically challenging, integrative and exploratory. The QCC and
NMSA and national curriculum standards are examined and issues of
accountability and teacher effectiveness are addressed. Various
instructional and behavior management strategies are modeled and
discussed. There is an extensive field experience requirement.

EDUC 4449 Classroom Technology for Elementary and Middle

Grades. (3) Fall and Spring
Classroom technology is a 3 semester-hour course offered to early
childhood and middle grades education majors during the fall and spring
semesters. This course will meet the expected performances found in
the Georgia Technology Standards for Educators. It is designed to teach
(a) Global Communication Skills (b) Application Skills and (c)
Integrative Strategies. All students will be responsible for designing a
professional web site and electronic portfolio that will contain evidence
of their expertise in classroom technology. The evidence will be aligned
with the Georgia Technology Standards.

EDUC 4456 Language Arts Methods. (3) Spring

This course provides a thematic approach to methods for teaching

language arts in the elementary grades. Major topics include oral and

written language, reading and writing workshop, spelling, and grammar.

Georgia QCC objectives, NCTE and IRA standards will be used

in developing instructional resources and units. Field experience

is required.

EDUC 4457 Social Studies Methods. (3) Spring
The interdisciplinary nature of social studies will be the focus for the
study of curriculum, methods, technology, and professional sources. An
emphasis will be on planning for and developing resources for
instruction, including the development of a unit with emphasis on the

157

NCSS standards and Georgia QCC objectives for a chosen grade level.
This course includes a field experience component.

EDUC 4459 Special Needs and Exceptional Children.

(3) Fall and Spring
A study of identification and diagnostic techniques for teachers related
to areas of exceptionality among students and of alternative styles of
teaching to meet special needs. The introduction to the Student Support
Team (SST) process, the writing of eligibility reports and Individual
Education Plans (IEP) will be explored. The psychological and
behavioral characteristics of exceptional children will be studied. The
importance of transition and other forms found within the exceptional
children's categories will be identified. Weekly field experience in the
exceptional children's areas will be provided.

EDUC 4460 Diversity in the Elementary Classroom. (3) Interim

This course addresses a variety of issues in diversity including
psychological, physiological, and social conditions of different students.
Various issues of equality and equal opportunity are also examined as
well as strategies for working with children at risk. This course includes
a field experience in diverse school settings outside of Troup County.

EDUC 4480 Senior Seminar. (3) Fall

Senior seminar is taken in conjunction with the curriculum course for
either middle grades or early childhood the semester prior to student
teaching. Senior education majors work closely with a local school for
eight hours each week supervised by college faculty.

EDUC 4490E Early Childhood Student Teaching. (12)

Fall and Spring
This course provides a full-day teaching experience for a minimum of
thirteen weeks. Pre-service teachers will be assigned to diverse public
schools and will gradually assume responsibility for working with
groups and individuals. They will participate in classroom teaching
and observation, planning and evaluation conferences, and other
school-related experiences with guidance provided by the cooperating
teacher and college supervisor gradually assuming total responsibility
for the class.

EDUC 4490M Student Teaching in the Middle Grades. (12)

Fall and Spring
Middle grades pre-service teachers are placed on a team in a middle
school for a minimum of twelve weeks, gradually assuming total
responsibility for the class. They will teach in both areas of
concentration and are evaluated through a rigorous performance based

158

assessment process based on national standards. They will participate in
classroom teaching and observation, planning and evaluation
conferences, and other school-related experiences with guidance
provided by the cooperating teachers and college supervisor.

159

English
Introduction

The Department of English Language and Literature offers a wide range
of courses to meet a variety of needs and demands: composition at
introductory and advanced levels; the literature of England and America;
continental literature (in translation); journalism; and creative writing.

Objectives

The primary goal of courses in composition and literature is to help
students become competent readers and writers by providing them with
challenging texts and ample opportunities to practice their skills of
critical thinking and expression. Toward this end, the English faculty
have set the following four objectives. All students completing the core
curriculum will demonstrate:

proficiency in expository writing with Standard American English
grammar, punctuation, and usage

proficiency in critical reading

the ability to assimilate, organize, and develop ideas logically and
effectively

an understanding of the rudiments of research-based writing,
including accurate and ethical citation and MLA documentation

Objectives of English Major Courses

All students completing the baccalaureate program in English will be
prepared to pursue careers in which a broad knowledge of literature and
a proficiency in critical reading, critical thinking, and expository writing
are important. They also will be prepared to pursue graduate studies in
English and in other professional areas, such as law, medicine, or
journalism. In addition, students who wish to prepare for a career in
teaching may do so by completing a major in English. For each of these
endeavors, English majors will demonstrate:

an extensive knowledge of the development of British literature and
American literature from their origins to the present

a capacity for interpreting literature, reading critically, and
expressing literary ideas, both in oral discussion and in written work

160

an ability to bring informed critical and analytical judgment to
bear on the study of literary issues, both in oral discussion and in
written work

a mastery of the techniques of literary research and the use of
MLA style

a knowledge of Standard American English grammar, punctuation,
and syntax

a knowledge of Standard American English usage

Requirements for English Majors

Before declaring English as a major, students must complete the CORE
composition classes (ENGL 1101 and 1 102) with no grade lower than
aC.

English majors are required to take 37 semester hours in English
language and literature above the 1000 level.

Requirements for English Minors

A minor in English consists of 18 semester hours above the 1000 level,
three courses of which must be at the 3000 level or above.

Assessment

Success in achieving the objectives of the English major will be
demonstrated in the following ways:

completion of each major course with a grade of C or better

completion of an entrance and an exit examination

satisfactory performance on the senior thesis and its presentation

Students are required to take the ETS Major Field Achievement Test in
Literature while enrolled in ENGL 2200 and again while enrolled in
ENGL 4495. Scores will be compared to measure progress. Students
preparing for graduate study in English or law are encouraged to take
the GRE or the LSAT.

Awards

The English Department gives two awards to outstanding senior English
majors during the Honors Day Convocation:

161

the Walter D. Jones Award for Excellence in Composition
and Scholarship

the Murial B. Williams Award for Excellence in
Literary Studies

The Jones award is given to the student whose paper written for a major
course is judged as outstanding by an impartial panel of reviewers. The
Williams award is given to the student who is deemed by the English
faculty to demonstrate the highest standards of scholarship and who
contributes the most to the advancement of literary studies among
English majors at LaGrange College.

A third award, the Frances Marion Chalker Medlock '53 Prize for
Poetry, is awarded to one or more students, regardless of major, who
exhibit a profound love and appreciation of poetry, as determined by the
English faculty.

Finally, each spring at Honors Day, the Department of English
recognizes the most outstanding essay(s) composed for a Rhetoric and
Composition course (ENGL 1 101 or 1 102) during the current academic
year. The winning essay(s) will be published in the next year's edition of
the LaGrange College Handbook of Freshman English.

Writing Center

The Department of English Language and Literature maintains a Writing
Center, which is located in Banks Library. This center serves the college
community by providing advice and support for student writers. The
center is directed by Dr. Laine Scott, who trains upper-level students to
serve as peer writing consultants. The hours of the center are posted
each semester.

The Scroll and LC Writing Contest

Since 1922, The Scroll has been LaGrange College's journal of creative
arts; published each spring, the magazine features the best of fiction,
drama, poetry, essays, and artwork by the students and faculty of
the College.

The LC Writing Contest is an annual event sponsored by the English
Department, the Writing Center, and The Scroll. It is open to all LC
students. First and second prizes are awarded to best entries in
fiction/drama, poetry, and essay. Winners are announced at Honors Day
and included in the annual Scroll.

162

Advanced Placement

Most LaGrange College students will take Rhetoric and Composition I
and II (ENGL 1101 and 1 102) during their freshman year. Some
students will receive credit for one of these courses based on the
Advanced Placement Test.

Students who earn a score of 4 or 5 on the AP Test in English
Language and Composition will receive three hours of credit for
Rhetoric and Composition I [English 1 101].

Students who earn a score of 4 or 5 on the AP Test in English
Literature and Composition will receive three hours of credit
for Rhetoric and Composition II [English 1 102].

Students who earn a score of 4 or 5 on both tests must choose
which course they prefer to exempt. Only one exemption

is allowed.

Only the AP Tests in English Language or English Literature are
accepted for credit in the LaGrange College English program.

Transient Credit

No transient credit will be accepted for courses in freshman composition
(ENGL 1101 or 1102).

Course Descriptions (ENGL)

ENGL 1101 Rhetoric and Composition I. (3) Fall 2005.
Introduction to expository writing, emphasizing the essay form, the
writing process, and rhetorical modes of thesis development.
Standardized test scores, among other criteria, will determine each
student's placement in either a standard, honors, or grammar-intensive
section of ENGL 1101.
Prerequisite to all higher-numbered English courses.

ENGL 1102 Rhetoric and Composition II. (3) Fall 2005,

Spring 2006.
Introduction to critical thinking and writing about literature,
emphasizing reading strategies, analytic writing, research techniques,
and modes of documentation.
Prerequisite to all higher-numbered English courses.

163

ENGL 2200 Introduction to English Studies. (1) Fall 2005.
Introduces students to the academic discipline of English and focuses on
the critical issues (past and present) involved in English Studies.
This course is a prerequisite for English majors for any 3000- or 4000-
level course.
Prerequisites: ENGL 1101, 1102

ENGL 2204 British Literature I. (3) Fall 2005.
A survey of British Literature from the Anglo-Saxon period through the
eighteenth century. Short critical essays required, at least one with
documentation. Required of all English majors.

ENGL 2205 British Literature II. (3) Spring 2006.
A survey of British literature from the Romantics through the Modern/
Postmodern period. Short critical essays required, at least one with
documentation. Required of all English majors.

ENGL 2206 American Literature I. (3) Fall 2005.
A survey of American Literature from the Colonial period through
American Romanticism. Short critical essays required, at least one with
documentation. Required of all English majors.

ENGL 2207 American Literature II. (3) Spring 2006.
A survey of American literature from Realism and Naturalism through
the Modern/ Postmodern period. Short critical essays required, at least
one with documentation. Required of all English majors.

ENGL 2260 Journalistic Writing I. (3) On demand.

An introduction to basic types of writing for newspapers: news, feature,

interview, review, and editorial.

ENGL 2261 Journalistic Writing II. (3) On demand.
Advanced instruction and practice in writing news, features, and
editorials. Course also involves copy editing and layout and design of
news pages.

Prerequisite: ENG 2260 or permission of the instructor.
For English majors:

Prerequisite to 3000-level or 4000-level courses: ENGL 1101,

1102,2200

ENGL 3300 History of the English Language. (3) Spring 2006.
Introduction to principles of linguistics; a survey of the origins and
development of English, and a study of its structure. Required of all
English majors.

164

ENGL 3302 Advanced Grammar. (3) Fall 2006.

A survey of the basic logic and grammatical structure of English, from

morpheme to word, phrase and clause, to sentence.

ENGL 3303 Advanced Composition. (3) Fall 2005.
This course is open to all students, regardless of major, who are
interested in strengthening their written expression beyond the level of
"functional." The focus will be on producing nonfiction prose that is
exemplary for its clarity and finesse.

ENGL 3306 Creative Writing Workshop (poetry). (3) Spring 2007.
An advanced course in imaginative writing. Professional models
studied, but student writing emphasized. Only one workshop (poetry or
fiction) may be taken for major credit.

ENGL 3308 Creative Writing Workshop (fiction). (3) Spring 2006.
An advanced course in imaginative writing. Professional models
studied, but student writing emphasized. Only one workshop (fiction or
poetry) may be taken for major credit.

ENGL 3312 Business Writing. (3) On demand.

(see MGMT 3312).
A study of the basic communication skills needed to prepare business
publications in today's world. Special attention given to format and
correct usage.

ENGL 3314 Classical Backgrounds. (3) On demand.

An examination of major classics, in modern translation, of Greek,

Roman, and Medieval literature.

ENGL 3316 Masterpieces of Continental Literature. (3)

On demand.
Major European classics in translation from the Renaissance through the
twentieth century.

ENGL 3320 Medieval Literature. (3) Spring 2007.

A survey, mostly in Middle English, of English literature to about 1500.

ENGL 3330 English Literature of the Renaissance. (3)

On demand.
Renaissance English literature to about 1675, excluding Shakespeare.

i ENGL 3335 Development of English Drama. (3) On demand.
An examination of the development of English drama, excluding
Shakespeare, from its beginnings up to the Restoration.

165

ENGL 3340 Restoration and Eighteenth-Century English
Literature. (3) Spring 2006.

Selected Restoration, Neoclassical, and Pre-Romantic English literature,
excluding the novel.

ENGL 3345 The Rise of the English Novel. (3) On demand.
A study of the rise of the English novel with an emphasis on selected
works of the late seventeenth-century and eighteenth-century novelists.

ENGL 3350 Romanticism in English Poetry and Selected Prose. (3)

On demand
A study of selected major nineteenth-century British prose and poetry,
with emphasis on lyric verse.

ENGL 3355 The English Novel in the Nineteenth Century. (3)

On demand.
A study of the selected works of Romantic and Victorian novelists.

ENGL 3360 Victorian Poetry and Selected Prose. (3) Fall 2006.
A study of selected major Victorian prose and poetry, with emphasis on
Tennyson, Browning, and the Pre-Raphaelites.

ENGL 3375 American Romanticism. (3) Spring 2007.
Major American Romantic writers of the United States through
Whitman and Dickinson.

ENGL 3380 Post Civil War American Literature. (3)

Spring 2006.
Major American writers of the Realistic and Naturalistic movements in
the United States.

ENGL 3385 Southern American Literature. (3) On demand.
A study of major Southern writers from about 1815 to the present.

ENGL 4400 Literary Theory and Modern Criticism. (3)

Fall 2005.
A study of literary theory through postmodern literary criticism.

ENGL 4410 Chaucer. (3) Fall 2005.

A survey of Chaucer's work. Consideration will also be given to

Chaucerian influence and criticism.

ENGL 4420 Shakespeare. (3) On demand.

The development of Shakespeare's art, as reflected in selected individual

plays or groups of plays.

ENGL 4430 Milton. (3) Fall 2006.
Selected poetry and prose of Milton.

166

ENGL 4440 Twentieth Century Fiction. (3) On demand.

A study of selected novels and short stories of Modern, Postmodern, and

Contemporary American and British fiction writers.

ENGL 4450 Twentieth Century Poetry. (3) On demand.
A study of the major American and British poets of the twentieth
century, their verse techniques, and their contributions to poetic art.

ENGL 4460 Twentieth Century Drama. (3) On demand.
A study of major American and British playwrights of the twentieth
century, their dramatic techniques, and their contributions to the
dramatic arts.

ENGL 4495 Senior Thesis and Presentation. (3) Spring 2006.
English majors will write and present orally an original research project
based on a significant topic in American or English language or literature.
Required of all English majors.
Prerequisite: Senior Standing

ENGL 4499 Independent Study /Research. (3) On demand.

167

Health and Physical Education
Introduction

The curriculum in the Department of Health and Physical Education is
composed of two programs. The physical education activities program
offers a selection of physical skills classes. These classes are designed
to promote physical skill development as well as knowledge in a variety
of activity areas including physical fitness and conditioning, aquatics,
lifetime leisure pursuits, and traditional team sports.

Objectives

Two minor programs in physical education/athletics are available. A
15-hour coursework minor in coaching is available to any student.
Students completing the minor in coaching will:

demonstrate knowledge of the profession of athletics.

understand professional practices, issues, trends, and literature
essential for effective coaching.

demonstrate appropriate professional behaviors for athletic
coaching.

Criteria for completion of this minor are stipulated below.

Required Core for the Physical Education/
Coaching Minor

HPED 3305 Sports Psychology 3 hours

HPED 3310 Coaching Theory and Methods 3 hours
HPED 3312 Principles of Strength, Conditioning,

and Nutrition for Athletes 3 hours

9 hours

Select two (2) courses from the following for a total of 6 hours

HPED 2202 Sports Statistics 3 hours

HPED 3302 Organization and Administration

of P. E. and Athletics 3 hours

HPED 3332 Prevention and Care of Athletic

Injuries/Illnesses 3 hours

HPED 3390 Seminar and Lab Practice in

Physical Education 3 hours

A 15-hour coursework minor also is available in physical education.
Students completing the minor in physical education will 1) demonstrate

168

knowledge of the profession of physical education; 2) understand
professional practices, issues, trends, and literature essential for effective
teaching; 3) demonstrate appropriate professional behaviors for classroom
management. This minor is designed in consultation with the department
chair in Health and Physical Education.

Criteria for Completion of the Physical Education and Coaching
Minors

satisfactorily complete all course work requirements.

maintain a minimum 2.5 cumulative G. P. A.

current certification in Community First Aid/CPR.

Course Descriptions (HPED)

HPED 1153 Camp Leadership and Program. (3) On demand.
A study of camping in an organized setting and of the leadership skills
necessary for the implementation of the camp program.

HPED 1154 Community First Aid/CPR. (3) Fall, Spring.
This course focuses on the identification of emergency situations and
selection of correct response. Certification in American Red Cross
standard first aid and adult, child and infant rescue breathing and
cardiopulmonary resuscitation are earned upon successful completion of
the course.

HPED 1155 Lifeguard Training. (3) Spring.

Competencies in swimming and life guarding techniques, swimming

speed and endurance are developed in this course. American Red Cross

lifeguard training and cardiopulmonary resuscitation for the professional

rescuer certifications are the result of successful completion of this

course.

Prerequisites: Current Standard First Aid Certification; Passing of
the following practical exams on the first day of class;
500 yd. continuous swim (crawl, breast stroke and
sidestroke); treading water for two minutes with
legs only and retrieving a brick from the deep end of
the pool.

HPED 1156 Water Safety Instructor. (3) Spring.
A course which focuses on the development of competencies in
' swimming stroke and instructional techniques. Students who
successfully complete this course earn certification in Red Cross WSI,
enabling them to teach all levels of the Learn to Swim Program, Basic
and Emergency Water Safety courses.

169

HPED 2202 Sports Statistics. (3) On demand.

Techniques of recording sports statistics and maintaining scorebooks are

the focus of this class.

HPED 2251 Introduction to Physical Education. (3) On demand.
A survey course of the career choices available in physical education.
Opportunities to talk with and observe professionals in various sub-
specializations are provided.

HPED 3302 Organization and Administration of Recreational
and Physical Education Programs. (3) On demand.
A study of the organization and administration of instructional,
intramural, and interscholastic activity programs. Special emphasis is
placed on the selection, purchase, and care of safe equipment and
facilities as well as on the legal requirements for providing and
maintaining safe programs and facilities.

HPED 3305 Sports Psychology. (3) Spring.
A study of human behavior in the context of the sporting experience and
how performance is affected by the interactions of the coach, athletes
and the environment. Emphasis is on motivation, personality,
attributions, disengagement from sport, aggression, leadership, and
communication patterns.

HPED 3306 Techniques of Sports Officiating. (3) Spring.
This course focuses on techniques of officiating athletic events.
Knowledge of the rules of selected sports and extensive practical
officiating in selected sports form the basis of this course.

HPED 3310 Coaching Theory and Methods. (3) On demand.
Analysis of teaching skills and techniques of the different interscholastic
sports in high schools.

HPED 3312 Principles of Strength Conditioning and Nutrition

for Athletes. (3) Fall.
This course focuses on the examination of proper techniques, concepts,
and applications of exercise science. Nutritional principles as these
relate to athletic performance also are included.

HPED 3320 Methods in Health and Physical Education in

the Elementary School. (3) Fall.
A study of the objectives, materials, activities, and curricula appropriate
for elementary school physical education and health. Supervised
observation and practical experiences in the elementary schools
are provided.

170

HPED 3331 Personal Health Issues. (3) On demand.
Ci| This course allows students to explore basic health issues and principles
in depth. Topics include fitness, diet and weight control, nutrition,
human sexuality, stress management, death education, aging, and drug
and alcohol education.

HPED 3332 Prevention and Care of Athletic Injuries/Illnesses.

(3) Spring.
This course focuses on common injuries and illnesses occurring in
athletics. Topics include, but are not limited to, heat exhaustion, heat
stroke, abdominal injuries, injury management, emergency triage,
anatomical instability, blood borne pathogens, and mechanics of injury.

HPED 3333 Yoga for Wellness (3) Fall, Winter
A study of the effects that yoga has on all aspects of the human body,
including physical, mental, and spiritual. Topics will include breathing
techniques, asanas, fasting, meditation, and different disciplines of yoga.
There will also be a physical component of this course.

HPED 3352 Physiology of Exercise. (3) On demand.

The effects of exercise on the major systems of the human body,
including cardio respiratory, neuromuscular, glandular, and digestive are
the focus of this course. Effects of heat, altitude, and ergogenic aids on
the human body during exercise also are included.
Prerequisites: BIOL 1148- BIOL 1149

HPED 3390 Seminar and Lab Practice in Physical Education. (3)

Fall, Spring.
This course provides supervised leadership experiences in various
physical education or athletic settings. Seminar discussions focus on
common issues and concerns.
Prerequisites: Junior or Senior standing and completion of 6 hours of

HPED courses.

HPED 4400 Internship in Physical Education and Coaching. (3)

Interim.

Directed observation and participation in physical education, coaching,
and/or supervisory situations.
Prerequisites: Junior or Senior standing, recommendation by the
department chair in health and physical education

Physical Education Activities (PEDU)

The physical education activity program is designed to provide
opportunities for learning or enhancing those skills necessary to

171

participate in leisure time activities throughout the life cycle. Special
emphasis also is given to activities which improve one's physical fitness
and condition. All courses carry one semester hour of credit and
count toward the hours needed for graduation.

PEDU 1102 Beginning Archery. (1) Fall, Spring.

Basic competencies in archery techniques and safety with experiences in

target shooting.

PEDU 1103 Badminton. (1) Spring.

Introduction to the skills, strategies, and rules of badminton

PEDU 1104 Basketball. (1) On demand.

Basic competencies in the techniques, strategies, and rules of basketball.

PEDU 1105 Jogging. (1) Fall, Spring.

Participation in progressive running programs designed to increase

cardiovascular endurance.

PEDU 1107 Bowling. (1) On demand.

Introduction to the basic skills and rules of bowling. Course conducted

at local bowling lanes.

PEDU 1108 Physical Conditioning. (1) Fall, Spring.
Basic assessment, maintenance, and improvement of over-all
physical fitness.

PEDU 1109 Beginning Golf. (1) Fall, Spring.

Introduction to the basic skills, strategies, and rules of golf. Field trips

to city golf courses.

PEDU 1111 Softball. (1) Fall.

Basic competencies and knowledge of rules and strategies of softball.

PEDU 1112 Beginning Tennis. (1) Fall, Spring.
Introduction to the basic skills, strategies, and rules of tennis.

PEDU 1114 Volleyball. (1) Fall, Spring.

Basic competencies in the techniques, strategies, and rules of volleyball.

PEDU 1116 Personal Fitness. (1) Spring.

Introduction to diet and weight control techniques as well as assessment

and maintenance of personal fitness.

PEDU 1120 Karate. (1) On demand.

Basic competencies and skills in karate techniques.

PEDU 1121 Bicycling. (1) On demand.

172

Introduction to the basic equipment, safety, and techniques of cycling

[including training and racing strategies. Weekend field trips.
PEDU 1122 Weightlifting/plyometrics. (1) Fall, Spring.
Introduction to exercises that are geared toward increasing speed, power,
and jumping ability. A basic overview of the physiological factors
I involved in the exercises will be included.

PEDU 1123 Beginning Swimming. (1) Spring.

Introduction to the aquatic environment with emphasis on competence in

primary swimming and safety skills and stroke readiness.

PEDU 1124 Intermediate/Advanced Swimming. (1) On demand.
Development and refinement of key swimming strokes. Introduction to
turns, surface dives, and springboard diving.

I Prerequisite: PEDU 1 123 or equivalent skills.
PEDU 1130 SCUBA. (1) Fall, Spring.

Develop competencies in safe diving techniques and practices as well as
safe use of SCUBA diving equipment. PADI open Water Diver
Certification available upon completion of course and optional trip for
checkout dives.
Prerequisite: PEDU 1 124 or equivalent intermediate swimming skills.

PEDU 1156 Canoeing. (1) Fall, Spring.

Fundamental canoeing skills emphasized. Field trips to lake facilities
and overnight camping experience are provided to give extensive
opportunities for recreational canoeing.

PEDU 1158 Backpacking. (1) Spring.

Introduction to basic equipment, safety, and techniques of trail camping.
I Extensive field trips to state and national trails are provided.

PEDU 1159 Sailing. (1) On demand.

Basic sailing competencies and understanding with experiences in

fundamental racing strategy. Field trips to lake facilities are provided.

PEDU 1160 Snow Skiing. (1) Spring.

Introduction to basic techniques, safety, and equipment of snow skiing.

Field trip to area ski facilities is included.

PEDU 1161 Rhythmic Aerobics. (1) Fall, Spring.
A conditioning course in which exercise is done to musical
accompaniment for the purpose of developing cardiovascular efficiency,
: strength and flexibility.

173

PEDU 1162 Hiking, Orienteering, and Camping. (1) Fall, Spring.
Introduction to basic techniques of tent camping, map, and compass
work. Field trips to nearby campgrounds and forest lands.

PEDU 1164 Water Aerobics. (1) Fall, Spring.
Development of cardio respiratory endurance, flexibility, body
composition, and muscle endurance/tone through vigorous water
exercise. The resistance of the water makes this course an excellent
choice for the beginner as well as the well-conditioned athlete, and for
the swimmer as well as the non-swimmer.

PEDU 1165 Aqua Fitness. (1) On demand.
Development and/or maintenance of cardiovascular fitness through
various aquatic activities including water jogging, circuit training, and
water resistance training. Students will learn to use various aquatic
equipment to implement their personal training.
Prerequisite: PEDU 1 123 or equivalent beginning swimming skills

PEDU 1166 Scottish Country Dance (1) Fall, Spring
Introduction to, and dancing folk dances of Scotland. Learn figures
and steps of reels, jigs, and strathspey. Opportunity to attend workshops
sponsored by the Atlanta Branch of The Royal Scottish Country
Dance Society

174

History

Introduction

The faculty of the Department of History believe that all persons,
whatever their selected role in life, require an understanding of their past
in order to prepare for their future. The faculty firmly believes that the
liberal arts preparation, which encompasses courses from the discipline
of history, provides the student with the most appropriate educational
background for life by integrating knowledge from the broadest range of
disciplines. The objective of the Department of History is to provide
students at LaGrange College with knowledge of the historical forces
which have shaped civilization as we know it.

Objectives

To achieve the objective set forth above the faculty seeks to:

provide students with a basic understanding of the historical
forces which have contributed to the development of civilization.

develop in students an understanding and appreciation of his/her
civilization which is a part of the world community.

The faculty of the department believes that students who select to
complete a major course of study in history should have the foundation
knowledge and understanding of the discipline, developed by classroom
instruction and individual study, necessary to provide them with the
opportunity to:

pursue graduate study within the discipline.

pursue a professional degree in a selected field of study.

pursue employment as a teacher in pre-collegiate education.

seek employment in a field such as government, entry level
historic documentation and preservation, social or historic entry
level research, or a field where their liberal arts preparation can be
beneficially utilized.

Graduates of the Department of History may be found pursuing careers
in business, law, education, politics and government, broadcasting,
journalism, the ministry and other fields of endeavor. In all of these
endeavors our graduates have found that their education has provided a
foundation for their careers and for their growth in life.

175

The Department of History offers the following major in history:

A. Prerequisite Courses

HIST 1101 and 1102
HIST 1111 and 1112

World Civilization
United States History

These are prerequisite courses for the major.

Prerequisite courses can be met by AP or CLEP tests, or by
transfer credit

We strongly encourage the history major to pursue the widest possible
liberal arts preparation by the careful selection of courses from the core
program structure.

B. Two courses from:

HIST 3307

HIST 3308

or

HIST 3310 -3311

Two courses from:

HIST 3301
HIST 3310
HIST 3320

Two courses from:

HIST 3372
HIST 3374

Required courses:

HIST 2000
HIST 4490

Social and Intellectual of the

United States

American Diplomatic History

Constitutional History of the
United States

Greco-Roman world

Middle Ages

Renaissance and Reformation

Europe 1660- 1870
Europe 1870 - the Present

Research Methods in History
Senior History Seminar

C.

An additional nine semester hours of 3000 and 4000 level
history courses are required. The total major course
requirements are 33 semester hours credit beyond 1000
level courses.

Success in achieving the objectives established for the major will be
demonstrated as follows:

successful completion of each major course with a grade of C
or better.

176

successful completion of the senior history seminar and defense of
the senior thesis before the students and faculty of the department.

successful completion of a major field examination during their
senior year.

Those wishing to major in history are encouraged to declare their major
during the beginning of the spring semester of their sophomore year.

Upper level courses in history, those numbered 3000 or above (with the
exception of HIST 4490), are available to all students who have
successfully completed prerequisites.

Course Descriptions (HIST)

HIST 1101 World Civilization I. (3) Fall, Spring.

Survey course on the development of world civilization up to 1660.

HIST 1102 World Civilization II. (3) Fall, Spring.

Survey course on the development of world civilization from 1660 to

the present.

HIST 1111 History of the United States to 1865. (3) Fall, Spring.
Emphasis on the Colonial, Revolutionary, early national, and Civil
War periods.

HIST 1112 History of the United States, 1865 to the Present.

(3) Fall, Spring.

Emphasis on Reconstruction, liberal nationalism, New Deal, and

postwar periods.

HIST 2000 Research Methods in History. (3) Interim only.

This course is required of all sophomore history majors. It will
! acquaint the student with the basic components of historical
methodology and research.

HIST 2010 Islamic Civilization (3). On demand.

An introduction to the basic tenets of Islam and survey of the growth

and diversification of Islamic Civilization.

HIST 3301 Greco-Roman World. (3) Fall 2005.

A study of Greco-Roman civilization from its birth in ancient
| Greece through the collapse of the western Roman empire in the fifth
I century A.D.

HIST 3302 The Middle Ages, 350-1350. (3) Spring 2006.
This course offers a comprehensive study of the development
of medieval civilization from the late fifth century to the late
fourteenth century.

177

HIST 3306 History of the South. (3) On demand.

Emphasis on the antebellum, Civil War, Reconstruction, and New
South periods.

HIST 3307 Social and Intellectual History of the United States.

(3) Fall 2006.
A review of ideas and patterns of thought, the role of social, ethnic, and
racial groups, and the major institutions of American society.

HIST 3308 American Diplomatic History. (3) Fall 2005.

Emphasis on the procedure for developing foreign policy as well as
diplomatic history.

HIST 3310 Constitutional History of the United States to 1900.

(3) Fall 2005.

An analysis of fundamental constitutional development from 1776
to present.
Prerequisites: HIST 1 1 1 1 and HIST 1112

HIST 3311 Constitutional History of the United States 1901 to

the Present. (3) Spring 2006.
An analysis of fundamental constitutional development from 1901 to
the present.

HIST 3312 Economic History of the United States. (3)

On demand.
American economic development from colonial times to the present.

HIST 3315 Georgia History. (3) Summer/On demand.

A study of Georgia History from the pre-colonial period to the present
with emphasis on the historical, social, economic and political development
of the State.

HIST 3320 The Renaissance and the Reformation, 1350-1600.

(3) Fall 2006.
This course offers a detailed study of the civilization of Renaissance and
Reformation Europe. Primary focus will be placed on the artistic and
religious achievements of the period 1350 to 1600.

HIST 3330 The Medieval Church and Papacy. (3) Spring 2007.
This course will examine the institutional and cultural history of the
medieval church, with special emphasis on the role of the papacy, and
its impact on medieval civilization.

HIST 3340 Medieval Kings and Queens. (3) Fall 2006.

A survey of medieval kings and queens and their influence on the
development of medieval civilization.

178

HIST 3341 Russia to 1856. (3) Fall 2005.

A comprehensive survey of the Russian historical development from
the appearance of the Kievan State in the 9 th century through the
Crimean War.

HIST 3342 Russia 1856 to the Present. (3) Spring 2006.

An examination of the Imperial Russian state.

HIST 3350 Renaissance and Renascences. (3) Spring 2005.

An examination of the great cultural revivals from the age of
Charlemagne to the age of Michelangelo.

HIST 3361 History of England to 1689. (3) Fall 2006.

A political, economic, social, and cultural history of England from 1689 to

the present.

HIST 3362 History of England from 1689 to Present. (3)

Spring 2007.
A political, economic, social and cultural history of England from 1689
to present.

HIST 3372 Europe 1660-1870. (3) Fall 2006.

A comprehensive survey of European history from the reign of Louis XTV

through the rise of the modem German state in 1 870.

HIST 3374 Europe 1870 to the Present. (3) Spring 2007.

1 A comprehensive survey of European history from the Bismarckian Era
rto the present.

HIST 3378 European Diplomatic History: 1890 to the Present.

(3) On demand.

A detailed examination of European international relations from 1890,
the end of the Bismarkian system to the present.
HIST 4416 Twentieth Century America. (3) On demand.
An intensive study of the United States during the twentieth century.

HIST 4478 Contemporary Europe. (3) On demand.

An examination of European history focusing on major issues
since 1945.

HIST 4490 Senior History Seminar. (3) Spring.

Ill study of historiography and research methods and materials.
Prerequisites'. Senior History Major or permission of the professor and

the Chair of the Department. This course may only be

attempted twice.

179

Human Services
Introduction

The Department of Human Services and Sociology offers a bachelor of
arts degree in human services that equips generalist-level helping
professionals with the knowledge and skills necessary to provide caring
and ethical services to individuals, families, and communities.

Objectives

The Human Services curriculum provides students with valuable
knowledge and skills applicable in virtually every personal,
professional, social, and cultural setting. Human Services majors
benefit from extensive liberal arts linkages with courses reaching across
various disciplines, including Social Work, Sociology, Anthropology,
and Psychology. Human Services graduates are prepared to pursue
advanced degrees in a variety of graduate and professional programs,
including Social Work, Sociology, Community Counseling, and Public
Administration. In addition, majors may pursue careers in a wide
variety of fields, such as social work, criminal and juvenile justice,
mental health and healthcare, nonprofit administration and management,
community organization and urban planning, community education, and
social policy research.

Human Services coursework will provide students with both factual and
theoretical knowledge of society and culture, as well as strategies for
understanding and working with diverse populations and marginalized
groups. Because of the increasing diversity of the population of the
United States, and as the world becomes a global community, this match
of knowledge and skills will be increasingly important for our
profession and our society.

During their final year, human services majors participate in a field
practicum or internship, which allows them to gain insight and actual
experience working in a particular area of Human Services. There are
many opportunities in various fields, such as youth support
organizations, child advocacy, shelters for women and families, teen
pregnancy centers, community centers for the elderly, criminal justice
organizations, community development corporations, recreational
therapy, faith-based interventions, and other non-profit and
governmental organizations.

180

Requirements for Major

Human Services majors are required to successfully complete the
following 42 semester hours with no grade lower than a "C" ("P" for
HUSV4491):

Foundation (15 hours)

HUSV 2299 Introduction to Human Services

HUSV 3352 Life Course and the Social Environment

PSYC 1101 Introduction to Psychology

SOCI 1 146 Principles of Sociology

SOCI 2247 Diverse Families

Policy (3 hours)

Choose one of the following:

SOCI 2253 Social Problems and Policy

HUSV 3377 Social Welfare: Policy and Analysis

Practice (9 hours)

HUSV 33 1 1 Ethical Human Services Practice
HUSV 4422 Cultural Competency in Human Services

Choose one of the following:

HUSV 3312 Groups and Adventure-Based Therapy
HUSV 4478 Special Topics in Human Services Practice
PSYC 3351 I ntroduction to Counseling

Option A:

MATH 1114 Introduction to Statistics

Choose one of the following:

HUSV 4476 Research Methods in Human Services
POLS 3300 Research Methods in Political Science

Option B:

PSYC 2298 Behavioral Statistics
PSYC 2999 Research Methods

Field Practice (9 hours)

HUSV 4491 Field Practice

Majors are encouraged to pursue a double major, a minor or to take
electives in any of the following disciplines: Biology, Business,
Education, Latin American Studies, Nursing, Psychology, Religion,
Sociology, Spanish and non-required Human Services courses. To do so
will complement the human services curriculum, enhance a liberal arts
education and strengthen a student's efforts to seek employment and
pursue graduate education in a helping profession.

181

Requirements for Minor

A minor in Human Services consists of 12 semester hours, six of which
must be at the 3000 level or higher.

All students planning to minor in human services must take the
following:

HUSV 2299 Introduction to Human Services
HUSV 331 1 Ethical Human Services Practice

Students must also complete an additional six semester hours of HUSV
coursework, three of which must be at the 3000 level or higher. A
relevant Interim course may be accepted upon approval of the
department chair.

Assessment

Mastery of the curriculum for a human services major is measured by:
completion of all major requirements with a C or higher in every
course

receiving credit for the field practicum course

satisfactorily delivering an integrative presentation during the
culmination of the field practicum

Course Descriptions (HUSV)

HUSV 1148 Introduction to Anthropology. (3) On demand

A general introduction to the scientific study of the origin, the behavior,

and the physical, social, and cultural development of humans.

HUSV 2299 Introduction to Human Services. (3) Spring 2006
An introduction to generalist human services. Emphasis is placed on the
historical development of this young profession as well as exposure to
various career opportunities in the helping profession. A 50-hour field
experience is required.

HUSV 3308 Cultural and Social Anthropology. (3) Fall 2005
A study of comparative cultures and social structures with special
emphasis upon the ethnography of primitive people.

HUSV 3311 Ethical Human Services Practice. (3) Fall 2005
This course integrates theory and technique development through a
combination of lecture and laboratory to provide students with the
opportunity to develop generalist level ethical human services practice
skills.
Prerequisite: HUSV 2299

182

HUSV 3312 Groups and Adventure-Based Therapy.

(3) On demand
An introduction to key concepts in basic therapeutic group processes
with a special emphasis on experiential outdoor therapeutic
interventions. Students will participate in outdoor activities such as
teambuilding exercises, ropes course, and spelunking. This course
requires multiple off-campus trips of one to two days in duration.

HUSV 3352 Life Course and the Social Environment.

(3) Fall 2005
An in-depth look into the American life course. The course will
consider the biological, psychological, and sociological aspects of
various life course stages. Students will become familiarized with the
ways in which social, economic, and historical changes help to construct
and reconstruct the life course.

HUSV 3377 Social Welfare: Policy and Analysis. (3) On demand
An advanced study on the current policies determining the provision of
social welfare services in America. Students explore the role of public
policy in helping or deterring people in maintaining or achieving
optimal health and well-being. Analysis of current social welfare
policies and their effect on human services practice will be undertaken

HUSV 4422 Cultural Competency in Human Services.

(3) Spring 2006
Utilizing an intensive travel or home stay model, this course enables
students to learn about differences and similarities in the experiences,
needs, and beliefs of all people and to develop the necessary and
differential assessment and intervention skills that will enable them, as
helping professionals, to serve an increasingly diverse population.

Prerequisites: HUSV 2299, HUSV 331 1 and student must have

Senior standing

Co-requisite: HUSV 4491

HUSV 4476 Research Methods in Human Services. (3) Fall 2005
An overview of research design and methodology germane to the
helping professions. Course emphasizes different methods of gathering
data, ethical concerns in this area, and basic statistical matters.

Prerequisites: HUSV 2299 and MATH 1 1 14

Cross-listing: POLS 3300

HUSV 4478 Special Topics in Human Services Practice.

(3) On demand
This course offers students information and insight into a selected area
of the practice of human services.
Prerequisites: HUSV 2299 (or chair's approval)

183

HUSV 4491 Field Practice. (9) Spring and Summer 2006
Seniors engage in a 320-hour field experience that serves as a capstone
to the major and introduces the student to the human services profession.
Students are placed at a human services organization and are supervised
by a field instructor who will work with the faculty to design a
customized experience that provides an integrative learning experience.
A complementary weekly seminar serves to ensure that the student
demonstrates integration of theory with practice by allowing for
processing of information and the completion of assignments that link
the major's curriculum to the practicum.

Grading: Pass/No Credit

Prerequisites: HUSV 2299, HUSV 3311 and student must have

Senior standing

Co-requisite: HUSV 4422

Student visits a Guatemalan orphanage as part of
an Interim course.

184

Latin American Studies and
Modern Languages

Introduction

Latin American Studies is a growing program at LaGrange College. It
is an interdisciplinary program that introduces the student to the cultural
diversity and richness of Latin America and its people. Due to the
increasing presence and importance of Latinos in the United States, a
minor in Latin American Studies enhances one's career opportunities
and effectiveness in such fields as business, government, health care,
journalism, law, and social work.

Objectives

While the minor in Latin American Studies currently requires 6 hours of
Spanish language study, students are encouraged to take more Spanish
courses in order to develop basic conversational fluency. In addition,
study abroad is strongly encouraged because it provides the student with
total cultural immersion. At present the College offers only a minor in
Latin American Studies; yet, the hope is to expand and to be able to
provide a major in the near future.

! A minor in Latin American Studies consists of the following 18 hours of
course work:

Spanish courses 6 hrs.

LAST 1 104 Latin American Culture 3 hrs.

LAST 2000 Introduction to Latin American Studies 3 hrs.

LAST 3110 Special Topics or Spanish 3110 3 hrs.

Elective in either LAST or Spanish 3 hrs.
(3000 level or above)
Course Descriptions (LAST)

LAST 1104 Introduction to Latin American Culture. (3)

A study of the art, literature, history, and anthropology of Latin America
(fulfills LANG 2000 requirement).

LAST 1199 Latin American Travel Seminar. (1-9)
1 A travel-study seminar which provides valuable educational experience
through close contact with the contemporary life and civilization of a
selected Latin American country. Basic academic preparation in the
history and customs of the target culture is undertaken before departure.
Prerequisites: SPAN 1 101, SPAN 1 102 and SPAN 2103 or
permission of instructor and chair of Latin
American Studies.

185

LAST 2000 Introduction to Latin American Studies. (3)

An interdisciplinary approach to the people, culture, development
and identity of Latin America. Attention will be given to such topics
as art, class, economics, gender, history, literature, music, politics, race,
and religion.

LAST 3001 Survey of Latin American Literature I. (3)

A general survey of contemporary Latin American literature.

LAST 3002 Survey of Latin American Literature II. (3)

Focuses on the works of a current major Latin American writer
or writers.

LAST 3110 Special Topics. (3)

A study of selected topics from a specific discipline. Since the focus of
this course changes frequently, this course may be repeated for credit.

LAST 3210 Latin American Politics. (3)

This course examines the dynamics of Latin American politics. The
class will be divided into three overlapping themes: political
development, economic growth, and political violence.

LAST 3930 Intercultural Communications. (3)

A study of the cultural risks confronting the business manager in an
international environment. This course will survey the differences in
values and codes of behavior among a number of cultures with the
primary focus being on Latin America. This course will give the student
the opportunity to learn how to read and respond to the organizational
culture of regulators, business associates, and customers across
cultural borders.

Spanish

As the Latino population increases in the United States, the ability to
speak Spanish is becoming an asset if not a necessity in the market
place. This need is already occurring in such diverse fields as business,
education, health care, law, and social work. In order to better prepare
our students to meet this growing need in their future fields, we offer a
major and minor in Spanish. While not required, study abroad is
strongly encouraged for both our majors and minors to improve
language fluency and cultural awareness.

186

A major in Spanish consists of a total of 36 hours. Thirty of these hours
are in Spanish courses above 1 102. Required courses are as follows:

SPAN 2103 Intermediate Spanish I 3 hrs.

SPAN 2105 Intermediate Spanish II 3 hrs.

SPAN 2106 Introduction to Hispanic Literature 3 hrs.

SPAN 3000 Spanish Conversation and Composition I 3 hrs.

SPAN 3001 Spanish Conversation and Composition II 3 hrs.

SPAN 3002 Hispanic Culture and Civilization 3 hrs.

SPAN 4000 Latin American Literature 3 hrs

SPAN 4001 Peninsular Spanish Literature 3hrs.
The remaining six hours of the major consists of two Latin American
Studies electives.

A minor in Spanish consists of 18 hours. Eighteen of these hours are in
Spanish courses above Spanish 1 102. Required courses are as follows:

SPAN 2103 Intermediate Spanish I 3 hrs.

SPAN 2105 Intermediae Spanish II 3 hrs.

SPAN 2106 Introduction to Hispanic Literature 3 hrs.

SPAN 3000 Spanish Conversation and Composition 3 hrs.

SPAN 3001 Spanish Conversation and Composition II 3 hrs.
Plus:

SPAN Spanish Elective 3 hrs.
Course Descriptions (SPAN)

SPAN 1101 Elementary Spanish I. (3)

A course for beginners with intensive practice in pronunciation,
essentials of grammar, and reading of simple prose.

SPAN 1102 Elementary Spanish II. (3)

: A continuation of Spanish 1101.
Prerequisite: Spanish 1101

SPAN 2103 Intermediate Spanish I. (3)

A review of grammar and syntax with practice in reading selected texts.
Prerequisite: Spanish 1 102 or permission of instructor

SPAN 2105 Intermediate Spanish II. (3)

A continuation of Spanish 2103.
Prerequisite: SPAN 2103 or permission of instructor

187

SPAN 2106 Introduction to Hispanic Literature. (3)

An introductory course designed to introduce the intermediate
level language student to reading and analyzing short literary works
in Spanish.
Prerequisite: SPAN 2103 or permission of the instructor

SPAN 2199 Latin American Seminar. (1-9)
A travel-study seminar which provides valuable educational experience
through close contact with the contemporary life and civilization of a
selected Spanish-speaking country. Basic academic preparation in the
history and customs of the target culture is undertaken before departure.
Prerequisites: SPAN 1 101, SPAN 1 102, and SPAN 2103 or
permission of instructor and chair of Latin American Studies

SPAN 3000 Spanish Conversation and Composition I. (3)

A course stressing practice in speaking and writing Spanish. Not open
to students fluent in Spanish.
Prerequisite: SPAN 2105 or permission of instructor

SPAN 3001 Spanish Conversation and Composition II. (3)

A continuation of Spanish 3000. Not open to students fluent in Spanish.
Prerequisite: SPAN 3000 or permission of instructor

SPAN 3002 Hispanic Culture and Civilization. (3)

This course provides an overview of Spain's and Latin America's
cultures and civilizations.
Prerequisite: SPAN 2106 or permission of instructor

SPAN 3110 Special Topics. (3)

The further development of Spanish language skills by focusing on a
variety of professions or fields of study. Since the focus of this course
changes frequently, this course may be repeated for credit.
Prerequisite: SPAN 2103 or permission of instructor

SPAN 4000 Latin American Literature. (3)

An advanced course designed to introduce the student to Latin
America's major literary movements and writers.
Prerequisite: SPAN 2106 or permission of instructor

SPAN 4001 Peninsular Spanish Literature. (3)

An advanced course designed to introduce the students to Spain's major
literary movements and writers.
Prerequisite: SPAN 2106 or permission of instructor

188

SPAN 4002 Latin American Women Writers. (3)

This course will introduce the student to major contemporary Latin
American and Latina women writers. Writers and works to be studied will
change periodically.
Prerequisite: SPAN 4000 or SPAN 4001 or permission of instructor

Modern Languages

The program in Modern Language is administered by the department of
Latin American Studies. Courses are taught in Spanish, French, German
and other modern languages (under the LANG label).

Minor in French

For students wishing to develop their general understanding of French
and the Francophone world, and/or wish to concentrate in a particular
area of French language study. The French minor consist of 18 credits
(12 additional credits beyond the intermediate level).

Required courses :

15 credits

FREN2103 Intermediate French I 3 credits

FREN2105 Intermediate French II 3 credits

FREN 3000 French conversation 3 credits

FREN 3001 Advanced Grammar and Composition 3 credits
FREN 3002 French civilization , or

FREN 3003 French Literature (Every other year) 3 credits

The remaining 3 hours can come from any 3000 level French course
listed below:

FREN 3004 Francophone culture and Literature (On demand)

FREN 3110 "Special Topics":

Topics will change, so students may take for repeat credit.

FREN 3110 Business French (On demand)

FREN 3110 Translation and Reading in French (On demand)

FREN 3110 French Philosophers (On demand)

Total credits: 18 credits

89

French (FREN)

FREN 1101 Beginning French I. (3)

A course for beginners with intensive practice in pronunciation,
essentials of grammar, and reading of simple prose.
FREN 1102 Beginning French II. (3)
A continuation of French 1101.
Prerequisite: FREN 1101 or permission of instructor

FREN 2103 Intermediate French I. (3)

A continuation of French 1 102 with additional readings.
Prerequisite: FREN 1 102 or permission of instructor

FREN 2105 Intermediate French II. (3)

A systematic and thorough review of French grammar with emphasis on
the production of speech. Not open to students fluent in French.
Prerequisite: FREN 2103 or permission of instructor

FREN 2199 Francophone Travel Seminar. (1-9)

A travel-study seminar composed of preliminary academic preparation
followed by contact with the target culture through travel in the selected
French-speaking country.
Prerequisite: FREN 1 101, FREN 1 102, and FREN 2103 or

permission of instructor and chair of Latin

American Studies

FREN 3000 French Conversation. (3)

The goal of this course is to help students improve their

(1) vocabulary

(2) oral comprehension: listening skills

(3) oral production: speaking skills

FREN 3001 Advanced Grammar & Composition. (3)

The objective of this course is to allow the participants to improve their
composition skills in French. The course has three major components:
grammar review and refinement; reading and analysis of various kinds
of texts, both literary and journalistic; a variety of composition
assignments involving such techniques as description, analysis,
persuasion, and managing complicated chronologies. The participants
can expect to improve their command of French grammar, to increase
their vocabulary, and to develop appropriate strategies for writing
good compositions.

FREN 3002 French civilization: Making and Identity of France. (3)

Concentrating on political and social history, rather than "high culture,"
this course is designed to introduce you to the great moments and great

190

personages who have defined France and what it is to be French across
the centuries. Some high points include Roman Gaul, the Carolingian
Renaissance, St. Louis and the high Gothic Period, Jeanne d'Arc and the
Hundred Years' War, Renaissance and Reform, Louis XIV and
Versailles, the Revolution, Napoleon, Revolution and Restoration in the
19th century, France at war in the 20th century.

FREN 3003 Introduction to French Literature. (3)

An introduction to representative writers from the Middle Ages to the
Revolution. Attention will be paid to the changing social and cultural
contexts in which the literature was produced; emphasis will be on
enduring humanistic values.

FREN 3004 Francophone Literature and Culture. (3)

As a four skills course, this FR 3004 class seeks to improve the reading,
writing, speaking and listening skills of students studying French
particularly with the goal of preparing those students who wish to go on
for upper division French. The four skills mentioned will be integrated
into the body of the course, and will be developed simultaneously.
Prerequisite: Fr 3002 or FR 3003

FREN 3110 Special topics. (3)

Topics will change so students may take for repeat credit.

Translation & Reading in French

Translation and Reading skills. This course concentrates exclusively on
the cultivation of reading and translation abilities in the French
language. Classes are in English and all work is from French to English.

Business French

The trend of internationalizing business and services forces companies
to cope with cultural differences inside a company and when sending
executives and their families abroad. In a foreign country there are more
than language barriers to overcome. Methods which work at home can
lead to failure abroad. Likewise, the most competent manager can
damage an operation if not properly prepared for his or her stay in the
host country. This course is designed to help you cross cultural
boundaries, whether you are planning on living abroad as a student, an
intern, or an employee. It is not meant to be a technical business course,
but rather a course that will help you understand what culture shock is,
and how you can prepare yourself for it.

191

French Philosophers An introduction to French Philosophers and the
different philosophical currents that have shaped French thought and the
world at large.

German (GERM)
GERM 1101 Beginning German I. (3)

A course for beginners with intensive practice in pronunciation,
essentials of grammar, and reading of simple prose.

GERM 1102 Beginning German II. (3)

A continuation of German 3101.
Prerequisite: GERM 1101 or permission of instructor

GERM 2103 Intermediate German I. (3)

Continuation of the development of proficiency in listening and
speaking, while expanding the reading and writing skills using materials
of a literary or cultural nature, grammar review included.
Prerequisite: German 1102

GERM 2104 Intermediate German II. (3)

A continuation of German 2103.
Prerequisite: German 2103

Other Languages and Culture (LANG)*

LANG 1101 Beginning Language I. (3) Fall 2005

A course of Japanese for beginners with intensive practice in oral
communications, pronunciation, essentials of grammar, and where possible,
reading of simple prose.

LANG 1102 Beginning Language II. (3) Spring 2005

A continuation of Language 1101.
Prerequisite: LANG 1101 or equivalent

LANG 1103 Beginning Language III. (3)

A continuation of Language 1 102
Prerequisite: LANG 1 102 or equivalent

LANG 1199 Language Travel Seminar (1-9)
A travel-study seminar which provides further preparation in the target
language and culture through travel in a country which speaks the
language. Academic work is determined by the course instructor.

Prerequisites: LANG 1 101, LANG 1 102, and LANG 1 103 or consent
of instructor and chair of Latin American Studies.

LANG 2000 Culture and Civilization of a Selected Country. (3)

A survey of the civilization and culture of one of the major societies of
the world. The course examines the culture's social and political
192

development, its customs and traditions, and its contributions to the
global community in terms of art, music and literature. (LAST 1 104 can
fill this requirement.)

LANG 2104 Intermediate Language. (3)

An intensive review of the language grammar with emphasis on the
production of speech. Not open to students fluent in the language.
Note: These courses are available so that a language other than French,
German, or Spanish may be available from time-to-time.

193

Mathmatics

Introduction

The Mathematics curriculum at LaGrange College provides a solid
undergraduate mathematics foundation. Along with the broad-based
general education curriculum, the Mathematics department seeks to
prepare mathematics majors for careers in industry or teaching, or for
graduate study in mathematics.

Objectives

To be accepted as a major in the Mathematics Department, a student
must have completed Mathematics 2221, have an overall GPA of 2.25 or
better, and a GPA of 2.5 or better in all mathematics courses numbered
2221 or higher. Students can pursue the Bachelor of Arts degree with a
major in mathematics or a Bachelor of Science degree with a major in
mathematics. Students who pursue the Bachelor of Arts degree have
more options in selecting their courses. This is the liberal studies
degree in mathematics. Students who complete the Bachelor of Arts
degree usually seek careers in areas such as banking, general business,
and secondary education. A more in-depth degree is earned by students
in the Bachelor of Science program. Students who complete the
Bachelor of Science degree usually enter graduate schools or pursue
industrial positions.

The Bachelor of Arts Degree

This degree requires a minimum of 42 semester hours in mathematics
courses, as follows:

MATH 2221 Analytic Geometry and Calculus I (4)

MATH 2222 Analytic Geometry and Calculus II (4)

MATH 2223 Analytic Geometry and Calculus III (4)

MATH 2224 Differential Equations (3)

MATH 3306 College Geometry (3)

MATH 3316 Probability Theory (3)

MATH 3335 Linear Algebra (3)

MATH 3380 Discrete Mathematics (3)*

OR MATH 3382 Combinatorial Design Theory (3)*

MATH 4333 Modern Algebra I (3)**

OR MATH 4343 Analysis I (3)

**

MATH 4350 Problem Solving (3)

194

I One of these courses must be taken. The other may be used to satisfy
one of the additional courses, listed below.

** One of these courses must be taken. The other may be used to satisfy
one of the additional courses, listed below.

plus 3 additional courses

MATH 2261

MATH 3305

MATH 3317

MATH 3340

MATH 3342

MATH 3380

MATH 3382

MATH 4333

MATH 4334

MATH 4343

MATH 4344

MATH 4410
ORCSCI4100

MATH 4495

MATH 4496

MATH 4499

, selected from
Calculus Applications
Number Theory
Mathematical Statistics
History of Mathematics
Complex Variables
Discrete Mathematics
Combinatorial Design Theory
Modern Algebra I
Modern Algebra II
Analysis I
Analysis II
Numerical Analysis
Numerical Analysis
Independent Study
Independent Study
Special Topics in Mathematics

(3)
(3)
(3)
(3)
(3)
(3)
(3)
(3)
(3)
(3)
(3)
(3)
(3)
(3)
(3)
(3)

A programming course in Computer Science is required, as approved by
advisor.

Bachelor of Science Degree

This degree requires a minimum of 48 semester hours in mathematics
courses, as follows:

MATH 2221
MATH 2222
MATH 2223
MATH 2224
MATH 3316
MATH 3317
MATH 3335
MATH 3342
MATH 3380
OR MATH 3382
MATH 4333
MATH 4343
MATH 4350

Analytic Geometry and Calculus I
Analytic Geometry and Calculus II
Analytic Geometry and Calculus III
Differential Equations
Probability Theory
Mathematical Statistics
Linear Algebra
Complex Variables
Discrete Mathematics
Combinatorial Design Theory
Modern Algebra I
Analysis I
Problem Solving

(4)

(4)

(4)

(3)

(3)

(3)

(3)

(3)

(3)*

(3)*

(3)

(3)

(3)

195

*One of these courses must be taken. The other may be used to satisfy
one of the additional courses, listed below.

plus 3 additional courses, selected from :

MATH 2261 Calculus Applications (3)

MATH 3305 Number Theory (3)

MATH 3306 College Geometry (3)

MATH 3340 History of Mathematics (3)

MATH 4334 Modern Algebra II (3)

MATH 4344 Analysis II (3)

MATH 44 1 Numerical Analysis (3)

ORCSCI4100 Numerical Analysis (3)

MATH 4495 Independent Study (3)

MATH 4496 Independent Study (3)

MATH 4499 Special Topics in Mathematics (3)

A programming course in Computer Science is required, as approved
by advisor. Physics 1121 and 1 122 are recommended.

Assessment

Assessment of the objectives of the mathematics program is based on
the following:

Mathematics majors will complete each major course with a grade
of C or better.

Students who have earned a grade of A or B in MATH 4350 taking
one of the following exams:

1 . Praxis II

2. GRE Subject Test in Mathematics

3. an Actuarial Science Examination administered by either
the Society of Actuaries (SOA) or the Casualty Actuarial
Society (CAS)

Will earn a satisfactory score on the exam in no more than two
attempts, provided that the exams are taken within six months of
completing MATH 4350.

A survey will be sent to recent graduates of the program during the fall
term of each year. The results of these surveys will be considered and
may result in changes to improve the program.

196

Minor

A minor in mathematics consists of the following courses: MATH 2221,
plus five additional courses selected from MATH 2222, 2223, 2224,
2261, 3305, 3306, 3316, 3317, 3335, 3342, 3380, 3382, 4333, 4334,
4343, 4344, 4350, 4410, 4495, 4496, and 4499. At least two of the six
courses must be at the 3000 or 4000 level.

Course Descriptions (MATH)

MATH 0100 Basic Mathematics. (3) Fall, Spring
An overview of basic skills in mathematics, including ratio and
proportion, percent, use of fractions and decimals, systems of
measurement and linear equations.

MATH 1101 College Algebra. (3) Fall, Spring
A study of sets, real numbers, operations, order, inequalities, polynomial
factoring, functions, graphs, exponents, first- and second-degree
equations, and systems of equations.
Prerequisite: MATH 0100 or satisfactory score on mathematics
placement test.

MATH 1114 Introduction to Statistics. (3) Fall, Spring
An introduction to probability and statistics. Topics include descriptive
statistics, probability, the Normal probability distribution, and
hypothesis testing.
Prerequisite: MATH 1 101 or 2105 or 2221.

MATH 1117 Quantitative Methods. (3) Spring

| A study of finite mathematical models with an emphasis on the

quantitative skills required to solve applications related to business.

Prerequisite: MATH 1 101 or 2105 or 2221.
i
MATH 1121 A Survey of Calculus. (3) Spring

An intuitive introduction, using technology, to the concepts and

applications of calculus. Topics include functions and graphing,

tangents to a curve, differentiation and integration, maxima, minima,

and area under a curve.

Prerequisite: MATH 1101 or 2105 or satisfactory score on

mathematics placement test.

Note: Not open to students who have credit for

MATH 2221.

197

MATH 2105 Precalculus. (4) Fall, Spring

A study of calculus-oriented algebra and trigonometry. Topics include
simplifying algebraic expressions, solving equations, exponential and
logarithmic functions, applications of functions, graphs, and the
trigonometric functions.
Prerequisite: MATH 1101 or satisfactory score on mathematics
placement test.

MATH 2221 Analytic Geometry and Calculus I. (4) Fall, Spring
An introduction to differential and integral calculus. Topics include
limits, differentiation and applications, integration and applications, and
exponential and logarithmic functions.
Prerequisite: MATH 2105 or 1 121 (and permission of instructor) or
satisfactory score on mathematics placement test.

MATH 2222 Analytic Geometry and Calculus II. (4) Fall, Spring
A continuation of Math 2221. Topics include the calculus of the
trigonometric and inverse trigonometric functions, improper integrals,
indeterminate forms, the conic sections, and techniques of integration.
Prerequisite: MATH 2221.

MATH 2223 Analytic Geometry and Calculus III. (4) Fall, Spring.
A continuation of the study of the calculus. Topics include sequences
and series, parametric equations, polar coordinates, functions of two
or more variables, partial derivatives, multiple integrals, and
vector analysis.
Prerequisite: MATH 2222.

MATH 2224 Differential Equations. (3) Spring.
A study of first and second order differential equations with
applications, numerical methods, and solution in series.
Prerequisite or Co-requisite: MATH 2223.

MATH 2261 Calculus Applications. (3) On demand
A study of applications which can be solved using calculus. The course
will utilize technology, in the form of graphing calculators, a software
package (such as Mathematica or Maple), or both.
Prerequisite: MATH 2222.

MATH 3001 Mathematical Applications for Teachers.

(3) Fall, even years
A study of topics in graph theory, linear programming, scatterplots, least
squares regression, topics in coding theory, exponential growth and
decay, number patterns, symmetry and tilings.

Prerequisite: MATH 1101 or higher.

Note: Open only to Elementary and Middle Grades Education Majors.

198

MATH 3002 Geometry for Teachers. (3) Spring, even years
A study of conditional statements, angles, congruent figures, parallel
' lines, similar figures, transformations, trigonometric ratios, and two- and
three-dimensional figures.

Prerequisite: MATH 1101 or higher.

Note: Open only to Middle Grades Education Majors.

MATH 3003 History of Mathematics for Teachers. (3)

Spring, even years
An historical development of mathematical concepts.
Prerequisite: MATH 1101 or higher.
Note: Open only to Elementary and Middle Grades Education Majors.

MATH 3004 Probability and Statistics for Teachers. (3)

Spring, odd years
A study of basic probability and statistics and its applications with an
emphasis on the skills required to organize and analyze data as it relates
1 to the education field.

Prerequisite: MATH 1101 or higher.

Note: Open only to Elementary and Middle Grades Education Majors.

Math 3005 Problem Solving for Teachers. (3) Fall, odd years

1 A study of topics in mathematics designed for future elementary and
middle school teachers who are not getting a concentration in
mathematics. Topics will include problem solving, number systems and
i the relationships between these systems, understanding multiplication
I and division, including why standard computational algorithms work,
properties of arithmetic, and applications of elementary mathematics.
Prerequisite: MATH 1101 or higher.
Note: Open only to Elementary and Middle Grades Education Majors.

Math 3006 A Survey of Mathematics for Teachers. (3)

Interim Term 2006
A study of problem solving techniques selected from the spectrum of
mathematical knowledge required of middle grades teachers.

Prerequisite: MATH 1101 or higher.

Note: Open only to Elementary and Middle Grades Education Majors.

MATH 3305 Number Theory. (3) On demand
An introduction to number theory.
Prerequisite: MATH 2221.

MATH 3306 College Geometry. (3) Spring, odd years
A study of the concepts of plane Euclidean geometry, with an
introduction to coordinate geometry and non-Euclidean geometries.
Prerequisite: MATH 2221.

199

MATH 3316 Probability Theory. (3) Spring
An introduction to probability. Topics include random variables,
discrete and continuous distributions, the Poisson process, expectation
and conditional expectation, and problem solving.
Prerequisite: MATH 2222.

MATH 3317 Mathematical Statistics. (3) Fall
An introduction to the mathematical theory of statistics. Topics include
estimation and maximum likelihood estimates, sampling distributions,
confidence intervals, and hypothesis testing.
Prerequisite: MATH 3316.

MATH 3335 Linear Algebra. (3) Fall, 2005
An introduction to linear algebra and matrix theory.
Prerequisite: MATH 1 121 or 2221.

MATH 3340 History of Mathematics. (3) Spring even years
An historical development of mathematical concepts.
Prerequisite: MATH 2221 or permission of instructor.

MATH 3342 Complex Variables. (3) Spring, even years
An introduction to complex variables.
Prerequisite: MATH 2222.

MATH 3380 Discrete Mathematics. (3) Fall, even years
An introduction to discrete mathematics. Topics include set theory,
combinatorics, recurrence relations, linear programming, and
graph theory.
Prerequisite: MATH 2221.

MATH 3382 Combinatorial Design Theory. (3) Spring, 2006
A study of techniques used for constructing combinatorial designs.
Basic designs include triple systems, Latin squares, and affine and
projective planes.
Prerequisite: MATH 2221.

MATH 4333 Modern Algebra I. (3) Fall, odd years
An introduction to modern abstract algebra.
Prerequisite: MATH 2222.

MATH 4334 Modern Algebra II. (3) On demand
A continuation of Modern Algebra I.
Prerequisite: MATH 4333.

MATH 4343 Analysis I. (3) Fall, even years
An introduction to Analysis.
Prerequisite: MATH 2223.

200

MATH 4344 Analysis II. (3) On demand
A continuation of Analysis I.
Prerequisite: MATH 4343.

MATH 4350 Problem Solving. (3) Fall

A study of problem solving techniques selected from the spectrum of
Mathematics course work required to complete a mathematics major at
LaGrange College. Topics come from a variety of areas, including
algebra, trigonometry, geometry, calculus, discrete mathematics,
probability and statistics, and mathematical reasoning and modeling.
Prerequisite: Senior standing and permission of instructor.

MATH 4410 Numerical Methods. (3) On demand
An introduction to numerical analysis with computer solutions. Topics
include Taylor series, finite difference, calculus, roots of equations,
solutions of linear systems of equations, and least-squares.
Prerequisite: MATH 2222 and CSCI 1990.

MATH 4495 Independent Study in Mathematics I.
(Variable) On demand

This course allows students to pursue a special problem or topic beyond

those encountered in any formal course.
Prerequisites: Minimum prerequisites are outlined in the LaGrange
CollegeBulletin. Additional prerequisites will be determined by the
instructor, based on the material to be studied.

MATH 4496 Independent Study in Mathematics II.
(Variable) On demand

This course allows students to pursue a second special problem or topic

beyond those encountered in any formal course.
Prerequisites: Minimum prerequisites are outlined in the LaGrange
CollegeBulletin. Additional prerequisites will be determined by the
instructor, based on the material to be studied.

MATH 4499 Special Topics in Mathematics.

(Variable) On demand
(A course offered at the junior/senior level focusing on a specialized
topic from the field of mathematics. A prerequisite may be required.

201

MUSIC

Introduction

The Department of Music is committed to developing skilled and
technologically astute musicians within a challenging learning
environment that encourages creativity, scholarship, and musical
excellence. We offer the Bachelor of Arts and the Bachelor of Music, a*
well as a minor in Music. The B.A. in Music provides a broad study of
music while allowing ample time for extensive coursework in a related
minor. The B.M., a professional music degree, demands more courses
within the music department and is offered in three areas of study:
Creative Music Technologies, Performance (Voice, Piano, Organ,
Guitar, Percussion), and Church Music.

Objectives

To equip music majors with the necessary musical knowledge and
skills required to obtain successful careers in music.

To equip music majors with the necessary musical knowledge and
skills required for admission into graduate study in music.

To provide classes, ensembles, and private music instruction for
non-music majors.

To provide culturally enriching experiences for the college and
community to heighten aesthetic awareness and appreciation of the
musical arts.

Facilities and Resources

The Department of Music is located on the Callaway Campus and is
housed in the Callaway Educational Building. Our facilities include the
Callaway Concert Hall, music faculty studios/offices, Callaway Recital
Hall, instructional and rehearsal space, student practice rooms, theory
lab, keyboard lab, composition lab, edit/mix suite, video editing suite,
and two recording studios. Most laboratories are 24/7 facilities and
enjoy a great deal of student use and creative productivity.

General Information for Music Majors

Acceptance into the Department of Music is granted by a music faculty
committee to those students who have submitted an application and
completed an audition/interview. Please inquire about audition dates,
usually held in early spring. Incoming students who have not auditioned
or interviewed before the committee prior to the beginning of the fall

202

semester should contact the Chair of the Department before enrolling in
music courses. Admission of all new music students to the Department
of Music, freshmen and transfers, is provisional in nature and will be
evaluated at the end of the first year of study (see Entry Requirements
for Music Majors below).

The Bachelor of Music degree is designed for students who are
1 :,a |i preparing for professional careers in music and/or graduate study in
f music. The curricula leading to this degree are based on a philosophy
^ that recognizes the need for rigorous study in all aspects of music.
' es Each program of study requires a heavy concentration of music
courses/experiences, and many courses are sequential. Therefore,
potential music majors are strongly encouraged to begin taking music
courses in their freshman year. The Chair of the Department of
Music can provide you with advisement and a four-year suggested
course guideline.

d The music faculty provides incoming students with a Music Majors
Handbook containing departmental policies and further details about
j requirements for music majors.

Music Scholarships

Talent-based scholarships are available for incoming freshmen as well
as transfer students. Audition dates for scholarships are held annually in
the spring. Applicants to the Creative Music Technologies degree track
must present two or three original compositions and/or arrangements on
manuscript or any recorded format. Applicants to all other degrees
should be prepared to present two selections of contrasting styles.

Ensembles

The LaGrange College Singers is a select group of singers chosen by
audition. This ensemble represents the College and Department of
Music in public performances throughout the academic year, both
locally and abroad.

Both the jazz and guitar ensembles are open to talented students by
audition only. Those interested may audition at the beginning of
each semester.

203

Music Minor

To obtain a minor in Music, students must complete the following

courses:

MUSI 1101 and 1102

Theory 1-2 4 hours

MUSI 11 13 and 1114

Ear Training 1-2 4 hours

MUSI 1110 and 1111

Literature

& Language of Music 1-2 2 hours

MUSI 1103

Piano 1 1 hour

MUSI 3301 (or MUSI 3302)

Music History 1 (or 2) 3 hours

Music Electives

3 hours

Total: 17 hours

Entry Requirements for Music Majors

In addition to fulfilling the general requirements for admission to
LaGrange College, students desiring to major in music must complete
the following:

Audition/interview before the music faculty prior to enrolling in
music courses.

Take the Music Theory Placement Exam. The results of this exam
will be used to determine the appropriate level of music theory
instruction.

Take the Piano Placement Exam. The results of this exam will be
used to determine the appropriate level of piano instruction.

At the end of the first year of study, a music faculty committee will
evaluate each student's progress in the department and determine
whether or not to accept the student into full standing as a music
major.

Exit Requirements for Music Majors

Students must earn a grade of "C" or better in all music courses.

All music majors must take the Theory Competency Exam upon
completion of MUSI 2202 and MUSI 2214 and must receive a
minimum score of 80% in each section. A detailed description of
this exam is included in the Music Majors Handbook.

All music majors must take the Piano Proficiency Exam
demonstrating keyboard skill, receiving a "Pass" on each of the
exam's criteria. Further details about this exam are included in the
Music Majors Handbook.

204

All music majors must present either a capstone presentation or a
public recital featuring their talent (according to the degree
requirements). Recital requirements vary between the different
programs of study. Consult the Music Majors Handbook for
specific guidelines.

All music majors must attend at least 80% of departmentally
sponsored concerts and events each semester of study.

Music Core

The following courses are common to all Music Majors and are referred
to as the Music Core. A student testing out of Piano Class 1-3, or those
whose primary applied instrument is piano or organ must take an
additional 3 hours of music electives to substitute for these classes.
Theory 1 and Ear Training 1 fulfills the Fine Arts elective requirement
and is counted as part of the Common Core Program above.

MUSI 1 1 10 & 1111 Literature & Language of Music 2 hours

MUSI 1101, 1102, 2201, 2202 Music Theory 1-4 8 hours

MUSI 1113, 1114,2213,2214 Ear Training 1-4 8 hours

MUSI 1 103, 1 104, 2203 Piano Class 1-3 3 hours

MUSI 3310, 3302 Music History 1 & 2 6 hours

Total: 27 hours

Bachelor of Arts in Music

This program of study provides the student with a broad, liberal arts
based music education. The major consists of course work in four areas
of study: 1) academic, 2) performance, 3) music electives, and 4)
capstone presentation. The academic areas include music theory and
music history. The performance component is comprised of Piano Class
(1-3) and applied lessons or ensemble. The music electives consist of
MUSI courses and may not be counted in the academic or performance
areas. MUSI 4486 Special Topics may be taken multiple times for
credit. The capstone presentation should be a senior-level investigation
of a topic approved by the music faculty and may take the following
forms: a) recital, a 30-minute public performance; b) lecture-recital, the
student presents a combination lecture and recital totaling 20-30
minutes; or c) lecture, a 20-30 minute presentation of research on some
music topic appropriate to the student's interests and abilities. The
successful capstone project should bring together each facet of the
student's music education, and thus should be completed in the student's
final semester. The student is encouraged to choose a complementary

205

minor area of study, including (but not limited to) English, Philosophy,
History, or Theater. The student must adhere to all entrance/exit
requirements common to all Music Majors.

In addition to the other degree requirements, students complete the
following Music courses:

Music Core 27 hours

MUSI 1 105, 1 106 (or 1 107, 1 108)

Applied Lessons or Ensemble 6 hours

MUSI 4488 Capstone Presentation 1 hour

Music Electives 12 hours

Bachelor of Music in Creative Music
Technologies

This program of study prepares the student for an entry-level position in
the music industry or continued study at the graduate level. Students of
this program typically come from backgrounds that include
performance, song writing, composition, electronic and/or computer
music. The course work prepares students for a wide variety of
activities, such as film/video scoring, multimedia, electro-acoustic
concert and studio applications, music printing, digital audio and
video editing, 5.1 audio editing and mixing, and MIDI applications
of every sort.

Internships allow students to tailor their academic work to their specific
career goals and gain valuable experience with industry professionals.
Internships may be repeated for credit.

In addition to the other degree requirements, students complete the
following Music courses:

ic Core

27 hours

MUSI 1105,

1106

Applied Instrument

3 hours

MUSI 1211,

2210,

2211,3210,3211,4210

Composition 1-6

6 hours

MUSI 1107,

1108

Ensemble

2 hours

MUSI 2310

Orchestration

2 hours

MUSI 2390

Audio Engineering

3 hours

MUSI 3369

Music Technology

5 hours

MUSI 3352

Jazz Theory & Popular Practice

2 hours

MUSI 3384

Junior Recital

1 hour

206

Basics of Conducting

3 hours

Internship

1 hour

Senior Recital

1 hour

4 hours

ffl in I
sof

MUSI 3366
MUSI 4470
MUSI 4484
Music Electives

Bachelor of Music in Performance
(Voice, Piano, Organ, Guitar, Percussion)

This program of study is designed for students seeking careers as
professional classical performers and/or studio teachers. Students
admitted to this program of study must possess exceptional talent in
their principal applied area, and instrumental and keyboard majors must
demonstrate previous training. The curriculum couples rigorous
scholarship with numerous performance opportunities, thus adequately
preparing students for graduate study in performance.

In addition to the other degree requirements, students complete the

following Music

courses:

Vocal Majors Track:
Music Core

MUSI 1105, 1106

MUSI 1107, 1108

Applied Voice
Choir

27 hours

8 hours

8 hours

MUSI 2239
MUSI 3384

Diction for Singers

(may be repeated for credit)

Junior Recital

4 hours
1 hour

MUSI 3366

Basics of Conducting

3 hours

MUSI 4484

Senior Recital

1 hour

MUSI 4480 Opera Workshop
Foreign Language (Non-Music Required)
Instrumental Majors Track:

3 hours
6 hours

Music Core

MUSI 1105, 1106
MUSI 1107, 1108
MUSI 3366
MUSI 3352
MUSI 3384
MUSI 4484
Music Electives

27 hours

Applied Instrument 8 hours
Ensemble 8 hours
Basics of Conducting 3 hours
Jazz Theory & Popular Practice 2 hours
Junior Recital 1 hour
Senior Recital 1 hour

6 hours

207

Bachelor of Music in Church Music

Through a broad interdenominational curriculum, the degree in Church
Music prepares future leaders for music ministry in the church. The
course of study affirms both the rich heritage of the sacred musical
tradition and contemporary worship styles practiced in many churches
today. This degree is also appropriate for those students pursuing
graduate study in church music at the seminary/graduate school level.

The required internships provide an opportunity for students to practice
their craft in a real-world environment. Students are expected to provide
their own transportation to and from the internship site. Because the
internship experience offers valuable interaction with professionals and
spiritual mentoring, students are encouraged to enroll for as many
internship credit hours as their schedule permits. Internship may be
repeated for credit.

In addition to the other degree requirements, students complete the
following Music courses:

Music Core

27 hours

MUSI 1105,

1106

Applied Instrument

8 hours

MUSI 1107,

1108

Ensemble

8 hours

MUSI 3331

Christian Hymnody

3 hours

MUSI 3366

Basics of Conducting

3 hours

MUSI 4470

Internship

1 hour

MUSI 4484

Senior Recital

1 hour

Music Electives

9 hours

Course Descriptions (MUSI)

MUSI 1100 Music Fundamentals. (3)* Fall and Spring

Provides an introduction to elementary music theory, including scales,
key signatures, staff notation, clefs, rhythm, meter, intervals, and general
music terminology.

MUSI 1101 Theory 1. (2)* Fall

This course is designed to provide the student with the basics of music
theory, including: scales, key signatures, intervals, triads, beginning
voice leading, harmony, figured bass, basic reductive and hierarchic
graphing techniques. Some lab time will be devoted to internet music
resources and notation using FINALE. Other topics will include basic
MAC computer skills especially as they pertain to music theory and
CAI in music theory. Must be taken with MUSI 1113.
Prerequisite: MUSI 1 100 or passing score on Theory
Placement Exam.

208

MUSI 1102 Theory 2. (2) Spring

Continuation of MUSI 1101. This course is designed to provide the
student experience with intermediate-level music theory topics,
including: phrase structure, non-chord tones, voice leading, harmony,
figured bass, basic reductive and hierarchic graphing techniques. Some
lab time will be devoted to internet music resources and notation using
FINALE. Other topics will include basic MAC computer skills,
especially as they pertain to music theory and CAI in music theory.
Must be taken with MUSI 1 1 14.
Prerequisite: MUSI 1101.

MUSI 1103 Piano 1. (1) Spring

Beginning instruction in piano for music majors with no previous

keyboard training. Development of basic reading skills.

MUSI 1104 Piano 2. (1) Fall

Continuation of Piano 1 with additional emphasis on sight-reading.
Prerequisite: MUSI 1 103 or permission of Chair.

MUSI 1105-1106 Applied Lessons. (1-2) Fall, Spring
Individual instruction in the student's choice of instrument or voice to
develop technical proficiency, repertoire knowledge, and performance
skills. May be repeated for credit.

Prerequisite: Audition and authorization by the Chair.
Section A - Voice

Section B - Piano (Classical and Jazz)
Section C - Organ

Section D - Guitar (Classical, Jazz and Bass)
Section E - Percussion
Section F - Trumpet
Section G - Composition
Section H - Cello

MUSI 1107-1108Ensemble (1) Fall, Spring

Performance organization(s) providing ensemble experience. May be
j repeated for credit.

Prerequisite: Audition.
Section A - Concert Choir
Section B - Jazz Ensemble
Section C - Guitar Ensemble

209

MUSI 1109 Beginning Classical Guitar. (1) Fall, Spring

Basic techniques of Classical guitar taught in a classroom setting,
intended for non-music majors. The course includes fundamentals of
reading music and understanding elementary music theory. In addition,
students will study examples of simple folk music and music for
worship. A selection of the most useful guitar chords, suitable for
beginners, and basic accompaniment patterns will be taught to allow the
students to accompany their singing. Students will need to own an
acoustic guitar and plan for daily practice time.

MUSI 1110 Literature and Language of Music 1. (1) Fall

This course will acquaint students with the appropriate language needed
for a precise discussion of music and the literature that corresponds to
musical evolution since notation developed. Students will learn to
distinguish between related genres, i.e., opera and oratorio, concerti and
concerto grossi. Moreover, they will learn to recognize musical styles
and be able to place music in the most likely historical period based on
stylistic observations. Although not a survey course, it will incorporate
musical historical perspectives and highlight those important composers
who have changed the direction of music or perfected a certain style.
The course will also have a strong listening component, thereby
encouraging more discriminate listening.

MUSI 1111 Literature and Language of Music 2. (1) Spring

Continuation of MU 1110, this course will place a great emphasis
on listening to and talking about different musical styles and
prominent composers who exemplify those styles. Score study will
be an important component.

MUSI 1112 Music Survey. (3)* Fall, Spring

A broad survey of music aimed at developing aesthetic awareness and

critical analysis of music from diverse styles and genres.

MUSI 1113 Ear Training 1. (2)* Fall

This course is designed to provide the student with basic sight singing
and listening skills. Some lab time will be devoted to internet music
resources and notation using FINALE. Other topics will include basic
MAC computer skills especially as they pertain to music theory and CAI
in music theory and ear training. Must be taken with MUSI 1101
Prerequisite: MUSI 1 100 or passing score on Theory
Placement Exam.

MUSI 1114 Ear Training 2. (2) Spring

Continuation of MUSI 1114. Must be taken with MUSI 1 102.
Prerequisite: MUSI 1101 and MUSI 1113.

210

MUSI 1211 Composition 1. (1) Spring

Score preparation, performance, and recording of works created by the
student. This is a seminar class; therefore, peer evaluation and
commentary is part of the classroom experience. At least one work
must be offered in the recital given by the composition class at the end
of the term.
Prerequisite: MUSI 1 102 and MUSI 1113.

MUSI 2201 Theory 3. (2) Fall

Continuation of MUSI 1 102. This course is designed to provide the
student with more advanced knowledge of music theory, including:
basic reductive and hierarchic graphing techniques, chromatic harmony,
modulations, form (binary, ternary, and variations), advanced voice
leading, and advanced part writing. Some lab time will be devoted to
internet music resources and notation using FINALE. Other topics will
include basic MAC computer skills, especially as they pertain to music
theory and CAI in music theory. Must be taken with MUSI 2213.
Prerequisite: MUSI 1 102 and MUSI 1 1 14.

MUSI 2202 Theory 4. (2) Spring

Continuation of MUSI 2201. This course is designed to provide the
student with more advanced knowledge of music theory, including:
reductive and hierarchic graphing techniques, advanced chromatic
harmony, modulations, sonata and rondo form, advanced voice leading,
advanced part writing, and introductory 20 th century compositional
techniques. Some lab time will be devoted to internet music resources
and notation using FINALE. Other topics will include basic MAC
computer skills, especially as they pertain to music theory and CAI in
music theory. Must be taken with MUSI 2214.
Prerequisite: MUSI 2201 and 2213.

MUSI 2203 Piano Class 3. (1) Spring

Continuation of MUSI 1 104 with emphasis on transposition and chord
accompaniment. Upon completion of this course, the student should be
prepared for the Piano Proficiency Exam. May be repeated for credit.
Prerequisite: MUSI 1 104.

MUSI 2210 Composition 2. (1) Fall

Score preparation, performance, and recording of works created by the
student. This is a seminar class, therefore, peer evaluation and
commentary is part of the classroom experience. At least one work
must be offered in the recital given by the composition class at the end
of the term.
Prerequisite: MUSI 1211.

211

MUSI 2211 Composition 3. (1) Spring

Score preparation, performance, and recording of works created by the
student. This is a seminar class, therefore, peer evaluation and
commentary is part of the classroom experience. At least one work
must be offered in the recital given by the composition class at the end
of the term.
Prerequisite: MUSI 2210.

MUSI 2213 Ear Training 3. (2) Fall

Continuation of MUSI 1114. This course is designed to provide the
student with a more advanced knowledge sight singing and listening
skills. Some lab time will be devoted to internet music resources and
notation using FINALE. Other topics will include basic MAC computer
skills, especially as they pertain to music theory and CAI in music
theory and ear training. Must be taken with MUSI 2201.
Prerequisite: MUSI 1 102 and MUSI 1 1 14.

MUSI 2214 Ear Training 4. (2) Spring
Continuation of MUSI 2213. Must be taken with MUSI 2202.
Prerequisite: MUSI 2201 and MUSI 2213.

MUSI 2239 Diction for Singers. (1) Fall and Spring
Trains students in the use of the International Phonetic Alphabet to
pronounce foreign language art songs. Practice in transcribing English,
Italian, French, and German art songs and applying the rules of correct
pronunciation. May be repeated for credit.

MUSI 2310 Orchestration. (2) Fall
Techniques of scoring for string, brass, woodwind, percussion
instruments and MIDI instruments.
Prerequisite: MUSI 1 102 and MUSI 1 1 14.

MUSI 2390 Audio Engineering. (3) Spring
Classroom instruction in digital and analog audio engineering.
Recording console operation, microphone placement and usage,
mixing, tape based and hard disc recording, mastering, CD burning
and troubleshooting.

MUSI 3301 Music History L (3) Fall
The study of the western classical tradition, from earliest antiquity
through Bach. Emphasis on musical analysis and criticism.
Prerequisite: MUSI 2202.

212

MUSI 3302 Music History 2. (3) Spring

Music of the Classical, Romantic, and Modern eras, including the music
of African Americans. Course will emphasize historical analysis and
criticism, aural identification, and research.
Prerequisite: MUSI 2202.

MUSI 3210 Composition 4. (1) Fall

Score preparation, performance, and recording of works created by the
student. This is a seminar class, therefore, peer evaluation and
commentary is part of the classroom experience. At least one work
must be offered in the recital given by the composition class at the end
of the term.
Prerequisite: MUSI 2211.

MUSI 3211 Composition 4. (1) Fall

Score preparation, performance, and recording of works created by the
student. This is a seminar class, therefore, peer evaluation and
commentary is part of the classroom experience. At least one work
must be offered in the recital given by the composition class at the end
of the term.
Prerequisite: MUSI 3210.

MUSI 3331 Christian Hymnody. (3)* January Term
A survey of Christian hymnody in the English-speaking world from its
roots in the early Christian Church to present day practices in worship.
The study of selected hymns and hymn writers associated with a number
of different Christian traditions will be included.

MUSI 3352 Jazz Theory and Popular Practice. (2) Fall
Theoretical foundations of the Jazz tradition, and consideration of
related contemporary style; blues, fusion, rock, gospel, and current
popular idioms. Aural skills emphasized, with keyboard harmony
studies oriented to realizing technical comprehension of the material.
Prerequisite: MUSI 2202.

MUSI 3366 Basics of Conducting. (3) Fall
1 Conducting techniques, score reading, rehearsal techniques for choral
and/or instrumental ensembles.
Prerequisite: MUSI 2202.

MUSI 3369 Music Technology. (5) Fall

Basic studio techniques, music sequencing, music printing, synthesizers,
studio operation.
Prerequisite: MUSI 2390 Audio Engineering.

213

MUSI 3384 Junior Recital. (1) Fall and Spring
A 30-minute public performance of the student's creative work and/or
talent presented during the junior year.
Prerequisite: Successful completion of the Pre-Recital Hearing.

MUSI 4210 Composition 6. (1) Fall
Continuation of MUSI 321 1. A projects course.
Prerequisite: MUSI 3211.

MUSI 4413 Business of Music Industry. (3)

The study of basic issues pertaining to the music industry: music
copyrights, music synchronization, musical mechanical licensing,
standard music contracts, royalties, artists' advances and contracts,
buyouts. Introduction to the major licensing organizations, i.e., ASCAP,
BMI, SESAC, and the National Academy of Recording Arts & Sciences,
the professional society of musicians.

MUSI 4460 Production Project. (3) January Term
A special projects course with hands-on participation and teamwork
required. Each project is unique; specific content will be publicized in
the semester preceding the course offering.

MUSI 4470 Internship. (1) Fall, January, Spring
A supervised, practical "real world" experience in a professional off-
campus environment. May be repeated for credit.

MUSI 4480 Opera Workshop. (3) Fall, January, or Spring Term
Staged and directed performances of complete compositions and/or
excerpts from operatic literature of several styles and periods.
Prerequisite: Audition.

MUSI 4484 Senior Recital. (1) Fall, Spring
A one-hour public performance of the student's creative work and/or
talent presented during the senior year.
Prerequisite: Successful completion of the Pre-Recital Hearing.

MUSI 4486 Special Topics. (3) Fall or Spring, alternate years
Class instruction for musical topics of a highly specialized nature. The
content of this course will change based upon the expertise of the
instructor and the needs of the students.

214

MUSI 4488 Capstone Presentation. (1)

The capstone presentation is a senior level investigation of some music-
faculty approved topic and may take the following forms: 1) recital, a
30-minute public performance; 2) lecture-recital, where the student pre-
sents a combination lecture and recital totaling at least 20-30 minutes; or
3) lecture, a 20-30 minute presentation of research on some music topic
appropriate to the student's interests and abilities.

* Denotes courses in Music that may satisfy Fine Arts requirement in
Core Curriculum.

215

Nursing
Introduction

The Bachelor of Science in Nursing (BSN) curriculum consists of two
plans of study. The basic program prepares graduates for entry into
professional nursing practice and confers eligibility for initial licensure
as a registered professional nurse (RN). A degree-completion option is
designed for licensed RNs who wish to earn the BSN degree.

The curriculum provides professional nursing education within a heritage
of Christian faith and liberal arts learning. The nursing major, grounded
in an ethic of caring, encourages independent thought, appreciation for
the discovery of excellence, and commitment to supporting the health of
individuals and society. BSN studies establish a sound foundation for
professional nursing practice, graduate study, and continuing progress
toward personal and professional goals. Faculty and students serve as
resources for the College and community in nursing education, service,
and research. Opportunities for collaborative study with students of other
majors and clinical experience with varied health care providers
emphasize the interdisciplinary nature of nursing practice. As
professional nurses, graduates will be able to assist individuals, groups,
and communities in meeting health care goals.

The BSN program is approved by the Georgia Board of Nursing and is
accredited by the National League for Nursing Accrediting Commission.

Objectives

Graduates of the Bachelor of Science in Nursing program will be able to:

Practice nursing from a knowledge and research base utilizing skills
of critical thinking, and communication, with the ability to expand
knowledge and skills through lifelong learning.

Engage in nursing practice based in a value system consistent with
professional standards of nursing and the philosophy of the nursing
program, characterized by caring and valuing of self and others.

Participate in transitions of health recognizing the opportunities and
limitations imposed by historical, sociocultural, spiritual, legal,
ethical, political, economic, and environmental contexts.

Assume the role of professional nurse, accountable as provider of care,
manager, collaborator, educator, learner, and resource for individuals,
families, groups, and communities in promoting and restoring health and
well-being.

216

Admission to the BSN Program

Students may declare the intent to pursue a nursing major at any
time. However, application for admission to the upper-division program
is made during the sophomore year. Nursing studies begin at the junior
level with the exception of Nutrition (NURS 3305; which may be

completed prior to admission to the nursing program. Admission
requirements are as follows:

A completed Application for Admission to Nursing. An application
form is available from the College Admissions office and in the

ice of the Department of Nursing.

Completion of a sufficient number of credits in Common Core and
other required courses to permit an uninterrupted progression in the
nursing major.

A grade oi C or higher is required in anatomy, ph)
microbiology, and English composition courses. Should a student
earn less than a C more than once in any combination of these
courses, the students v. ill be ineligible to enter the nursing program.
A limit of five years applies to completion of anatomy . physiok
and microbiology co

A cumulative overall CPA of 2.5 or higher at the time of entry into

the nursing program, including all courses completed or attempted
at any institution.

An interview with a member of the nursing faculty may be required.

An applicant may request an interview if desired.

An applicant who has completed any program of study leading to
licensed employment in the health care area ('such as registered or
practical nursing, emergency medical technician) must present the
license in person.

Unlicensed students enrolled in the nursing program may not be

employed by any health care agency in the capacity of licensed nursing
nel. They shall not represent themselves in any practice setting as
nursing students unless engaged in planned programmatic learning
activities which are pan of the nursing curriculum.

Admission to the BSN Completion Option

The BSN Comple ion is open to Registered Nurses who have

graduated from an Associate Degree or Diploma program in Nursing

217

and who hold a valid license to practice as a Registered Nurse.
Current Georgia RN licensure is required prior to entering a clinical
nursing course.

In addition to RN licensure, the general admission requirements above
apply to RN applicants, with the following exceptions:

RN students who enter the nursing sequence on a full-time basis
must have completed all Common Core requirements and all
required non-nursing courses through the junior level.

No time limit applies to the completion of anatomy, physiology, or
microbiology courses.

Thirty (30) previously earned Associate or Diploma nursing
semester credits may be accepted toward the BSN degree, subject to
the terms of the Georgia RN-BSN Articulation Agreement (the
complete Agreement is available in the office of the Department of
Nursing). These 30 semester credit hours represent previously
completed nursing courses in Adult Health, Child Health, Maternal
Health, and Mental Health and are not intended to equal the actual
number of previously earned nursing credits. Normally, no more
than 30 hours of Associate Degree or Diploma nursing course
credits may be applied toward fulfilling any requirements of the
BSN degree.

Twenty-four (24) additional nursing course credits must be earned
at the upper division level (3000 and 4000 courses). Up to 9 of
these credits may be earned through challenge examinations on a
one-attempt basis. A minimum of one year of nursing practice
experience within the past three years is required for eligibility for
challenge examinations.

Matriculation Requirements

An accepted student must possess a level of physical and emotional
health sufficient to enable him/her to meet nursing program
requirements and the standards of professional nursing practice.

Prior to beginning the first clinical nursing course, a medical
examination is required which documents the student's level of
health and immunization including current documentation of the
Hepatitis series and TB skin test.

Professional liability insurance (purchased on a group basis through
the College) and basic cardiopulmonary resuscitation (CPR)

218

certification is required prior to beginning the first nursing course
and must be continued throughout all clinical nursing courses.

Students may be required to undergo a background check and/or
drug screening as required by individual health care agencies.

Curriculum

Nursing courses are offered in a 4-1-4 semester sequence during the
junior and senior years of study. The total BSN curriculum can be
completed in four academic years (8 semesters) and includes 45 credit
hours in the Common Core, 19 credit hours in other required and
elective courses, and 58 credit hours in nursing courses. Included in
these hours are two elective and one required interim courses which
compose 9 hours of required interim hours. Selected courses required
for the BSN degree may fulfill certain Common Core Requirements;
these and other required non-nursing courses are:

BIOL 1 148 and BIOL 1 149 Human Anatomy and

Physiology*

MATH 1101
CORE 1110
PSYC 1101
PSYC 3302

ENGL 1101, 1102
BIOL 2320
RLGN2310

College Algebra*

Quantitative Reasoning

Introduction to Psychology*

Human Growth and
Development*

Rhetoric and Composition*

Microbiology *

Bioethics

*These courses are prerequisite to entering the nursing courses.
CORE 2000, Dimensions of Well-Being, is not required of Nursing
Majors.

Junior Year

Fall: NURS 3305 Nutrition and Health*

(may be completed in advance)

NURS 3310 Health Promotion I, Aging
NURS 33 1 1 Health Assessment

NURS 3330 Health Promotion II, Maternal Infant

219

Interim:

NURS 3312 Issues and Trends in Nursing.

Spring:

NURS 3331
NURS 3340
NURS 3350

Fall:

NURS 4400
NURS 4405
NURS 4430
NURS 4431
Spring: NURS 4432
NURS 4440

NURS 4450

Pharmacology*

Pediatric Health Formation & Restoration

Health Restoration I, Life Span

Senior Year

Health Restoration II, Psych/Mental Health

Concepts in Clinical Nutrition

Health Restoration III, Complex Problems

Research in Nursing*

Nursing Senior Capstone*

Concepts in Health Promotion III: A
Community Focus*

Leadership & Role Transition: A Clinical
Practicum

Nursing courses designated above by an asterisk are required of RN
students enrolled in the BSN-completion option. RN students also
complete two RN only courses:

Junior Level
Senior Level

NURS 3313 RN Seminar, Transitions (Fall)
NURS 4460 RN Practicum (Spring)

Information regarding the program length and costs is provided to the
National League for Nursing Accrediting Commission and is available
from that organization at 61 Broadway - 33 rd Floor, NY 10006, 800-669-
1656 Ext. 153.

Progression

1 . A grade of C (75%) or higher is required for successful completion
of all nursing courses. Course syllabi and the BSN Student
Handbook detail requirements for achieving a passing grade of C or
better. A grade of D, F, or WF is a failing grade.

2. A minimum cumulative GPA of 2.0 must be maintained throughout
the period of enrollment in nursing courses. A nursing major whose
GPA falls below 2.0 will be placed on departmental probation and
has one semester in which to raise the GPA to 2.0 or higher. Failure

220

to achieve a 2.0 in one semester will result in withdrawal from the
nursing program. A 2.0 GPA is required for entrance into senior
level courses.

3. Students earning a D or F in any nursing course may repeat the
course one time. The course may be repeated, and if the student
passes, he/she is eligible to continue the nursing program. However,
any other failure in that or any other nursing course will result in
dismissal from the program.

4. All Common Core and other required non-nursing courses, with the
exception of American Experience, Bioethics and an interim
elective must be completed prior to beginning the senior level
nursing courses.

5. Students who fail a course in the first semester of the program must
compete for readmission with the next year's applicant pool.

6. Students must successfully complete all Junior level clinical courses
before proceeding to Senior level clinical courses.

7. The faculty of the Department of Nursing reserve the right to
dismiss at any time a student whose health, conduct (academic
dishonesty, professional conduct), general attitude, clinical
performance, or scholastic standing make it inadvisable to retain the
student in the program. Students are expected to display qualities
that are desirable in professional persons.

Progression in BSN Completion Option

In addition to the guidelines above, the following policies apply to
progression in the BSN Completion Option:

A valid Georgia RN license must be maintained throughout
enrollment in clinical nursing courses.

All previously earned ADN or Diploma nursing credits will be placed in
escrow when the RN student enters the nursing program. Upon
satisfactory completion of 6 credit hours of BSN nursing courses, the
escrowed credits will be transferred to the student's permanent academic
record. Should the RN student not be successful in the initial 6 hours of
nursing course's, the previously earned nursing credits will not be
applied toward the BSN degree.

Assessment in the Major

Standardized achievement tests are administered at intervals throughout the
nursing program. These tests are included within specific nursing courses.
During the final semester of nursing studies, all students must complete
a comprehensive assessment of learning in the major at a pre-determined

221

level required for graduation: Non-RN students will complete a

standardized comprehensive examination in nursing. RN students will

complete an essay-type examination. A description of these assessment

processes will be provided to students during the first semester nursing

studies.

Course Descriptions (NURS)

Course credit hours and corresponding clock hours are shown in
parentheses. One class clock hour/week equals one credit hour; three
laboratory or practice clock hours/week equal one credit hour.

NURS 3305 Nutrition and Health (1) Fall
An introduction to nutrition concepts and current dietary trends,
focusing on health promotion. Nutrients are explored with regard to
sources, dietary requirements, and health implications. Student interests
are incorporated.
Prerequisite: None.

NURS 3310 Concepts in Health Promotion I: Focus on Aging.

(2 hrs. class 6 hrs. lab/clinical per week) (4) Fall
A foundation course to introduce and develop concepts, practices and
processes of health promotion in professional nursing, emphasizing the
needs of the elderly. The skills of communication, problem solving, and
critical analysis in nursing are included.

Prerequisite: Admission to BSN program.

Co-requisites: NURS 331 1, NURS 3330

NURS 3311 Health Assessment Across the Life-span.

(2 hr. class, 3 hrs. lab per week) (3) Spring
A study of the health assessment process applied to persons of all ages,
with emphasis on building knowledge and skill in data acquisition,
organization, and interpretation.
Prerequisite: RN status or Co-requisite: NURS 3310.

NURS 3312 Issues and Trends in Nursing. (3) Interim
An introduction to professional nursing practice and the varied roles of
the nurse in multiple practice settings. The significance of research in
nursing practice and inquiry as a means of defining the nursing role is
included.
Prerequisite: Admission to BSN program.

NURS 3313 Transitions: A Seminar for Registered Nurses. (2) Fall
A study of varied perspectives and conceptual bases of the professional
nursing role. The research process and research significance in nursing
practice is introduced.
Prerequisite: Admission to BSN program, RN status.

222

NURS 3330 Concepts in Health Promotion II, Mother,

Newborn, Family. (3 hrs. class, 6 hrs. lab/clinical
per week) (5) Fall
A study of nursing care of mother, newborn, and family, including
selected women's health care issues. The nursing role in health
promotion is emphasized, with examination of physical, developmental,
and psychosocial challenges to health.
Prerequisite: Admission to the BSN Program
Co-requisites: NURS 3305, NURS 3310, NURS 331 1

NURS 3331 Pharmacology in Nursing.

(3 hrs. class, 3 hrs. lab per week) (4) Spring
Pharmacologic concepts and skill essential for nursing practice,
including the basic science of drugs, determination of dosage, nursing
implications, and medication administration techniques.

Prerequisites: NURS 3310, 3311, 3330

Co-requisites: NURS 3340, 3350

NURS 3340 Pediatric Health Promotion and Restoration

(2 hrs. class, 6 hrs. lab/clinical per week) (4) Spring
A course designed to assist students in developing pediatric nursing
knowledge and skills. An understanding of growth and development
provides a basis for the nursing care in health promotion and restoration of
well and ill children in a variety of clinical settings.

Prerequisites: NURS 3305, NURS 3310, NURS 3311,

NURS 3312, NURS 3330

Co-requisites: NURS 3331, NURS 3350

NURS 3350 Concepts in Health Restoration I:

A Life-span Focus. (3 hrs. class, 12 hrs. lab/clinical
per week) (7) Spring
The foundation course in nursing care of individuals and families who
are experiencing challenges to health, emphasizing understanding and
skill in health restoration.

Prerequisites: NURS 3310, NURS 331 1, NURS 3312
Co-requisite: NURS 3331

NURS 4400 Concepts in Health Restoration II:
A Psych/Mental Health Focus.
(2 hrs. class,6 hrs. lab/clinical per week) (4 ) Fall
Course provides the student with a foundation in psychiatric and mental
health nursing with a focus on therapeutic communication, influences
affecting mental health and illness, and nursing care for mental health
maintenance and restoration.
Prerequisites: NURS 3330, NURS 3331, NURS 3350, NURS 3340

223

NURS 4405 Concepts in Clinical Nutrition. (1) Fall

A study to recognize the value of nutritional assessment in
comprehensive nursing care. The nursing role in understanding dietary
needs as they relate to various body systems and diseases is included.
Prerequisites: NURS 3305

NURS 4430 Concepts in Health Restoration III: Complex

Problems Across the Life-span. (3 hrs. class, 12 hrs.
lab/clinical per week) (7) Fall
A study of advanced nursing care relevant to acutely ill patients with
complex health problems. Learning experiences emphasize
collaboration and critical analysis necessary in providing and
coordinating care.
Prerequisites: NURS 3330, NURS 3331, NURS 3350, NURS 3340

NURS 4431 Research in Nursing. (3) Fall
A course designed to assist students in developing a sense of inquiry,
including research designs, sampling strategies, data analysis methods,
and the use of research in clinical nursing practice.
Prerequisites: NURS 3312 or NURS 3313

NURS 4432 Nursing Senior Capstone. (2) Spring
A seminar to assist students in synthesizing learning related to the roles
and practices of professional nurses, exploring the health care system
and the legal-ethical, sociopolitical, cultural, and professional issues
influencing contemporary nursing.

Prerequisites: NURS 4400, NURS 4430, NURS 4431

Co-requisite: NURS 4450, NURS 4460

NURS 4440 Concepts in Health Promotion III:

A Community Focus.

(3 hrs. class, 3 hrs. lab/clinical per week) (4) Spring
A course directed toward the knowledge and skills necessary to the
practice of community health nursing. Emphasis is placed on the
promotion and protection of the health of individuals and groups within
the context of community. A research project is completed focusing on
a problem or issue in community health.
Prerequisites: NURS 4400, NURS 4430, NURS 4431

NURS 4450 Leadership and Role Transition: A Clinical

Practicum. (2 hrs. class per week, 180 total hours
clinical practice) (6) Spring
A course to facilitate the transition to professional practice. Leadership
and management roles assumed in clinical practice and increasing

224

autonomy in patient care are guided through preceptorial experiences.
Prerequisites: NURS 4430, NURS 4431,
Co-requisites: NURS 4432, NURS 4440

NURS 4460 Practicum for Registered Nurses.

(2 hrs. class per week, 108 total hours clinical

practice) (4) Spring
A clinical practicum to facilitate RN transition to professional practice.
Principles of leadership are examined as they relate to Nursing Practice
for the RN.
Prerequisite: All nursing courses except Co-requisite NURS 4440

NURS 4495 Independent Study in Nursing (Variable)

On demand
For students meeting requirements, the opportunity to pursue special
interests beyond those in the formal course of study.
Prerequisite: Completion of 2/3 nursing major, 3.0 GPA,
and permission.

225

Physics
Introduction

The physics curriculum at LaGrange College serves two basic purposes:

1) an introduction to the physical sciences, oriented towards
developing problem solving, and reasoning skills suitable for the
core requirements of the college.

2) provides courses that support programs in mathematics,
chemistry, biology, computer science, dual-degree in engineering,
and education, and preparation for health professional schools
including medicine, dentistry, veterinary, pharmacy, and
physical therapy.

Course Descriptions (PHYS)

PHYS 1101 Introductory Physics I.

(3 hrs. lee, 2 hrs. lab per week) (4) Fall
A noncalculus-based introduction to elementary kinematics, dynamics,
energy, momentum, fluids, and thermodynamics. The two hour
laboratory illustrates the concepts introduced in class.
Prerequisite: MATH 2105

PHYS 1102 Introductory Physics II.

(3 hrs. lee, 2 hrs. lab per week) (4) Spring
A continuation of Physics 1101 and an introduction to sound and waves,
electric charge, Coulomb's Law, electric and magnetic fields, optics,
special relativity and quantum mechanics.
Prerequisite: PHYS 1101

PHYS 1121 General Physics I.

(3 hrs. lee, 2 hrs. lab per week) (4) Fall
A calculus-based introduction to particle dynamics, energy and
momentum conservation, rotational dynamics, hydrostatics, and
thermodynamics. The two-hour laboratory illustrates the concepts
introduced in class.
Prerequisite: MATH 2222

PHYS 1122 General Physics II.

(3 hrs. lee, 2 hrs. lab per week) (4) Spring
A continuation of Physics 1121 covering wave mechanics, electricity
and magnetism, simple circuits, optics, special relativity and quantum
physics. The laboratory introduces students to electronics.
Prerequisites: PHYS 1121

226

Political Science
Introduction

The political science program is designed to provide students with the
knowledge and skills they will need to become active, useful citizens in
modern democratic polities. For students who concentrate in political
science or those who take only occasional courses, this means that the
political science program will develop their capacity to understand
political organizations and political processes, to analyze the forces
affecting political decisions, and to form judgments about their
obligations and rights as citizens. It also means that the political science
program will provide students with the skills necessary to begin a career
in business, public service, consulting, or journalism or to continue their
training in graduate studies or law school.

Objectives

Students majoring in political science at LaGrange College will acquire
basic knowledge of these areas:

The values, processes, and institutions that affect collective
decision-making and contemporary politics in the United States.

The comparative analysis of the values, processes, and institutions
that affect collective decision-making and contemporary politics in
other countries.

The relations between and among states, especially those affecting
international conflict and international cooperation.

The ethical dimensions of public policy issues, political practices,
and constitutional and legal questions.

Students majoring in political science at LaGrange College will also
acquire the basic skills necessary to comprehend and perform modern
political analysis. These include:

Ability to analyze the foundations of and differences between
normative and empirical inquiry.

Knowledge of the basic elements of research design and methods in
normative, empirical, and historical studies of politics.

Knowledge of basic data management and analysis and of the use
of computers in political research.

Ability to convey findings in both written and oral presentations.

227

Course of Study

The Department of Political Science offers both a major and minor
course of study in political science.

For a Major in Political Science

Demand Sequence for the Program in Political Science (POLS)
POLS 1 101 U.S. Government

OR

POLS 1 102 Introduction to Political Science

POLS 22 1 Comparative Politics

POLS 2220 International Relations

POLS 3300 Research Methods in Political Science

POLS 4430 Senior Seminar in Political Science

Students majoring in political science must also complete an additional
18 semester hours of elective courses chosen from among the three and
four thousand level courses listed for the program in this catalog. At
lease one of these courses must be in the field of American politics and
public policy (POLS 3310, 331 1, 3312, 3313, 3314, or 3315) and one in
the fields of international relations (POLS 3320, 3321, 3322, 3323) or
comparative politics (POLS 3350, 3351). Political science internships
(POLS 4400) can earn up to a full semester (12 hours) of credit toward
graduation, but usually only three (3) hours will be credited toward
completion of the major course. This limit can be waived by the
Department under special circumstances.

For a Minor in Political Science

Demand Sequence for the Program in Political Science (POLS)
POLS 1101 U.S. Government

OR

POLS 1 102 Introduction to Political Science

POLS 2210 Comparative Politics

POLS 2220 International Relations

Students minoring in political science must also complete an additional
6 semester hours of elective courses chosen from among the three and
four thousand level courses listed for the program in this catalog. In the
minor course of study, political science internships cannot substitute for
elective course credit.

228

Assessment of Objectives

Assessment of the objectives of the program in political science is based
on successful completion of each major course with a grade of C or
better and successful completion of POLS 4430: Senior Seminar in
Political Science. To enroll in POLS 4430 students must have
completed POLS 1 101, 1 102, 2210, 2220, and an additional nine (9)
semester hours of elective courses in the political science program. In
special circumstances, these requirements may be waived by permission
of the faculty of the program.

Special Opportunities

LaGrange College is a charter member of the United Methodist College
Washington Consortium that sponsors the Capital Hill Internship
Program in Washington, D.C., for students of political science and other
disciplines. The program in political science also supervises a variety of
internships in local and state government and in Georgia's legal
community. Students interested in pursing one of these opportunities
should consult with the program faculty. The program also includes
service learning opportunities in several of its courses. Again, students
should consult with program faculty concerning these courses prior
to registration.

Course Descriptions (POLS)

POLS 1101 United States Government (3)

An introduction to political science through an analysis of the political
system of the United States. Topics considered include: basic concepts
of political science, federalism, civil liberties and civil rights, basic
governmental institutions, elections and public opinion, political parties
and groups, and domestic and foreign public policy.

POLS 1102 Introduction to Political Science (3)

An introductory course which focuses on the nature of the discipline of
political science and which deals with the way political scientists study
politics through an overview of the major topics of the discipline.

POLS 2210 Comparative Politics (3)

An introduction to comparative analysis of political systems. Topics
considered include: basic concepts of comparative theory, modern
political history in developed and developing areas, the interaction of
political and economic factors in developed and developing areas,
politics and state institutions in selected countries, and comparative
aspects of domestic and foreign public policy.

229

POLS 2220 International Politics (3)

An introduction to the interaction of nation-states in the global
system. Topics considered include: war and power, economic and
social interdependence, and problems specifically associated with
developing nations.

POLS 3300 Research Methods in Political Science (3)

A study of basic social science research methods as applied in political
science. Topics considered include: research design and data collection,
measurement and causality, fitting models to data with various methods,
graphic analysis, and the use of statistical software.

POLS 3310 State and Local Government (3)

A study of state and local government in the United States. Topics
considered include: the political cultures and social environments of
American states and communities, political processes in states and
communities, the structure of state and local political institutions, and
policy issues facing states and communities.

POLS 3311 Congress and the Presidency (3)

A study of the institutional interactions of the executive and legislative
branches of the United States government. Topics considered include:
the President and policymaking, Congress and policymaking,
institutional constraints on executive and legislative policymaking;
foreign policy, civil rights policy, economic policy and budgeting, and
social welfare policy.

POLS 3312 Public Administration and Public Policy (3)

An introduction to the study of public administration and public policy.
Topics considered include: theoretical approaches to the study of public
administration, the historical and constitutional basis for public
administration in the United States, the organization and management
of public institutions, the social, political, and legal environments of
public institutions, the role of political processes in public
administration, the analysis and evaluation of public policy, and the
ethical basis of public administration.

POLS 3313 American Judicial Institutions (3)

A study of judicial institutions in the United States. Topics considered
include: the functions of legal and judicial institutions, the structure and
powers of national and state court systems, the legal profession, judicial
selection, judicial procedure, court administration, and policy formation
by judicial institutions.

230

POLS 3314 American Constitutional Law:Institutions (3)

An introduction to the study of constitutional law as it applies to
government institutions in the United States. Topics considered include:
basic concepts of constitutional analysis, historical development of
present legal institutions and regimes, judicial policy decisions in
different areas of law, and the social, political, and economic factors
affecting those decisions.

POLS 3315 American Constitutional Law: Civil Liberties and
Civil Rights (3)

An introduction to the constitutional liberties and rights accorded
American citizens. Topics considered include: basic concepts of
constitutional analysis, historical development of present legal
interpretations and regimes, judicial decisions in different areas of law,
the social, political, and economic factors affecting those decisions, and
their effect on governing in the United States.

POLS 3320 Analysis of Foreign Policy (3)

An introduction to how structures, institutions, outside actors, and
political culture produce American foreign policy. Topics covered
include: recent history of U.S. foreign relations, the roles played by both
the President and the Congress, the roles, functions and structures of
U.S. State Department, the Defense Department, intelligence agencies
and the National Security Council, the policy making process and the
measurement of outcomes, roles played by the public, interest groups,
and other actors. Current major foreign policy issues will be discussed
and examined as case studies.

POLS 3321 International Political Economy (3)

A study of international economics and trade through the analysis of the
factors influencing past and present changes. Topics covered include:
current and past international finance systems and mechanisms of
exchange, the role of the state and other actors, an examination of
comparative advantage, various strategies states employ such as import
substitution or export promotion, the nature and impact of formal and
informal barriers to trade, the GATT and WTO, the problems, failures,
successes and prospects of the international economic system and its
impact on domestic politics.

POLS 3322 International Organizations. (3)

A study of the current international system. Topics covered include: the
nature of "systems", the recent history of global affairs and the evolution
of the international system to its present state, selected theoretical

231

analyses of international systems, the nature, roles and functions of the
various actors in the system, how advances in technology have
fundamentally changed the world, and the evolving roles of both states
and supranational institutions.

POLS 3323 International Conflict (3)

A study of the conditions that produce war and peace in international
relations. Topics considered include: an examination of recent conflicts
in the international system, theories concerning the potential sources and
determinants of war with an emphasis on the theory of realism and
competing theories, and theories of war settlement and potential sources
of future interstate tension.

POLS 3340 Themes in Political Philosophy (3)

An introduction to the basic ideas of political philosophy. Topics
considered include: the social and historical context of political theory;
the development of major ideas in political philosophy; critical analysis
of theoretical arguments; and the relation of political theory to
contemporary politics.

POLS 3341 Modern Political Theory (3)

An overview of liberalism, communism, and fascism, the three primary
political ideologies that have shaped the twentieth century.

POLS 3350 States and Politics in Developing Areas (3)

A comparative study of the political systems of developing societies.
Topics considered include: basic comparative theory, modern history of
developing societies, political systems of selected states, and the
interaction of political and economic factors in developing societies.

POLS 3351 States and Politics in Developed Areas (3)

A comparative study of the political systems of developed societies.
Topics considered include: basic comparative theory, modern history of
developed societies, political systems of selected states, and the
interaction of political and economic factors in developed societies.

POLS 4400 Political Science Internship (credit may vary)

A supervised internship opportunity for students to work for approved
public or private organizations.

POLS 4410 Selected Topics in Political Science (3)

This course examines particular issues related to topics in political
science selected by program faculty.

232

POLS 4420 Directed Study in Political Science (3)

A supervised course of independent study available to selected students.
The course provides an opportunity for close cooperation between
program faculty and students on research projects and presentations.

POLS 4430 Senior Seminar in Political Science (3)

A seminar course on a major subject of national or international concern
based on individual research and assigned readings.

233

Psychology
Introduction

The goal of this department is to acquaint the student with basic principles
of behavior and the research methods necessary to understand them.

Objectives

A student who graduates from LaGrange College with a major in
psychology will:

recognize the importance of an EMPIRICAL approach in
attempting to understand behavior.

be familiar with the concepts, terms, and explanatory principles
characteristic of major psychological theorists and be able to
evaluate them critically.

be able to identify and discuss examples of the major "types"
of learning, to wit: classical, operant, observational, and
information processing.

be familiar with generalizations regarding physiological correlates
of behavior.

be familiar with the major historical developments in psychology.

be familiar with the terminology of the current edition of the
Diagnostic and Statistical Manual of the American Psychiatric
Association (DSM-IV-TR).

be able to describe how clinicians of different theoretical
orientations (e.g., psychoanalytic, humanistic, cognitive, behavioral,
and physiological) explain and treat psychological disorders.

be able to list and discuss the various objective and projective
personality assessment techniques including the Rorschach ,
the Thematic Apperception Test, the MMPI, the NEO-PI-R, and
the MBTI.

recognize the basic philosophical (e.g., What is personality?) and
methodological issues (e.g., How do we quantify and measure
personality?) in psychological research.

be familiar with the sections of an APA style research report
including the kinds of information typically found in each.

be familiar with the standard procedures for summarizing data
(including construction of frequency tables), the calculation of
measures of central tendency (means, medians, and modes), the

234

calculation of measures of dispersion (range, variance, and standard
deviation), and correlation coefficients.

be familiar with the logic of hypothesis testing including the
statement of research and statistical hypotheses, the notion of Type I
and Type II errors, the power and efficiency of a statistical test, and
the major inferential techniques used in psychology (especially t
test, analysis of variance, and chi-square).

recognize the concepts and principles of psychology as exemplified
in everyday situations.

A major in psychology consists of 37 semester hours (12 courses)
beyond the introductory course (PSYC 1 101). Twenty-five of these
hours come from the categories below.

Methods (Both Required - See Note 1 Below)

PSYC 2298, PSYC 2299

Experimental Content (Select Two)

PSYC 4455, PSYC 4465, PSYC 4470

Social/Personality/Development Content

(Select Three See Note 2 Below)

PSYC 3321, (PSYC 3302 or PSYC 3358), PSYC 3350, PSYC 4460

Advanced Special Topics (Required - See Note 3 Below)

PSYC 4480

Notes:

1. Since this department views psychology as a research-based
discipline, it is strongly recommended that the student complete
PSYC 2298 and PSYC 2299 as soon as possible after the major
is declared.

2. Students may take either PSYC 3302 or PSYC 3358 but not both to
satisfy this requirement. If a student takes both, one course counts
toward the 12 hours of major electives.

3. PSYC 4480 will be offered once per year during January term and
will involve advanced study of a specialized topic. Topics will
vary from year to year.

4. PSYC 1 101, Introduction to Psychology, is the prerequisite to all
2000 level and above psychology courses except PSYC 2298 and
PSYC 3341. Some courses have other prerequisites.

235

Major Electives

An additional 12 hours of major courses will be selected by the student.
A student may select any 3000 or 4000 level psychology course beyond
those counted in the required areas. Up to three courses selected from
SOCI 2247, HUSV 2299, HUSV 3308, and BIO 1 148 may be applied
toward the major with the approval of the advisor.

Minor

A minor in psychology consists of six courses with the approval of the
chair of the department. Any course which is listed in the current
bulletin as counting toward the major in psychology also counts toward
the minor. The exception is that a maximum of two of the major courses
offered outside the psychology department may be counted toward the
minor (i.e., at least four of the courses for the minor must be taken in the
psychology department).

Assessment

The accomplishment of the psychology objectives will be demonstrated
by obtaining an acceptable score on the Area Concentration
Achievement Test (ACAT) in psychology. Normally, this test will be
given during the student's final semester at LaGrange College.

Career Options

Students who complete the major in psychology have a wide variety of
career options. Psychology is a very broad field which overlaps many
different areas. Some of the jobs taken by recent psychology graduates
include management and supervisory positions in business and industry
and positions in community and state service agencies. A psychology
major also serves as good preparation for advanced study in law, social
science, counseling, and psychology.

Miscellaneous

No course with a grade below C may be applied toward the major in
psychology. The only exception is PS YC 4000 in which a grade of Pass
must be obtained.

236

Course Descriptions (PSYC)

PSYC 1101 Introduction to Psychology. (3) Fall, Spring.

A survey of major topics in psychology including research methods, basic

neuroanatomy, learning, perception, personality and abnormal behavior.

Prerequisite to all other psychology courses except PSYC 2298 and

PSYC 3341.

PSYC 2298 Behavioral Statistics. (3) Fall.
Introduction to the measurement of behavior and quantitative methods
of data analysis. An emphasis on parametric statistics and their
application to the behavioral sciences.

PSYC 2299 Research Methods. (4) Spring.

A survey of various types of research design, including the strengths and
weaknesses of each. The laboratory includes practice in designing and
conducting experiments, as well as analysis and reporting of results.
Prerequisites: PSYC 2298 and PSYC 1101

PSYC 3302 Human Growth and Development. (3) Fall, Spring.
A study of normal life beginning with conception. Important
developmental phenomena are considered in the light of major theories
of development.

PSYC 3304 Educational Psychology. (3) Fall.
Application of psychological principles and research to the teaching/
learning process. Major topics include behavioral and cognitive
approaches to learning, classroom management, and test construction
and interpretation.

PSYC 3321 Social Psychology. (3) Fall, Spring.
A course dealing with behavior as affected by social influences. Major
topics include social perception, social communication (verbal and
nonverbal), altruism, attitudes, aggression, and prejudice. Also, applied
areas such as forensic psychology are considered.

PSYC 3330 History and Systems of Psychology. (3) On demand.
A study of the historical background of psychology, with emphasis upon
the major schools of thought.

PSYC 3341 Human Sexuality. (3) Fall

This course involves a multidisciplinary examination of human sexual
behavior and intimate relationships. Typical topics considered include
male and female sexual response, gender roles, sexual disorders and
dysfunctions, gender identity, legal and cross-cultural aspects of human
sexuality, sexual orientation, contraception, and relationship issues
related to sexuality.

237

PSYC 3350 Abnormal Psychology. (3) Fall, Spring.

A survey of the causes, characteristics, current theories, and treatment of

psychological disorders.

PSYC 3351 Introduction to Counseling. (3) On demand.
An introduction to counseling approaches, methods, and assessment
techniques. Emphasis is placed on individual counseling.

PSYC 3357 Psychology of Religion. (3) On demand.
Psychological interpretation of religious experience and growth.

PSYC 3358 Psychology of Aging. (3) Spring.
Human aging is examined from physiological (e.g. sensory and
cardiovascular changes), psychological (e.g. memory and intellectual
changes) and sociological (e.g. adjusting to retirement) perspectives.
Also, death and disorders associated with aging such as Alzheimer's
Disease are explored.

PSYC 3380 Special Topics in Psychology. (3) On demand.

A course offered at the sophomore/junior level focusing on a specialized

topic from the field of psychology.

PSYC 4000 Internship in Psychology (3) On demand
This course requires 120 hours of supervised experience (observation,
work, etc.) in a local agency or office and selected readings.
Application for internship must be submitted in the term or semester
prior to placement. Students are then selected on a competitive basis for
enrollment. Grading is on a Pass - No Credit basis.
Prerequisite: Major in psychology with junior or senior standing and
permission of department.

PSYC 4400 Individual Research. (3) On demand.
Under supervision of a faculty member, the student will develop a
project on a topic that is psychological in nature. The emphasis will be
on analyzing and synthesizing scientific literature with the goal of
producing a literature review and/or research proposal. A successful
proposal may lead to data collection and analysis. The result of the
project will be a paper written in APA style.
Prerequisites: PSYC 2298 and PSYC 2299

PSYC 4455 Cognitive Psychology. (3) Spring 2005.
An information processing analysis of topics in perception, thinking,
learning, and memory.
Prerequisites: PSYC 2298 and PSYC 2299 or consent of professor.

238

PSYC 4460 Psychology of Personality. (3) Fall.
A critical study of major personality theories, principles and instruments
of assessment, and relevant empirical research.
j Prerequisites: PSYC 2298 and PSYC 2299 or consent of professor.

PSYC 4465 Physiological Psychology. (3) Spring 2006.
Neuroanatomy and neurophysiology will be explored and will provide a
j foundation for examining biological aspects of various behaviors (e.g.,
sensory processes and sleep). Also, the psychopharmacology of selected
drugs and genetic influences on behavior will be considered.

PSYC 4470 Behavior Analysis and Its Applications. (3) Spring.
A survey of principles, research findings, and applications of classical,
operant, and observational learning.
Prerequisites: PSYC 2298 and PSYC 2299 or consent of professor.

PSYC 4480 Special Topics in Psychology. Interim.
A course offered at the junior/senior level focusing on a specialized topic
from the field of psychology.
Prerequisites: A prerequisite may be required.

239

RELIGION AND PHILOSOPHY

Introduction

As a field of inquiry within the liberal arts, the study of religion affords
all students an opportunity to hone the critical thinking and
communication skills that are an asset to any profession. Students who
are considering church-related vocations also may tailor their courses
either to prepare for such careers directly after completion of the degree
or to provide a foundation for graduate study in religion or theology.

The Religion and Philosophy Department offers two major plans of
study: the religion and philosophy major, and the religion major with a
concentration in church leadership. The department also offers three
minor programs: religion, church leadership, and philosophy.

The Religion and Philosophy Major

The major consists of 1 1 courses in addition to the exploratory course in
Religion that is taken as part of the core (RLGN 1 101-05), yielding a
total of 12 courses. The Religion major must include at least 2 courses
in each of these areas: Biblical Studies, Historical Studies, and Ethics
and Theological Studies. The major also requires at least one course in
the area of Philosophy. In addition, all Religion & Philosophy majors
will complete a senior thesis or project. Thus, of the 12 courses
required for a Religion major, at least 8 courses must conform to the
following guidelines:

I. Biblical Studies (2 courses). Minimum requirement is one course
in Old Testament and one course in New Testament at the 2000-
level or above. Courses: 21 10, 2111, 2120, 2121, 31 10-3160.

II. Historical Studies (2 courses). Courses: 1 104 (if not taken for the
core), 2210-2230, 3210-3220.

III. Ethics and Theological Studies (2 courses). Courses: 1 105 (if not
taken for the core), 2310, 3310-3350.

IV. Philosophy (1 course). Courses: any of the philosophy courses,
which are listed under Area IV in the course listing below.

V. Senior Thesis or Project (1 course). Course: 4620, taken either in
the fall or spring of the senior year. Thesis topics must be approved
by the Department Chair prior to the semester in which the student
enrolls for the course.

240

Students are free to choose any other religion or philosophy department
courses for the remaining 4 courses. Internships may be taken for up to
1 full course of credit, with permission of the department chair. At least
6 courses in the major must be numbered at the 2000-level or above.

The Religion & Philosophy Major with a
Concentration in Church Leadership

A Church Leadership concentration within the Religion Major is
designed to prepare graduates for church careers in educational and
youth ministry. The program meets all of the educational requirements
necessary for certification in Christian education by the United
Methodist Church. The major consists of 1 1 courses in addition to the
exploratory course in Religion that is taken as part of the core (RLGN
1 101-05), yielding a total of 12 courses. The Church Leadership
concentration requires successful completion of the following courses:

I. Biblical Studies (1 course). Courses: 1 102 or 1 103 (if not taken
for the core requirement), 21 10, 2111, 2120, 2121, 31 10-3160.

II. Historical Studies (1 course). Courses: 1 104 (if not taken for the
core), 2210-2230, 3210-3220.

III. Ethics and Theological Studies (1 course). Courses: 1 105 (if not
taken for the core), 2310, 3310-3350.

IV. Philosophy (1 course). Courses: any of the philosophy courses,
which are listed under Area IV in the course listing below.

V. Church Leadership and Youth Ministry (4 courses). Courses:
3510-3560.

VI. Internship (1 course). Course: 3550, scheduled in consultation with
the Church Leadership Program Director.

VII. Senior Thesis or Project (1 course). Project topics must be
approved by the Department Chair prior to the semester in which
the student enrolls for the course.

At least two of the courses in Areas I-III must be at the 2000-level or
above. In addition, students seeking certification in Christian education
by the United Methodist Church must complete United Methodist
Studies (3210). Students who do not seek United Methodist certification
may choose any religion department course for the remaining to fulfill
the remaining course requirements for the major.

The Religion & Philosophy Major with Honors

Students who maintain a 3.5 grade point average in departmental
courses and who receive "A" grades on their senior theses or projects
may graduate with honors.

241

The Religion & Philosophy Minor

A minor in religion requires completion of 3 courses in addition to the
exploratory religion core requirement: 4 courses in all. At least 2
courses must be at the 2000-level or above.

The Church Leadership Minor

A minor in Church Leadership consists of 4 courses in addition to the
exploratory religion core requirement: 5 courses in all. The minor
includes one course taken at the 2000-level or above in Area I, II, III,
IV, or VI. In addition, minor students must take Christian Education in
the Local Church (3510) and should choose one (1) of the following:
RLGN 3520, 3540, or 3560. Finally, the minor requires 1 course of
Internship (RLGN 3550).

The Philosophy Minor

No major program currently is offered in philosophy. A minor consists
of 4 courses in Area IV, of which at least 2 courses must be taken at the
2000-level or above.

The Church Music Program

The church music program is administered through the music department
in cooperation with the Religion and Philosophy department. See the
Music Department section of the catalogue for a program description.

Course Descriptions

Core Exploratory Courses: Explorations of the Christian

Faith (RLGN)

RLGN 1101. Introduction to Christianity. Spring 2006, Spring 2007
An introduction to the Christian tradition of faith through a study of its
central symbols, sacred texts, and practices.

RLGN 1102. Jewish Origins in Context. Every term
A study of the Hebrew bible, commonly called by Christians the Old
Testament, in the context of the ancient near eastern world. The course
also will ask students to reflect on the impact of the Hebrew bible on
Western civilization and its implications for the contemporary world.

RLGN 1103. New Testament Writings in Context. Every term
A study of the New Testament writings in the context of Greco-Roman
civilization. The course also will ask students to reflect on the impact of
Christian scriptures on Western civilization and consider their
implications for the contemporary world.

242

RLGN 1104. Dialogue with World Faith Traditions.

Spring 2006, Spring 2007
The course will place the insights of the Christian faith in dialogue with
those of major living world religions.

RLGN 1105. Moral Traditions and Contemporary Social

Problems. Fall 2005, Fall 2006
A study of contemporary ethical issues in the light of the moral
traditions central to the Christian faith. The course will examine such
issues as marriage and family, war and peace, racism, abortion, and the
environment. Servant leadership component.

Religion and Philosophy Departmental Courses

RLGN 2110. Introduction to Biblical Hebrew I.

A beginning course designed to teach the fundamentals of Biblical
Hebrew.
Prerequisite: None

RLGN 2111. Introduction to Biblical Hebrew II.

A continuation of RLGN 2110.
Prerequisite: RLGN 21 10

RLGN 2120. Introduction to Hellenistic Greek I.

A beginning course designed to teach the fundamentals of Hellenistic or
Koine Greek, which includes the language of the New Testament.
Prerequisite: None

RLGN 2121. Introduction to Hellenistic Greek II.

A continuation of RLGN 2120.
Prerequisite: RLGN 2120

RLGN 2130. Readings in New Testament Greek.

Selected readings from New Testament texts with some attention to
developing intermediate Greek grammar.
Prerequisite: RLGN 2120 and 2121

RLGN 3110. The Law.

A detailed study of the first five books of the Old Testament.
Prerequisite: RLGN 1102, or permission of professor

RLGN 3120. The Prophets.

A detailed study of prophetic movements in Israel and of the individual
prophets, their historical background, lives, messages, and contributions
to the religious life of Israel.
Prerequisite: RLGN 1 102, or permission of professor

243

RLGN 3130. The Writings.

An examination of wisdom, apocalyptic and poetic literature of the
Old Testament.
Prerequisite: RLGN 1 102, or permission of professor

RLGN 3140. The Life and Teachings of Jesus.

A study of the message of Jesus within the context of the synoptic
gospels and its application to contemporary society.
Prerequisite: RLGN 1 103, or permission of professor

RLGN 3150. The Apostolic Age.

An examination of the origin and expansion of the early Christian
Church, with studies in the Epistles and the Acts of the Apostles.
Prerequisite: RLGN 1 103, or permission of professor

RLGN 3160. The Gospels. Fall 2005

An examination of one of the four canonical gospels with emphasis on
the historical context, history of interpretation, and modern
appropriations of the text.
Prerequisite: RLGN 1 103, or permission of professor

Area II: Historical Studies (RLGN)

RLGN 2210. Early Church History.

A survey of the history of the Christian Church from the close of the
Apostolic age to the end of the Middle Ages.
Prerequisite: None

RLGN 2220. Modern Church History. Fall 2005
A history of the Christian Church from the reformation era to the
modern period.
Prerequisite: None

RLGN 2230. Race and Religion in America.

This course will examine the role that religion played and continues to
play in American race relations and racial identities. The course will
emphasize the history and the theorists of the civil rights contemporary era.
Prerequisite: None

RLGN 3210. United Methodist Studies. Fall 2005
A survey of the history, theology, and polity of the United
Methodist Church.
Prerequisite: A religion core course

244

RLGN 3220. A History of Christian Political Thought.

A study of the impact of the Christian theorists and the institutions of the
Church on the development of political theory in the West.
Prerequisite: A religion core course

Area III: Theology, Ethics, and the Social Scientific Study
of Religion (RLGN)

RLGN 2310. Bioethics. Fall 2005, Fall 2006
A study of the ethical issues raised by the practice of nursing, medicine,
and biomedical research.
Prerequisite: None

RLGN 3310. Contemporary Christian Thought.

A survey of the development of Christian thought, with particular
attention to the nineteenth and twentieth centuries.
Prerequisite: A religion core course

RLGN 3320. The Ethics of Sexuality, Marriage, and Gender.

A study of the moral issues related to sexuality, gender roles, and family
life. Topics will vary per offering, but may include ethical reflection on
such topics as the meaning and purpose of sexuality, gender roles, pre-
marital and extra-marital sexuality, homosexuality, and family structure.
The course also is cross-listed in the Women's Studies Program as
WMST 3320
Prerequisite: A religion core course

RLGN 3340. Sociology of Religion.

A sociological analysis of the interplay between religion and culture.
Prerequisite: A religion core course

RLGN 3350. Psychology of Religion.

Psychological interpretation of religious experience and growth.
Prerequisite: A religion core course

Area IV: Philosophy (PHIL)

PHIL 1410. Introduction to Philosophy. Spring 2006
A survey of major philosophical themes and figures that were formative
in Western civilization.
Prerequisite: None

PHIL 2410. Moral Philosophy.

A study of the major philosophical understandings of morality and the
good life.
Prerequisite: None

245

PHIL 2420. Ancient and Medieval Philosophy.

A historical survey of classical and medieval philosophy.
Prerequisite: None

PHIL 2430. Modern Philosophy. Spring 2007
A historical survey of the philosophies of the Renaissance through the
post-modern era.
Prerequisite: None

PHIL 2440. Elementary Logic.

An introduction to the logic of propositions with attention to the
structure and evaluation of informal arguments. The rhetoric of
persuasion and its use of logic and emotions also will be discussed.
Prerequisite: None

PHIL 3410. Philosophy of Religion.

An investigation of problems related to philosophical reflection on
religious thought and experience.

Prerequisite: At least one prior course in philosophy or
permission of professor

PHIL 3420. Themes in Political Philosophy. Fall 2005
An introduction to the basic ideas of political philosophy. Topics
considered include the social and historical context of political theory,
the development of major ideas in political philosophy, critical analysis
of theoretical arguments, and the relation of political theory to
contemporary politics. The course also is cross-listed in the Political
Science Program as POLS 3340.
Prerequisite: None

PHIL 4410. Selected Topics in Philosophy. Fall 2006

A seminar course on a major subject of concern in philosophy based on

individual research and assigned readings.

Prerequisite: At least one prior course in philosophy or
permission of professor

Area V: Church Leadership Courses (RLGN)

RLGN 3510. Christian Education in the Local Church. Fall 2005

A study of issues confronting those participating in a local church
setting. Required of all students in the Internship.
Prerequisite: A religion core course

246

RLGN 3520. Christian Worship. Spring 2007
The study and practice of Christian worship in its historical and
contemporary contexts. Topics will include the theology of worship,
sacraments, liturgy, and the place of music in worship.
Prerequisite: A religion core course

RLGN 3540. Youth Ministry. Fall 2006

The study and practice of ministry to persons from adolescence through
young adulthood.
Prerequisite: A religion core course

RLGN 3560. Congregational Leadership. Spring 2006
The study of the leadership styles and skills necessary for leadership of a
religious institution. Topics may include congregational dynamics,
leading institutional change, working with volunteers, avoiding burnout,
and racial and gender issues in leadership.
Prerequisite: A religion core course

RLGN 3550. Internship. As scheduled

Supervised participation in the local church setting. May be repeated for
credit up to 6 hours.
Prerequisite: Two courses from Area V

Area VI: Capstone and Other Courses (RLGN)

RLGN 4610. Selected Topics in Religion. Spring 2006
A seminar course on a major subject of concern based on individual
research and assigned readings.
Prerequisite: Permission of professor

RLGN 4620. Senior Thesis or Project. As scheduled
Prerequisite: Application to Religion Department Chair

247

SOCIOLOGY

Introduction

The mission of the Sociology department is to equip students with
an entry-level knowledge of sociological concepts, theories, and
research strategies.

Description of Major

Sociology explores the intersection of biography and history by relating
the life of the individual to the operation of social institutions and to
the influence of culture. The student of sociology studies the subtle,
yet complex ways in which our lives influence and are influenced by
social forces.

The discipline of sociology, while new in relation to some disciplines,
has been an intellectual success. From its birth in the middle of the
nineteenth century to the present, the perspectives and methods of
sociologists have become commonplace. Important insights by
sociological theorists are the cornerstones not only of sociology, but of
other social sciences as well.

Sociological concepts have influenced historians, economists, and
politicians, as well as policy makers and social commentators. Students
will find some familiarity in sociological concepts that have made their
way into the discourse of everyday life. "Self-fulfilling prophecy,"
"WASP," "upward mobility," "modernization," "in-groups," and "dual-
earner marriage" are all examples.

Sociology deals with the full range of social groups - from families and
peer groups to towns, communities, organizations, governments and
nations. Increasingly, sociology is concerned with cross-cultural
influences and global systems. Few fields of study have such a broad
scope and wide relevance for research, theory, and application of
knowledge as sociology, and few majors offer their students a more
diverse range of career opportunities.

A major in sociology provides an individual with an excellent liberal
arts foundation for embarking upon a wide range of career paths,
including those in business and the human/social services. Sociology is
also excellent preparation for students who wish to do graduate study in
law, business, public administration, criminology, or another social
science. In addition, the solid base sociology majors receive in research
design, data analysis, and sociological concepts gives them a
competitive edge in today's information society.

248

General Objectives

Students majoring in Sociology will acquire a basic knowledge of the
following areas:

the "sociological imagination," or ability to link individual
biography with history and culture

the difference between micro- and macro-level groups and
processes, and the interconnections among them

the importance and necessity of theory in the process of learning

the strengths and weaknesses of various research methods, and the
appropriateness of each for various research questions

the social bases and biases of what constitutes knowledge or
conventional wisdom

the opportunities as well as constraints that are imposed on us by
social structure

Requirements for the Sociology Major

Sociology majors are required to complete the following courses,
totaling 30 semester hours, with no grade lower than a "C" in
any course.

Foundation (12 hours)

SOCI 1 146 Principles of Sociology

SOCI 2253 Social Problems and Policy

SOCI 4475 Development of Sociological Thought

HUSV 3308 Cultural and Social Anthropology

Research (6 hours)

MATH 1 1 14 Introduction to Statistics
POLS 3300 or HUSV 4476:

Research Methods in Political Science

OR
Research Methods in Human Services

Electives/Interdisciplinary Emphasis (12 hours)

Students may complete the major by electing 4 other courses from the
following list, two of which must be 3000-level or higher.

SOCI 3309 Gender & Society

SOCI 3306 America's Children

SOCI 3307 Criminology

SOCI 3302 Social Change

249

SOCI 2247 Diverse Families

LAST 1 104 Introduction to Latin American Culture

RLGN 2230 Race & Religion in America

RLGN 3340 Sociology of Religion

HUS V 1 148 Introduction to Anthropology

WMST 1 101 Introduction to Women's Studies

One appropriate Interim course may count towards the elective
requirement, with approval of the department chair.

Requirements for the Sociology Minor

A minor in sociology consists of 5 courses, two of which must be at the
3000 level or higher.

All students planning to minor in sociology must take the following:

SOCI 1 146 Principles of Sociology

SOCI 2247 Diverse Families

SOCI 2253 Social Problems and Policy

Students must choose 2 courses from the following list:
SOCI 3309 Gender & Society

SOCI 3306 America's Children

SOCI 3307 Criminology

SOCI 3302 Social Change

HUSV 3352 Life Course and the Social Environment

PS YC/SOCI 332 1 Social Psychology
RLGN/SOCI 3340 Sociology of Religion
HUSV/SOCI 4478 Special Topics in Human Services or

Sociology, with approval of department chair

Assessment

Mastery of the curriculum for a major in Sociology is measured by:

Completion of all major requirements with a C or higher in every
course

Completion of a formal research proposal (typically during a
student's final semester) as part of the requirements for SOCI
4475, Development of Sociological Thought, that demonstrates
competence in 1 ) the selection of an appropriate and
contemporarily relevant sociological research question; 2)
integration and application of theory; 3) and assessment and
defense of a suitable research design.

250

Course Descriptions (SOCI)

SOCI 1146 Principles of Sociology. (3) Fall and Spring

A study of the fundamental concepts and principles of the discipline,
with emphasis on socialization, social institutions, social interaction,
social stratification and inequality, as well as mechanisms of social
control. Familiarization with the distinction between macro- and micro-
level sociological processes will be emphasized.

SOCI 2247 Diverse Families. (3) Fall

This course offers a multi-disciplinary perspective on contemporary
marriages, families, and other intimate relationships. Students will
become familiarized with competing models and theories on family
relationships. In addition, the course explores cross-cultural variation in
family systems as well as diversity and change within the American
population. Topics to be covered include: mate selection, sexuality,
marital structure, marital happiness, divorce, parenting, and alternative
family forms.

SOCI 2253 Social Problems and Policy. (3) Spring
Using a special topics approach, this course provides the most current
assessment of social problems and the policies created in an attempt to
remedy these social ills. This course may require an overnight off-
campus urban immersion experience.

SOCI 3302 Social Change. (3) On demand
An analysis of the sources, patterns, and consequences of social and
cultural change. The roles of socio-economic, political, technological
and other factors in processes of change at institutional and societal
levels are investigated.

SOCI 3306 America's Children. (3) Fall, on demand
An analysis of current issues confronting America's children.

SOCI 3307 Criminology. (3) Fall, on demand
A multi-disciplinary examination of criminal behavior and corrections,
with an emphasis on competing theories regarding the origins and
incidence of criminality. The course will explore the history of laws and
the criminal justice system, as well as various categories of crime.
Special attention will be given to the social forces underlying criminal
and deviant behavior.
Prerequisite: SOCI 1 146, with a grade of C or higher

251

SOCI 3309 Gender & Society. (3) Every other Spring

Students will become aware of the gendered society in which we live,
the norms, values, and patterns of communication associated with each
gender and how these affect personal life choices and social status.
Specifically, students will become aware of how our basic social
institutions, such as the economy, the family, education, religion, and
the political system are gendered institutions with differing ideals and
expectations for women and men.
Prerequisite: SOCI 1 146, with a grade of C or higher

SOCI 4475 Development of Sociological Thought. (3)

Every other Spring
This course is an introduction to the development and current state
of sociological theory. It focuses on the most influential figures
in the development of sociological theory and their legacy in
contemporary sociology.
Prerequisites: SOCI 1 146 & POLS 3300 or HUSV 4476, with a

grade of C or higher; normally taken during a student's
final semester; senior status preferred

HUSV 1148 Introduction to Anthropology. (3) Fall and Spring
A general introduction to the scientific study of the origin, the behavior,
and the physical, social, and cultural development of humans.

HUSV 3308 Cultural and Social Anthropology. (3) Spring
A study of comparative cultures and social structures with special
emphasis upon the ethnography of primitive people.

HUSV 4476 Research Methods in Human Services. (3)

On demand.
An overview of research design and methodology germane to the
helping professions. Course emphasizes different methods of gathering
data, ethical concerns in this area, and basic statistical matters.
Prerequisites: HUSV 2299 and MATH 1 1 14 or PSYC 2298

252

THEATRE ARTS

Introduction

The Department of Theatre Arts offers a pre-professional training
program emphasizing the practical aspects of theatre and the
importance of process. It is the belief of the faculty that the training
process must prepare students for the real world of theatre. Faculty
teaching in the Theatre Arts program are experienced, working
professionals. We offer professional summer theatre opportunities at
the Papermill Theatre in Lincoln, New Hampshire. With the belief that
theatre is both an art form and a business the curriculum provides a
strong undergraduate foundation in theatre performance, design,
production and literature.

Offering a B.A. in Theatre Arts, majors are required to complete a 33
hour core curriculum in theatre arts designed to foster an appreciation
for, and an understanding of each area of theatre. In addition, 3 specific
track courses and 6 practicum hours are required to complete the
theatre arts degree composed of 42 total major hours.

Objectives

The following objectives are established as a basis for the training
program in Theatre Arts. Upon application for graduation, the Theatre
Arts major will be expected to:

understand the basic theoretical concepts behind each of the four
major areas within the discipline: performance, design, production
and literature.

have an extensive artistic vocabulary in their specific area of
concentration.

have the technical knowledge pertaining, but not limited to the
student's chosen area of concentration.

demonstrate an understanding of auditioning and/or portfolio
presentation.

be knowledgeable of viable avenues of employment and sources
noting such information.

have an understanding of opportunities for graduate studies and
employment in theatre and the performing arts.

253

Graduation Requirements for the
Theatre Arts Major

A student pursuing a major in Theatre Arts must meet all of the
following criteria on an ongoing basis:

A. Satisfactory completion of all degree requirements as outlined in
the catalogue.

B. Participation in all departmental productions and activities,
including auditions, production crews, work calls and production
strikes as assigned by faculty.

C. Attendance at all scheduled departmental meetings and activities.

Admission to the Theatre Arts Major

In order to be admitted and to continue as a Theatre Arts major, a
student must meet the following criteria:

A. Overall grade point average of 2.25 or better. Scholarship
recipients must maintain a 3.0 grade point average or better.

B. Writing proficiency-a grade of C or better in English 1 101, 1 102

C. Theatrical Proficiency-a grade of C or better in all Theatre Arts
courses

D. Prognosis for Success- evaluation during Theatre courses
pertinent to:

1) attendance

2) attitude

3) cooperation

4) oral and written skills

5) enthusiasm and dedication to the Theatre Arts program

E. Transfer students wishing to continue as a Theatre Arts major
must provide evidence of all of the above plus the following:

1 ) past participation in departmental productions

2) recommendations of at least two theatre faculty from the
transfer ring institution

3) acceptance as a major is subject to approval by a majority of
the LaGrange College Theatre Arts faculty

A student that does not meet all of the above criteria each semester may
be placed on probation. After the probationary period, the student will be
re-evaluated by the Theatre Arts faculty. If it is determined that the

254

student has failed to meet the above criteria satisfactorily, the student
may be removed as major, and any theatre scholarships revoked.

Requirements for the Theatre Arts Major

A total of 42 semester hours are required for the Theatre Arts major.
Core Requirements (33 hours):

THEA 1101

Drama Survey I

3 hrs.

THEA1102

Drama Survey II

3 hrs.

THEA 1184

Acting I

3 hrs.

THEA 2205

Movement for the Actor

3 hrs.

THEA 2210

Voice and Diction

3 hrs.

THEA 1180

Stagecraft

3 hrs.

THEA 21 10

Introduction to Design

3 hrs.

THEA 2200

or 2201

Stunts/Fights for Stage, TV and Film I

3 hrs.

THEA 2330

Script Analysis

3 hrs.

THEA 2285

Practicum

6 hrs.
33 hrs

Track Course 3 of the following (9 hours):

Performance Track

THEA 3370

Directing

3 hrs.

THEA 3345

Musical Theatre

3 hrs.

THEA 4451

Auditioning

3 hrs.

THEA 2286

Makeup

3 hrs.

THEA 3305

Period Styles

3 hrs.

THEA 3310

Playwriting/Screenwriting

3 hrs.

THEA 2351

Acting II

3 hrs.

Design/Technical Track

THEA 3360

Scenic Design

3 hrs.

THEA 3381

Lighting Design

3 hrs.

THEA 3385

Costume Design

3 hrs.

THEA 2283

Stage Management

3 hrs.

THEA 3420

Theatre Management

3 hrs.

THEATRE ARTS CORE HOURS

33 hrs

TRACK HOURS

9 hrs.

i

42 hrs

255

Requirements for the Theatre Arts Minor

THEA 1101 Drama Survey 3 hrs.

THEA1184 Acting I 3 hrs.

THEA 1 1 80 Stagecraft 3 hrs.

THEA 2110 Intro to Design 3 hrs.

THEA 2330 Script Analysis 3 hrs.

Practicum 3 hrs.

18 hrs.
Course Descriptions (THEA)

THEA 1101 Drama Survey I. (3) *

A survey of the discovery of theatre beginning in ancient Greece
continuing through the rise of Realism. Students will study theatre as a
developed art form through reading, viewing and discussing plays
representing diverse eras of history.
Drama Survey II may be taken independently of Drama Survey I.

THEA 1102 Drama Survey II. (3)*

A survey of the discovery of theatre from the rise of Realism through
contemporary drama. Students will study theatre as a developed art
form through reading, viewing and discussing plays representing diverse
eras of history.
Drama Survey II may be taken independently of Drama Survey I.

THEA 1180 Stagecraft. (3)*

A course designed to provide the student with theoretical and working
knowledge of technical theatre. An emphasis is placed on the
fundamental techniques and processes used in theatre productions.
Students will work on a departmental production.

THEA 1184 Acting I. (3)*

A course designed to introduce students to the fundamentals of acting
for the stage. Course will include achievement of a simple objective,
self and sensory awareness, relaxation, concentration and beginning
scene and text analysis.

THEA 2110 Introduction to Design. (3)

A course designed to introduce students to the fundamental elements of
all areas of the design process.
Prerequisite: THEA 1101 or THEA 1102

THEA 2200 Stunts /Fights for Stage, TV and Film I. (3) *

Performance course covering basic stage movement, acrobatics,
faints, falls, slapstick comedy, hand-to-hand combat, and weapons
when applicable.

256

THEA 2201 Stunts/Fights for Stage, TV and Film II. (3) *

A continuation of THEA 2200, adding period weaponry such as, but not
limited to quarterstaff, broadsword, rapier, dagger, food fights, etc. for
the stage.

THEA 2205 Movement for the Actor. (3) *

A course designed to develop body awareness by exploring movement
connected to impulse and instinct, focusing on integration of the mind,
body and spirit.

THEA 2210 Voice and Diction. (3)

To introduce students to the process of voice production, methods of
Linklater's freeing the voice with emphasis on relaxation and breathing,
and applicable techniques for working with text.

THEA 2283 Stage Management. (3)

A course designed to provide student with introduction to, and basic
training in, the area of stage management.

THEA 2285 Theatre Practicum. (1-3)

To give students practical experience in the four major areas of theatre arts.
Prerequisite: Roles/responsibilities for credit must be approved by
faculty. (May be taken for 1 -3 hours of credit
per semester.)

THEA 2286 Makeup for the Stage. (3)*

A study in the theories and application of stage makeup. Topics may

include corrective, old age and character makeup, as well as prosthetics.

THEA 2330 Script Analysis. (3)

A study of major genres of dramatic literature designed to provide the
director, actor, designer, dramaturge and/or technician with basic
guidelines for text analysis. Students will develop and utilize skills to
thoroughly analyze text.
Prerequisite: THEA 1101 & 1102

THEA 2351 Acting II. (3)

A continuation of THEA 1 184 which explores further character
development through advanced scene work and improvisational
exercises.
Prerequisite: THEA 1184

THEA 3272 Creative Dramatics. (3) On demand
A course which introduces methods of creating, designing and utilizing
drama to enhance teaching skills and foster the educational development
of students.

Highly recommended for early childhood and secondary

education majors.

257

THEA 3305 Period Styles of Acting. (3)

A course designed to introduce students to period styles of acting and
movement which may include: Greek, Elizabethan, Comedy of Manners,
Farce, Realism and the Theatre of the Absurd.
Prerequisites: THEA 1184, THEA 2351

THEA 3310 Playwriting/Screenwriting. (3)

A course designed to stimulate critical and creative thinking through the
creation of original material. Students will be guided in the completion
of writing a play/screenplay.
Prerequisite: THEA 2330, grade B or better in ENGL 1 101 & 1 102,
or consent of instructor.

THEA 3345 Musical Theatre. (3)

A practical study of techniques and styles of musical theatre.
Prerequisite: THEA 1184

THEA 3360 Scenic Design. (3)

An advanced study of the Scenic Design process. Students will apply
the principles of design to scenery through intense practical
assignments. Emphasis is placed on communication through Drafting,
Renderings and Models.
Prerequisite: THEA 21 10

THEA 3370 Directing. (3)

A course designed to introduce students to the director's role in
interpreting, choosing, rehearsing and staging a play. Course includes
direction for performance of a short play.
Prerequisites: THEA 1 184, THEA 2110, THEA 2330

THEA 3381 Lighting Design. (3)

An advanced study of the Lighting Design process. Students will apply
the principles of design to lighting through intense practical
assignments. Emphasis is placed on communication through Rendering,
Magic Sheets, and Lighting Plots.
Prerequisite: THEA 2110

THEA 3385 Costume Design. (3)

A course that acquaints the student with the basic skills needed to design
theatrical costumes, which includes patterning and cutting/draping.
Prerequisite: THEA 21 10

THEA 3420 Theatre Management/Arts Management (3)

A course which introduces the fundamentals of Arts management.
Course will investigate and navigate through the conflicting issues,
strategies and opportunities in management in the Arts.

258

THEA4451 Auditioning. (3)

A course designed for developing audition techniques and examining
guidelines for audition procedures with emphasis on practical auditions,
resume, headshots, audition selection material and compilation of an
audition portfolio.

Prerequisite: THEA 1 184, THEA 2351
THEA 4470-2 Special Topics. (1-3)

A series of courses designed to provide students with advanced material/
study in either performance or design tracks.

Prerequisite: Consent of Instructor

THEA 4484 Senior Thesis. (3)

A course in which senior Theatre Arts majors bring their training and
emphasis into focus. Senior thesis projects may be track-specific
special projects in acting, design, directing, stage-managing or
playwriting.
All proposals must be approved by the Department Chair and are
subject to scheduling and faculty supervisory commitments.

* Denotes courses in Theatre Arts that may satisfy Fine Arts
requirement in Core Curriculum.

259

WOMEN f S STUDIES

Introduction

Women's Studies is an interdisciplinary field of study which
complements a liberal arts education by drawing upon a variety of
disciplines to gain a critical awareness of the female experience.
In developing this awareness and in presenting its diversity, courses
explore gender as well as race, ethnicity, culture, age, and social class
as categories of analysis. While exploring these issues, the courses
also promote the development of skills in critical thinking, speaking,
and writing. Courses focus on women's past and present roles in
culture, politics, the family, the arts and sciences, health care business,
and religion.

Objectives

A minor in Women's Studies consists of twelve semester hours: Three
of which must be WMST 1101: Introduction to Women's Studies. Of
the remaining nine hours, six must be taken at the 3000 level. This
flexibility coupled with the interdisciplinary nature of the field, permits
students to design a minor which best reflects their academic and future
career interests. (Only cross-listed courses taken during or after the fall
of 2000 may be applied to the minor in Women's Studies.)

Course Descriptions (WMST)

WMST 1101 Introduction to Women's Studies (3)

This course will provide a better understanding of the female experience
and the evolution of women's roles within one's own culture and that of
others. In developing this understanding emphasis will be placed on the
great diversity of women's individual lives by considering such factors
as race, age, marital, and class status.

Cross-listed Courses
WMST 3110/LAST 3110:
Special Topics/Latin American Women Writers (3)

WMST 3247/SOCI 2247:
Diverse Families (3)

WMST 3312/ENGL 3345:

The rise of the English Novel (3)

WMST 3320/RLGN 3320:

The Ethics of Sexuality, Marriage, and Gender (3)

260

WMST 3340/ENGL 3340:

Restoration and Eighteenth Century English Literature (3)

WMST 4500/LIBR 4500:

Advanced Library Research in the Sciences (2)

WMST 4400/LIBR 4400:

Advanced Library Research in the Social Sciences and Humanities (2)

WMST 4478/HUSV 4478:
Women in Ministry (3)

Also, interim term courses are offered in Women's Studies.

261

Faculty

David Oki Ahearn( 1995)

Associate Professor of Religion and Philosophy; Chair, Division of
Humanities; Chair of the Religion Department
B. A. Austin College; M.Div., Southern Methodist University; Ph.D.,
Emory University

Nancy Thomas Alford (1969)

Assistant Professor of Health and Physical Education, Chair of the

Health and Physical Education Department

B.S. Georgia College; M.S., University of Tennessee

Toni P. Anderson (1999)

Professor of Music; Chair of the Music Department

B.M., Lamar University; M.M., New England Conservatory of Music;

Ph.D., Georgia State University

Kim Barber (1995)

Associate Professor of Theatre Arts; Chair, Division of Fine
Arts; Chair of the Theatre Department

B.S., University of Tennessee; M.F.A., University of California at
Los Angeles

David M. Barrett (2003)

Associate Professor of Business

B.S.M.E., Tufts University; M.B.A., Georgia State University; Ph.D.

Georgia State University

Charlene Baxter (1976)

Assistant Professor; Librarian for Public and Technical Services
A.B., West Georgia College; M.L.S., George Peabody College
for Teachers

CindiBearden(2001)

Assistant Professor of Business

B.S., Jacksonville State University; Master of Accountancy, University

of Alabama, Certified Public Accountant

Jon Birkeli (1987)

Ely R. Callaway, Sr. Professor in International Business; Chair of the

Business Department

A.B., Lenoir-Rhyne College; Ph.D., University of South Carolina

Michael Bishop (2005)
Writer in Residence

B.A. University of Georgia; M.A. University of Georgia; Honorary
Doctorate LaGrange College

262

Sandra Blair (2000)

Assistant Professor of Nursing

B.S.N. LaGrange College; M.S.N. Georgia State University

Marcia Langham Brown (1996)

Associate Professor of Art and Design

B.F.A., Guilford College; M.F.A., University of Georgia

Joseph J. Cafaro( 1984)
Professor of History

A. A., Manatee Junior College; B.A., Florida Atlantic University;
M.A., Ph.D., Florida State University

Susan R. Cody (2002)

Assistant Professor of Human Services, Head of the Sociology

Department

B.A., Jacksonville University; M.A., University of Florida; Ph.D.,

University of Florida

John Granger Cook (1994)

Associate Professor of Religion

B.A., Davidson College; M.Div., Union Theological Seminary; Ph.D.,

Emory University

Mary Lou Dabbs (1999)

Assistant Professor; Electronic Resources Librarian

B.A., Florida Presbyterian College; M. Ln., Emory University

Seok Hwang

Assistant Professor of Mathematics

B.S. Yeungnam University; M.A. University of Wisconsin; Ph.D.

University of Wisconsin

Nina Dulin-Mallory (1989)
Professor of English

B.A., Clemson University; M.Ed., LaGrange College; Ph.D.,
Auburn University

Steven Earl Edwards (1992)

Associate Professor of Theatre Arts

B.A., Texas Wesleyan University; M.A., University of Arkansas;

Ph.D., Texas Tech University

Charles H.Evans (1981)
Professor of Psychology
B.S., M.S., Ph.D., University of Georgia

Anton Flores (1999)

Assistant Professor of Human Services, Chair of Human

Services Department

B.S.W., Georgia State University; M.S.W., University of Georgia

263

Frederick, Carlie ( 1999)

Assistant Professor of Nursing

B.S.N., M.S.N. , Wayne State University

Gordon Jeffrey Geeter (1990)

Assistant Professor of Health and Physical Education

A.S., Andrew College; B.S., Tennessee Wesleyan College; M.S.S.,

United States Sports Academy

F. Stuart Gulley ( 1996)

Assistant Professor of Religion

B. A., Vanderbilt University; M.Div., Emory University;

Ph.D., Georgia State University

Heather A. Haas (2001)

Associate Professor of Psychology

B.S. Rocky Mountain College; M.S. University of St. Andrews; Ph.D.

University of Minnesota

Melvin H. Hall (2002)

Assistant Professor of Chemistry

B.S. Cuttington University College; M.A., University of California at

Berkeley; Ph.D. Auburn University

Jenny Hampton (2000)

Assistant Professor of Business

B.S. University of Georgia; MTx Georgia State University;

J.D. University of Chicago

CeliaG. Hay (1996)

Assistant Professor of Nursing

Diploma, Piedmont Hospital School of Nursing;

M.S., Georgia State University, Ph.D. Georgia State University

B. Joyce Hillyer (1995)

Associate Professor of Education

A.S. Southern Union State Junior College; B.S., M.Ed., Ed.D.

Auburn University

John C.Hurd( 1974)
Professor of Biology
B.S., Alabama College; M.S., Ph.D., Auburn University

Lee E.Johnson (1990)

Fuller E. Callaway Associate Professor of Music
B.A., Auburn University; M. M., Indiana University

Marvin D. Johnson (1996)
Assistant Professor
B.A. Concordia College; M.A. American University in Cairo

264

Dorothy M. Joiner (2001)

Lovick Corn Professor of Art History

B.A. St. Mary's Dominican College; M.A. Emory University; Ph.D.

Emory University

Donald Jolly (1961)

Professor of Mathematics

B.S. University of Southern Mississippi; M.S. University of Illinois;

Ph.D. Auburn University

(Retired from full-time teaching in 1995)

Charles P. Kraemer ( 1978)

Professor of Psychology; Chair of Psychology Department; Director of

Undergraduate research

B.A., LaGrange College; M.S., Ph.D., University of Georgia

Jennifer Langdon

Instructor of Mathematics

B.S., U. Nebraska-Lincoln, M.S., U. Nebraska-Lincoln, M.S. U.

Nebraska-Lincoln, Ph.D., U. Nebraska-Lincoln

John D.Lawrence (1970)

Fuller E. Callaway Professor of Art and Design, Chair of the Art

Department

B.F.A., Atlanta College of Art; M.F.A., Tulane University

Kyoo Lee (2004)

Assistant Professor of Philosophy

B.A., Ewha Women's University; M.A. Ewha Women's University;

Ph.D. Warwick University

Tracy L. R. Lightcap (1991)

Associate Professor of History and Political Science, Chair of Political Science

Department

A.B., University of the South; M.A., University of South Carolina;

Ph.D., Emory University

Alvin B. Lingenfelter (2003)

Assistant Professor of Religion

B.A., Mississippi College; Masters of Divinity, Duke Divinity School.

Donald R. Livingston (2001)

Assistant Professor of Education, Chair of the Education Department
B.S. Drexel University; M.Ed. West Chester University; Ed. D. Georgia
Southern University

Sarah Beth Mallory (1993)

Associate Professor of Biology, Director of the Interim Term and

Core Curriculum

B.S., M.S., University of Georgia; Ph.D. Auburn University

265

Greg A. McClanahan (1988)

Professor of Mathematics; Chair, Division of Science and Mathematics,

Chair of Mathematics Department

B.S., M.S., Auburn University; Ph.D., Clemson University

William J. McCoy, IV (1991)

Professor of Chemistry/Physics, Chair of Biology, Chemistry, and Physics

Departments

B.S., Yale University; Ph.D., University of North Carolina

Linda H. McMullen ( 1999)

Assistant Professor of Organizational Leadership and Director of the
Evening College; B.S., Geneva College; M.S., Geneva College

David W. Messer (2003)
Assistant Professor

B.S., University of Tennessee; M.S., University of Tennessee; Ed.S.,
West Georgia College; Ed.D., East Tennessee University

Frederick V.Mills (1967)

Professor of History, Chair of the History Department

A.B., Houghton College; S.T.B., Temple University;

M.Th., Princeton University; M.A., Ph.D., University of Pennsylvania

Walter Y. Murphy

A.B., Emory University; M.Div., Emory University; LL.D., Bethune-
Cookman College; D.D., LaGrange College (1980-1996)

Francis A. O'Connor (1997)

Associate Professor of Latin American Studies

B.A., University of Pennsylvania; M.A., Idaho State University;

Ph.D., University of Iowa

Debbie Ogle (2003)

Assistant Professor of Music

B.S., University Montevallo; M.M., University of Alabama

William G. Paschal (1994)

Associate Professor of Biology

B.S., Saint Joseph's College; Ph.D., Indiana University School

of Medicine

Loren L. Pinkerman (1998)

Assistant Professor; Director of Banks Library

B.A., Westmar College; M.A.T., Colorado State University;

M.L.S., Indiana University

266

Amanda R. Plumlee (1996)

Associate Professor of Latin American Studies and Modern Languages,

Chair of Latin American Studies and Modern Languages

B.S., UTC of Chattanooga; M.A., Ph.D., University of Tennessee

Melinda Pomeroy-Black

Assistant Professor of Biology

B.A. Rhodes College; M.S. Virginia Tech; Ph.D. Virginia Tech

Margaret Reneke (1999)

Associate Professor of Art and Design
B.F.A., University of Georgia; M.F.A.,
Virginia Commonwealth University

Fay A. Riddle (1980)

Professor of Computer Science, Chair of the Computer Science

Department

B.S., H. Sophie Newcomb College of Tulane University; M.S.,

Ph.D., University of Florida

Arthur Robinson (1998)

Assistant Professor; Public Services Librarian

B.A., Trinity College; M.L.S., Ph.D., Indiana University-Bloomington

Lydia W. Rosencrants (1999)

Boatwright Assistant Professor of Accountancy

Associate Professor of Accountancy, Chair of the

Accountancy Department

B. S., University of Richmond; Ph.D., Michigan State University

MaranahA. Sauter(1983)

Professor of Nursing; Chair of the Professional Programs
A.A., B.S., Georgia Southwestern College; M.S., Georgia State
University; Ph.D., Medical College of Georgia

Laine Allison Scott (1998)

Associate Professor of English, Chair of the English Department
B.A., The College of William & Mary; M.A., Middlebury College;
M.A., Salisbury State University; Ph.D., University of Alabama

Bailey Brooks Shelhorse, Jr. (1968)

Professor of Mathematics and Computer Science
A.B., LaGrange College; M.A., Louisiana State University; M.Ed.,
Washington State University; M.S., University of Evansville;
Ph.D. Georgia State University

Kevin L.Shirley (1998)

Assistant Professor of History

B.A., M.A. (history), M.A. (religion), Ph.D., Florida State University

267

Jay K.Simmons (1997)

Associate Professor of Political Science;
Vice President for Academic Affairs and Dean
B.A., Birmingham-Southern College; M.A.,
Ph.D., University of Alabama

JackC. Slay, Jr. (1992)
Dean of Students

B.A., M.A., Mississippi State University;
Ph.D., University of Tennessee

Timothy N. Taunton (1984)
Professor of Art and Design
B.A., University of Arkansas-Little Rock;
M.F.A., Louisiana State University

Brenda W.Thomas (1989)
Professor of English

A.B., Samford University; M.A., Auburn University;
Ph.D., Georgia State University

Charles A. Thompson (2001)

Associate Dean and Director of LaGrange College at Albany
B.A., Gustavus Adolphus College; M.A., Wichita State University;
Ph.D. University of Missouri

Nathan Tomsheck (2004)

Assistant Professor of Theatre Arts

B.F.A., Whitworth College; M.F.A., Yale School of Drama

John A. Tures(2001)

Assistant Professor of Political Science

B.A., Trinity University; M.S. Marquette University;

Ph.D., Florida State University

Mitchell Turner, (2002)

Assistant Professor of Music
Bachelor of Science, Georgia Southern University;
Master of Music, University of Georgia;
Ph.D., University of Georgia

John M.Williams (1989)

Associate Professor of English

B.A., M.A., Auburn University; Ph.D., Georgia State University

Phillip R. Williamson (1969)

Associate Professor of Health and Physical Education;
B.S., M.S., Troy State University

268

Anthony Wilson

Assistant Professor of English

B.A., Oglethorpe University; M.A., Vanderbilt University;

Ph.D., Vanderbilt University

Margie Yates (2005)

Assistant Professor of Education

B.X. University of Georgia; M. Ed. Columbu State University; Ph. D.

Auburn University

Carol M. Yin (1991-1994, 1996)

Associate Professor of Mathematics
B.S., M.A.M., Ph.D., Auburn University

Kuo-chuan Yin (1994)

Associate Professor of Mathematics

B.S., National Chung Hsing University; M.S., Ph.D., Auburn

University

Adjunct Faculty

Ethyl L. Ault

Instructor of Education

M.Ed., Georgia State University

Patricia Callaway

Instructor of Music

B.A., Emory, M.M. State University of West Georgia;

D.MA, University of Georgia

James Anthony Criswell
Instructor of Music
B. Med., Columbus State University; M.M., Samford University

Jerean C. Grau

Instructor of Nursing

B.S., University Medical College of Virginia; Ph.D., University

of Florida

Bill Kovack

Instructor of Business, B.A. Michigan State University; M.B.A.
Michigan State University

Eric Jones

Instructor of Music

B.F.A. Music, California Institute of the Arts; M.F.A. Music, California

State University, Northridge

269

Takemi Kapamaya

Instructor of Modern Foreign Language

B.A., Kyoto Sangyo University, M.A., Himeji Dokkyo University

Julianne Lynn

Instructor of Business

B.A. University of Georgia, Juris Doctorate, Cumberland School of Law

Allison Orr

Instructor of English

B.A., M.Ed., Auburn University

Christiane B. Price

Instructor of Modern Foreign Language

M.A., Freie Universitat; Ph.D., Emory University

Tracy Clahan Riggs

Instructor of Theatre Arts

B.F.A., Catholic University; M.F.A., Florida Atlantic University

Pamela Tremblay

Instructor of Cornerstone and Physical Education

ABJ, University of Georgia; M.Ed., State University of West Georgia;

Ed.S. State University of West Georgia

Thomas P. Steele

Instructor of Religion

B.A., Newberry College; M. Div., Lutheran School of Theology; D.

Min., McCormick Theological Seminary

Darryl Stephens

Instructor of Religion

B.A., Rice University; M. Div., Southern Methodist University

Paul M. Wolkoff

Instructor of Wellness and Physical Education

B.S., Georgia Institute of Technology; M.Ed., East Tennessee

State University

President Emeritus

Walter Y. Murphy

A.B., Emory University; M.Div., Emory University; LL.D., Bethune-
Cookman College; D.D., LaGrange College (1980-1996)

270

Retired Faculty Members

Professors Emeritus

Sybil L. Allen, B.S., M.Ed., Ed.D. (1976-1994)

Roland B. Cousins, B.S., M.S., D.B.A. (1990-2005)

Sue M. Duttera, Ph.D. (1986-2002)

Santiago A. Garcia, B.A., M.A., Ph.D. (1977-1995)

Luke K. Gill, Jr., B.B.A., M.S.W., J.D. (1971-2002)

S. G. Hornsby, B.S.Ed., M.A., Ph.D. (1966-2005)

Sandra K. Johnson B.A., M.Ed., Ed.D. (1983-2005)

Richard Donald Jolly, B.A., M.S., Ed.D. (1961-1995)

Evelyn B. Jordan, AA, B.S., M.Ed., Ed.D. (1977-2001)

Walter Dickinson Jones, A.B., M.A., Ph.D. (1962-1982)

Frank R. Lewis, A.B., M.L.S. (1973-1996)

Charles Franklin McCook, A.B., S.T.B., S.T.M., Ph.D. (1961-1994)

Maynard L. Reid, B.S.E., M.S.E., Ed.D (1973-1995)

John L. Shibley, B.S., M.S., Ph.D. (1950-1986)

Associate Professors Emeritus

Julia B. Burdett, A.A., B.A., M.P.E., M.S.W. (1974-1997)

Patrick M. Hicks, B.S., M.S. (1958-1998)

Jennifer S. Harrison, Baccalaureate, M.Ed., Ph.D. (1995-2005)

Assistant Professors Emeritus

Martha M. Estes, B.A., MA. (1982-1991)

271

Board of Trustees

Officers

Chairman George "Buddy" Darden

Vice Chairman Ray C. Anderson

Second Vice Chairman F. Stuart Gulley

Secretary Nancy N. Durand

Treasurer Phyllis D. Whitney

Members

Ray C. Anderson, Atlanta, Georgia 2007

George W. Baker, Jr., LaGrange, Georgia 2006

A. Quillian Baldwin, Jr., LaGrange, Georgia 2009

J. Barry Bennett, LaGrange, Georgia Alumni Trustee

J. Kennedy Boatwright III, LaGrange, Georgia 2006

David E. Boyd, Atlanta, Georgia 2008

James F. Gruce, Jr., LaGrange, Georgia 2008

Hal N. Brady III, Columbus, Georgia 2008

H. Speer Burdette III, LaGrange, Georgia 2007

Robert L. Carmichael, Jr., LaGrange, Georgia 2008

Janet Gipson Caswell, Atlanta GA 2008

Robert B. Copeland, LaGrange, Georgia 2009

George "Buddy" Darden, Marietta, Georgia 2009

G. Lindsey Davis (Bishop), Atlanta, Georgia Ex Officio

E. Malone Dodson, Alpharetta, Georgia 2007

Nancy N. Durand, LaGrange, Georgia 2006

Garnett J. Giesler, LaGrange, Georgia 2005

Edmund C. Glover, LaGrange, Georgia 2006

William G. Griffin, Jr., Rome, Georgia Ex Officio

Elizabeth C. Harris, Cartersville, Georgia 2007

Ellen Hudson Harris, Franklin, Georgia 2008

Scott D. Hawkins, Atlanta, Georgia 2009

William M. Hodges, Atlanta, Georgia 2006

Pat H. Holder, LaGrange, Georgia 2007

John S. Holle, LaGrange, Georgia 2007

Wayne Hunter, LaGrange, Georgia 2006

Harold Lawrence Jr., LaGrange, Georgia Ex Officio

DeDe W. Leetch, LaGrange, Georgia Ex Officio

Susan S. Middlebrooks, Manchester, GA Ex Officio

Charles M. Miller, Cornelia, Georgia 2008

Polly C. Miller, Columbus, Georgia 2007

272

Marie T. Marshell, Columbus, GA 2006

H. Andrew Owen, Jr., Atlanta, GA 2009

SGA President, Tanner W. Garrard Ex Officio

Peggy Cobb Schug, Charlotte, North Carolina 2006

Jason Slaughter, Atlanta, GA 2007

Nancy K. Stevens, LaGranage, GA Ex Officio

Charles W. Smith, LaGrange, Georgia 2009

Richard W. Story, Gainesville, Georgia 2007

James L. Waits, Atlanta, Georgia 2008

Almonese Brown Clifton Williams, Atlanta, Georgia 2006

Ricky Wolfe, LaGrange, GA 2008

Alumni Representatives

Gerald C. Becham, LaGrange, Georgia

Consultants

Linda R. Buchanan, Vice President and Dean for Student Life and Retention

F. Stuart Gulley, President

William G. Paschal, Faculty Representative

Walter Y. Murphy, President Emeritus

Kimberly Myrick, Vice President for Enrollment Management

B. David Rowe, Vice President for Advancement

Jay K. Simmons, Vice President for Academic Affairs and Dean
Phyllis D. Whitney, Executive Vice President for Administration

Legal Counsel

Daniel W. Lee, LaGrange, Georgia

President's Advisory Council

Carolyn M. Bernard, Greensboro, Georgia
Samuel G. Candler, Atlanta, Georgia
J. Philip Cleaveland, LaGrange, Georgia
Lovick P. Corn, Columbus, Georgia
William B. Fackler, Jr., LaGrange, Georgia
John J. Flynt, Jr., Griffin, Georgia
Charles L. Foster, Jr., LaGrange, Georgia
Clifford C. Glover, West Point, Georgia

G. Sanders Griffith III, Columbus, Georgia
Charles D. Hudson, LaGrange, Georgia

L. Bevel Jones III, Decatur, Georgia
J. Smith Lanier II, West Point, Georgia
Frank R. Lewis, LaGrange, Georgia

C. Stephen Lynn, Nashville, Tennessee

273

Howard R. Park, LaGrange, Georgia

S. Cliff Rainey, LaGrange, Georgia

John W. Stewart, Jr., LaGrange, Georgia

L. Henderson Traylor, Jr., LaGrange, Georgia

Administrative Officers and Staff
President's Cabinet

Frank Stuart Gulley (1996) - President

B.A., Vanderbilt University; M.Div., Emory University; Ph.D.,
Georgia State University

Robert K. Boozer (2002) - Director of Institutional Research and Planning
B.S., M.S., North Carolina State University; Ph.D., Georgia State
University

Quincy D. Brown (1997) - The Elizabeth Walker Lanier Campus Minister
and Director of Servant Leadership

B.S., DeVry Institute of Technology; M.Div., Emory University;
D.Min., Interdenominational Theological Center

Linda R. Buchanan (1997) - Vice President and Dean for Student Life and
Retention

B.S., George Williams College; M.S., Eastern Kentucky
University; Ph.D., Georgia State University

Kimberly Myrick (2003)-Vice President for Enrollment Management
B.A., University of Tulsa; M.A., University of Denver

B. David Rowe (2000) - Vice President for Advancement

B.S., Southwestern University; M.Div., Emory University

Jay K. Simmons (1997) -Vice President for Academic Affairs and Dean
B.A., Birmingham-Southern College; M.A., Ph.D., The
University of Alabama

Phyllis D. Whitney (1998) -Executive Vice President for Administration
B.S., M.A., Murray State University

274

ADMINISTRATIVE STAFF

Rebecca Anderson

2000

Lynn Atha

2003

Ashley Bailey

2004

Charlene Baxter

1976

David Beard

2005

Jackie Belcher

2000

Melissa Binion

2004

James Blackwood

1997

Robert Boozer

2002

Rita Boyd

2003

Dee Bradley

1992

Kelly Britsky

1997

Kristen Brooks

2004

Susan Brown

1999

Quincy D. Brown

1997

Linda R. Buchanan

1997

Becky Carter

1999

Diana Celorio

2001

Karen Clark

2004

Jennifer Claybrook

1999

Austin P.Cook, III

1981

Diane Cooper

1998

Mary Lou Dabbs

1999

Sandra Dennis

1972

Josie Durant

2002

Marion Edwards

2004

Vickie Evans

2005

Brandon Fetner

1999

Secretary, Social and Behavioral Sciences

Financial Aid Counselor

Cross Country Women Basketball

Librarian for Public and Technical
Services, Library

Webmaster

Financial Aid Counselor

Bookstore

Director of Information Technology

Director, Institutional Research and
Planning

Administrative Assistant,
Communications and Marketing

Secretary, Education Division

Women's Basketball and Volleyball
Coach, Senior Women's Administrator

Campaign Coordinator

Swimming Coach

The Elizabeth Walker Lanier Campus
Minister, Director of Servant Leadership

Vice-President and Dean for Student

Accounts Receivable Specialist,
Business Office

Career Placement Coordinator/
International Advisor

Development Writer

Softball Coach, Volleyball Assistant
Coach

Postmaster

Coordinator of Administrative Services

Electronic Resources Librarian, Library

Human Resources Specialist

Departmental Assistant, Theatre

Bishop in Residence

Evening College Admin Asst.

Database Administrator, Information
Technology

275

Michael Fouts

2000

G. Jeffrey Geeter

1990

Jason Goodner

2001

Stacy Gorman

2000

F. Stuart Gulley

1996

Ron Hamilton

2003

Susan A. Hancock

1975

Harden Tracy

2004

Shirley Harrington

1997

Dean Hartman

2000

Warren Haynes

1998

Bryan Hearn

2000

Wylene Herndon

1979

Jimmy G. Herring

1974

Andrea Hively

2004

Melissa Home

2001

Kevin Howard

1999

Patti Hoxsie

2000

Janet Hughes

2004

John Hughes

2002

Amy Hurst

2004

Robin Hurst

1999

Mark Isenhour

2004

Marvin D. Johnson

1996

Dorothy Joiner

2001

Kevin Kime

2004

Lori Knopp

1998

Catherine Kostilnik

1993

Susan A. Laforet

1994

Network Manager, Information
Technology

Men's and Women's Soccer Coach

Assistant Director of LaGrange College
at Albany

Assistant Director of Publications and
Web Development

President

Assistant Director for Media Relations

Secretary, Alumni and Parent Relations

Receptionist, Admission Office

Assistant to the Director of Institutional
Research and Planning

Director of Communications
and Marketing

Men's Basketball Coach

Director of Instructional & Information
Technology

Parking

Registrar

Director, Student Activities and Service

Secretary, LaGrange College at Albany

Baseball Coach

Assistant Controller, Business Office

Assistant to VP Advancement

Sports Information Director

Center for Community Studies

Secretary, Division of Humanities

Assistant Boys Basketball Coach, RD
Vernon Hall

Assistant to the Vice President for
Academic Affairs and Dean

Curator of the Lamar Dodd Art Center

Graduate Assistant Baseball Coach

Secretary, Division of Nursing

Director, Center for Community Studies

Secretary, Division of Natural Sciences
and Mathematics and Institutional
Research and Planning

276

Anita Laney
Dawn Marrin

Kirby H. McCartney

Laurel McDaniel

2001

Melissa McDonald

1983

Linda McGill

2000

Patricia A. McKay

1998

Linda H. McMullen

1999

Carolyn McNearney

2000

Tiffany Mixon

1999

Brandon Mobley

2000

Todd Mooney

2005

Lisa K. Morgan

1991

Jackie L. Morman, Sr.

1992

Kimberly Myrick 2003

Sharon Newton

Debbie Ogle
Ashley Parham
Meredith Parker
Loren Pinkerman

Martha W. Pirkle
Kathy Pirrman
Marty Pirrman
Michelle Reeves
Rhodes Carla
Lee Richter
Brenda T.Riley
John Riley

1974 Bookstore Director

2000 Administrative Assistant/ Curator,
Lamar Dodd Art Center

1983 Administrative Assistant, Student

Development Office; Resident Director of
Hawkes Hall

Copy/Mail Center Operator

Administrative Assistant,
Registrar's Office

Switchboard Operator/Receptionist

Administrative Assistant,
Registrar's Office

Director, Evening College

Administrative Assistant, Academic
Affairs and Dean's Office

Support Manager,
Information Technology

Systems Analyst,
Information Technology

Head Coach, Football

Circulation Manager and Assistant to
the Director of the Library

Pool Operations Manager

Vice President for Enrollment
Management

2000 Administrative Assistant, Career

Development Center and Counseling

1997 Choral Director

2000 Admission Counselor

2001 Admission Counselor

1998 Director, William and Evelyn
Banks Library

1994 Director of Alumni and Parent Relations

2000 Application Coordinator, Admission

1 999 Controller, Business Office
1998 Assistant Director, Financial Aid
2005 Executive Secretary to the President
1993 Golf Coach

1989 Secretary, Division of Business
2003 Director of Leadership Giving

277

Arthur Robinson

1998

Tammy Rogers

1992

David Rowe

2000

Tammy Sawyer

2003

Laine A. Scott

1998

Lyn Schenbeck

2004

Ann Sellman

2002

Wells Shepard

2004

Jay K Simmons

1997

Jack Slay

1992

Lori Slay

1997

Sylvia Smith

1985

Nancy Spradlin

2001

Barbara Storie

1992

Natasha Talreja

2003

Charles Thompson

2001

Emma S.Trammell

1992

Pamela Tremblay

1998

Glenda Turner

1993

Daniel Washburn

2003

Darlene R. Weathers

1988

Fiona Westmoreland

2003

Phyllis D. Whitney

1998

David Wiggins

2003

Chastity Williams

2003

Phillip R. Williamson

1969

Sandra Williamson

1999

Chris Wilson

2002

Joan Wilson

2001

Mary Wilson

1994

Paul Wolkoff

1997

Public Services Librarian, Library

Director of Donor Relations

Vice President for Advancement

Softball Assistant Coach

Director of Writing Center

Placement Director

Administrative Assistant Music Dept.

Director of Admission

Vice President for Academic Affairs
and Dean

Dean of Students

Cataloging and General Assistant, Library

Director, Financial Aid

Accounting Assistant, Business Office

Secretary, Athletics/ Health, Physical
Education and Recreation

Admission Counselor

Associate Dean and Director of LaGrange
College at Albany

Information Specialist, Admission Office

Director of Counseling

Resident Director of Candler Hall

Assistant Coach, Baseball

Manager, Campus Bookstore

Admission Counselor

Executive Vice President for
Administration

Acquisitions Assistant

Record Secretary

Athletic Director

Accounts Payable Specialist,
Business Office

Community Facilitator, Center for
Community Studies

Administrative Assistant,
Development Office

Resident Director of Henry Hall

Athletic Trainer

278

INDEX

A

Abbreviations 102

Academic

Advising 58

Calendar 5

Divisions 100

Forgiveness 67

Honors 70

Load 68

Programs 81

Petition 72

Regulations & Procedures.... 2

Support Services 73

Standing 65

Acceleration 62

Accreditation 12

ACT 21

Administration 274

Admission 20

Advanced Placement Tests 62

Advisers 61

Albany Campus 13

Appeals 66, 72

Assessment 84, 88

Associate Degree 10

Athletics 168

Attendance, Regulations 62

Attendance, Class 62

Auditing Courses 27

Awards and Recognition 95

B

Baccalaureate Degree

Requirements 68

Building Descriptions 14

C

Calendar, Academic 5

Career Planning 56

Change of Regulation 2

Communications Directory 2

Conduct 45

Cooperative Programs 64

Core Program, Liberal Arts ... 149

Counseling 56

Courses of Instruction
(see Departments)

Numbering 101

Abbreviations 102

Course Repetition 62

Credit-By Examination and

Exemption 62

Advanced Placement 62

College Level Examination 62

Program (CLEP) 62

Credit through USAFI and70

Service Schools 63

Curriculum (See Departments)
Cultural Enrichment 70

D

Day Clinic 19,55

Dean's List 70

Declaration of Major 87

Degree Requirements 68

Degrees Offered 85

Departments

Art and Design 103

Biology 112

Business 115

Accountancy 121

Economics 123

Finance 124

Management 125

Marketing 128

Chemistry 129

Computer Science 140

Core Courses 149

Education 151

English 160

French 189

German 192

279

Health & Physical Ed 168

History 175

Human Services 180

Latin American Studies.... 185

Mathematics 194

Modern Language 185

Music 203

Nursing 216

Philosophy 240

Physics 226

Political Science 227

Psychology 234

Religion 240

Spanish 186

Theatre Arts 243

Women's Studies 260

Divisions, Academic 100

E

Early Admission 23

Endowed Lectureships 95

Enrollment 20

Evening College 13

F

Faculty 262

Federal Tax Credits 29

Fees 28

Financial Aid 33

Financial Information 27

Financial Planning 27

Foreign Languages (See Latin
American Studies)

Fraternities 51

Fraud (Suspected) 44

G

Grade Points 68

Grades and Credits 64

Graduation Petitions 71

Graduation Requirements 40

Grants-in-Aid

H

HealthCare 19,55

History of the College 10

Holidays (See Academic Calendar)

280

Home Schooled Students 22

Honor Code 58

Honor Societies 52

Honors, Prizes and Awards 95

HOPE Scholarship 42

Housing Requirements 49

I

Incomplete Grade 64

Independent Study 87

Infirmary (See Day Clinic)
Information Technology

Campus Network 77

Cellphone and Pager Policy .79

Data Security 79

Email accounts 76

Facilities 76

Personal Web Pages 76

Responsible Use Policy 73

Student Computer

Configurations 76

Use 73

Use by Guests and Alumni... 79

User Account 74

User Awareness 79

WAP Best Practices 77

Wireless Network 77

Intercollegiate Athletics 52

Interdisciplinary Major 86

Intramural Sports 54

International Students and

Studies 63

Internship (consult indv. depts.)

J

Joint Enrollment 23

L

LaGrange College

At Albany 13

Campus 14

Evening College 13

Purpose and History 10

Lectures 95

Library 14

Load (Course) 68

Loans 40

Location of College 10

M

Majors 93

Medical Care 19, 55

Minors 88

Mission Statement 10

N

Non-degree student 24

Non-traditional student ( See
Evening College Bulletin)

O

Officers, Administration 274

Officers, Board of Trustees ...272
Organizations :Honorary

Religious 52

Service 51

Special Interests 51

Students 50

Orientation 60

Other Languages & Cultures . 185
Overload 68

P

Petition, Academic 72

Placement (Course) 83

Placement Services 56

Philosophy of College 10

Pre-professional Programs 88

President's Cabinet 274

Probation, Academic 65

Publications 51

Q

Quality Points 68

R

Readmission 25

Refund Policy 30

Registration and Academic

Advisers 61

Religion-in-Life Lectures

Thompson Lectureship 95

Religious Life 54

Requirements:

Admission 21

Degree 68

Graduation 71

Residence Requirements 49

Retired Faculty Members 271

Room and Board 28

S

SAT 21

Satisfactory Academic Progress.. 34

Scholarships 39

Semester Hours 1 1

Session, Other 13

Sexual Harassment 46

Social Life 51

Sororities, Social 5 1

Staff 275

Status

Full-time 68

Part-time 68

Student

Aid 33

Classification 70

Conduct and Honor Code 45, 58

Development 49

Government 50

Housing 49

Life 51

Organizations 51

Publications 51

Review of Decisions 57

Traditional Activities 51

Summer School 1 1

Summer Theatre Laboratory . 253
Suspension 65

T

Teacher Education and

Certification 151

Testing 20

ACT 20

281

CEEB(SAT) 20

CLEP 84

Fee 28

Time Restrictions:

Major 87

Core Program 84

Financial Aid 36

Transcripts 72

Transfer

Admission 24

Credit 68

Transient

Students 24

Study (elsewhere) 69

Trustees, Board of 272

Tuition and Fees:

General Summary 28

Tutoring Center 56

V

Vehicle Registration 57

W

Withdrawal 61

Work Opportunities 44

Writing Center 162

282

283

284

7 n sr g

S 2J 2.
> * ? s

ceo if u ) x>

s<f 8 5

i <3. a

z - 2 =
S - s

5 NJ P R

S -8 s

i- 2 do

O 3 o S

2 O r rt

= 2 2"

oo 5. * a

- o

P * s 2

,3 J?

r 2 w

> o m
o - z
33 o o

> a ft

z Si

no J

u m o

3

t

Cs

5

p

O

5

sa

td

pa

3

era

as

o

SU

p-

O

C/5